More care with headers add/remove lists. Bug 1452
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.80"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2014
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1989 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1990 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1991 support has not been tested for some time.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2036 building process fails if it is set.
2037
2038 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2039 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2040 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2041 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2042 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2043 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2044 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2045 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2046
2047 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2048 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2049 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2050
2051
2052
2053 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2054 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2055 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2056 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2057 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2058 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2059 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2060 .code
2061 FULLECHO='' make -e
2062 .endd
2063 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2064 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2065 given in addition to the short output.
2066
2067
2068
2069 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2070 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2071 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2072 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2073 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2074 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2075 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2076 order:
2077 .display
2078 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2079 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile_&
2081 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2083 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2084 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2085 .endd
2086 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2087 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2088 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2089 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2090 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2091 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2092 and are often not needed.
2093
2094 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2095 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2096 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2097 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2098 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2099 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2100 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2101 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2102 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2103
2104
2105 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2106 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2107 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2108 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2109 default values are.
2110
2111
2112 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2113 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2114 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2115 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2116 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2117 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2118 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2119 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2120 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2121 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2122 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2123 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2124 containing the lines
2125 .code
2126 CC=cc
2127 CFLAGS=-std1
2128 .endd
2129 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2130 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2131
2132 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2133 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2134 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2135
2136
2137 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2138 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2140 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2141 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2142 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2143 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2144 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2145 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2146 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2147 .code
2148 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2149 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2150 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2151 .endd
2152 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2153 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2154 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2155 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2156 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2157 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2158 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2159 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2160 errors.
2161
2162 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2163 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2164 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2165 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2166 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2167 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2168 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2169 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2170 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2171 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2172 syntax. For instance:
2173 .code
2174 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2175 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2176 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2177 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2178 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2179 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2180 .endd
2181
2182 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2183 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2184 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2185 .code
2186 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2187 .endd
2188 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2189 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2190
2191 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2192 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2193 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2194 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2195 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2196 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2197 .code
2198 X11=/usr/X11R6
2199 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2200 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2201 .endd
2202 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2203 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2204 .code
2205 X11=/usr/openwin
2206 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2207 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2208 .endd
2209 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2210 definition of all three of these variables into your
2211 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2212
2213 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2214 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2215 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2216 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2217 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2218
2219 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2220 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2221 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2222 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2223 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2224 libraries.
2225
2226 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2227 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2228 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2229 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2230 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2231
2232
2233 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2234 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2235 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2236 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2237 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2238 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2239 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2240 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2241
2242
2243
2244 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2245 .cindex "building Eximon"
2246 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2247 where the files that are involved are
2248 .display
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2250 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2254 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2255 .endd
2256 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2257 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2259 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2260 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2261 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2262 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2263 .ecindex IIDbuex
2264
2265
2266 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2267 .cindex "installing Exim"
2268 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2269 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2270 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2271 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2272 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2273 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2274 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2275 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2276 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2277 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2278 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2279 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2280
2281 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2282 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2283 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2284 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2285 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2286 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2287 alternative files, no default is installed.
2288
2289 .cindex "system aliases file"
2290 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2291 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2292 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2293 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2294 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2295 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2296 and outputs a comment to the user.
2297
2298 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2299 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2300 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2301 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2302 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2303
2304 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2305 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2306 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2307 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2308 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2309 over SMTP.
2310
2311 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2312 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2313 command such as
2314 .code
2315 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2316 .endd
2317 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2318 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2319 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2320 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2321 but this usage is deprecated.
2322
2323 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2324 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2325 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2326 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2327 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2328 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2329
2330 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2331 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2332 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2333 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2334 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2335 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2336 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2337
2338 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2339 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2340 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2341 command:
2342 .code
2343 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2344 .endd
2345 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2346 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2347 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2348 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2349 command:
2350 .code
2351 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2352 .endd
2353 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2354 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2355
2356 .ilist
2357 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2358 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2359 .next
2360 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2361 installed binary.
2362 .endlist
2363
2364 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2365 .code
2366 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2367 .endd
2368 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2369 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2370 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2371 .code
2372 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2373 .endd
2374
2375
2376
2377 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2378 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2379 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2380 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2381 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2382 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2383
2384 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2385 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2386 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2387
2388
2389
2390 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2391 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2392 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2393 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2394 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2395 necessary.
2396
2397
2398
2399
2400 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2401 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2402 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2403 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2404 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2405 .code
2406 exim -bV
2407 .endd
2408 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2409 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2410 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2411 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2412 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2413 example,
2414 .display
2415 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2416 .endd
2417 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2418 .display
2419 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2420 .endd
2421 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2422 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2423 user agent. For example:
2424 .code
2425 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2426 From: user@your.domain.example
2427 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2428 Subject: Testing Exim
2429
2430 This is a test message.
2431 ^D
2432 .endd
2433 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2434 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2435 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2436
2437 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2438 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2439 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2440 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2441 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2442 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2443 .display
2444 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2445 .endd
2446 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2447 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2448 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2449 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2450 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2451
2452 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2453 .cindex "lock files"
2454 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2455 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2456 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2457 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2458 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2459 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2460 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2461 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2462 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2463 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2464 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2465 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2466
2467 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2468 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2469 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2470 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2471 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2472 incoming SMTP mail.
2473
2474 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2475 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2476 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2477 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2478 production version.
2479
2480
2481 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2482 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2483 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2484 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2485 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2486 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2487 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2488 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2489 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2490 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2491 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2492 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2493 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2494
2495 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2496 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2497 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2498 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2499 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2500 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2501 as follows:
2502 .code
2503 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2504 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2505 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2506 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2507 .endd
2508 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2509 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2510 favourite user agent.
2511
2512 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2513 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2514 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2515 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2516 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2517 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2518
2519
2520
2521 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2522 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2523 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2524 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2525 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2526 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2527 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2528 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2529 configuration file.
2530
2531
2532
2533
2534 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2535 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2536 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2537 .code
2538 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2539 .endd
2540 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2541 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2542 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2543 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2544 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2545 .code
2546 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2547 .endd
2548 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2549
2550 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2551 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2552 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2553
2554
2555
2556
2557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2559
2560 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2561 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2562 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2563 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2564 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2565 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2566 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2567 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2568 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2569
2570
2571 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2572 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2573 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2574 were present before any other options.
2575 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2576 standard output.
2577 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2578 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2579 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2580
2581 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2582 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2583 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2584 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2585 format.
2586
2587 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2588 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2589 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2590 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2591
2592 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2593 .cindex "queue runner"
2594 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2595 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2596 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2597
2598 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2599 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2600 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2601 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2602 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2603 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2604 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2605 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2606
2607
2608 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2609 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2610 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2611 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2612 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2613 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2614
2615 .ilist
2616 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2617 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2618 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2619 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2620 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2621 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2622
2623 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2624 .cindex "envelope sender"
2625 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2626 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2627 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2628 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2629 users to set envelope senders.
2630
2631 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2632 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2633 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2634 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2635 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2636
2637 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2638 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2639 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2640 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2641 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2642 that are available to trusted users.
2643 .next
2644 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2645 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2646 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2647 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2648 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2649
2650 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2651 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2652 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2653 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2654
2655 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2656 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2657 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2658 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2659
2660 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2661 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2662 false.
2663 .endlist
2664
2665
2666 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2667 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2668 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2669 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2675 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2676 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2677 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2678 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2679 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2680 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2681 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2682
2683 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2684 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2685 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2686 . creates a man page for the options.
2687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2688
2689 .literal xml
2690 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2691 .literal off
2692
2693
2694 .vlist
2695 .vitem &%--%&
2696 .oindex "--"
2697 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2698 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2699 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2700 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2701
2702 .vitem &%--help%&
2703 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2704 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2705 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2706 no arguments.
2707
2708 .vitem &%--version%&
2709 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2710 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2711 displayed.
2712
2713 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2714 &%-Am%&
2715 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2716 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2717 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2718 ignored by Exim.
2719
2720 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2721 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2722 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2723 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2724 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2725 clean; it ignores this option.
2726
2727 .vitem &%-bd%&
2728 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2729 .cindex "daemon"
2730 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2731 .cindex "queue runner"
2732 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2733 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2734 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2735
2736 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2737 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2738 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2739 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2740
2741 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2742 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2743 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2744 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2745
2746 When a listening daemon
2747 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2748 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2749 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2750 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2751 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2752 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2753 running as root.
2754
2755 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2756 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2757 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2758
2759 The SIGHUP signal
2760 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2761 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2762 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2763 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2764 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2765 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2766 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2767 because these are reread each time they are used.
2768
2769 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2770 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2771 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2772 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2773
2774 .vitem &%-be%&
2775 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2776 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2777 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2778 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2779 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2780 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2781 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2782
2783 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2784 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2785 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2786 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2787 test data. A line history is supported.
2788
2789 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2790 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2791 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2792 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2793 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2794 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2795 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2796
2797 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2798 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2799 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2800 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2801
2802 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2803 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2804 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2805 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2806 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2807 of a file. For example:
2808 .code
2809 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2810 .endd
2811 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2812 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2813 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2814 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2815 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2816 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2817 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2818 &%-be%&).
2819
2820 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2821 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2822 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2823 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2824 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2825 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2826 system filters are recognized.
2827
2828 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2829 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2830 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2831 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2832 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2833 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2834 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2835 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2836 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2837 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2838 supplied.
2839
2840 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2841 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2842 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2843 .code
2844 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2845 .endd
2846 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2847 variables that are used by the user filter.
2848
2849 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2850 .code
2851 # Exim filter
2852 # Sieve filter
2853 .endd
2854 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2855 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2856 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2857 redirection lists.
2858
2859 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2860 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2861 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2862 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2863
2864 When testing a filter file,
2865 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2866 .cindex "envelope sender"
2867 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2868 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2869 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2870 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2871 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2872 options).
2873
2874 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2875 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2876 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2877 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2878 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2879 &$qualify_domain$&.
2880
2881 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2882 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2883 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2884 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2885 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2886 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2887 actually being delivered.
2888
2889 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2890 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2891 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2892 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2893 prefix.
2894
2895 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2896 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2897 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2898 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2899 suffix.
2900
2901 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2902 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2903 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2904 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2905 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2906 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2907 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2908 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2909 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2910 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2911 after a full stop. For example:
2912 .code
2913 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2914 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2915 .endd
2916 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2917 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2918 conversion to the canonical form is
2919 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2920
2921 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2922 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2923 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2924 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2925 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2926
2927 &*Warning 1*&:
2928 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2929 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2930 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2931 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2932 connection.
2933
2934 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2935 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2936 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2937
2938 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2939 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2940 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2941 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2942 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2943 session were authenticated.
2944
2945 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2946 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2947 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2948
2949 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2950 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2951 specialized SMTP test program such as
2952 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2953
2954 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2955 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2956 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2957 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2958 updating the callout cache database.
2959
2960 .vitem &%-bi%&
2961 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2962 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2963 .cindex "building alias file"
2964 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2965 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2966 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2967 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2968 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2969 recognized.
2970
2971 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2972 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2973 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2974 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2975 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2976 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2977 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2978
2979 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2980 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2981 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2982 .cindex "querying exim information"
2983 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2984 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2985 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2986 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2987 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2988
2989 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2990 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2991 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2992 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2993 recognised DSCP names.
2994
2995 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2996 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2997 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2998 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2999 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3000 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3001 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3002 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3003 way to guarantee a correct response.
3004
3005 .vitem &%-bm%&
3006 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3007 .cindex "local message reception"
3008 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3009 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3010 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3011 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3012 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3013 if no other conflicting option is present.
3014
3015 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3016 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3017 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3018 suppressing this for special cases.
3019
3020 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3021 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3022
3023 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3024 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3025 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3026
3027 The format
3028 .cindex "message" "format"
3029 .cindex "format" "message"
3030 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3031 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3032 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3033 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3034 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3035 .code
3036 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3037 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3038 .endd
3039 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3040 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3041 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3042 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3043 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3044
3045 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3046 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3047 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3048 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3049 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3050
3051 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3052 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3053 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3054 .cindex "malware scan test"
3055 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3056 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3057 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3058 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3059 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3060 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3061
3062 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3063 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3064 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3065 This option requires admin privileges.
3066
3067 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3068 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3069 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3070
3071 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3072 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3073 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3074 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3075 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3076 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3077 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3078 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3079 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3080
3081 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3082 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3083 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3084 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3085 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3086
3087 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3088 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3089 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3090 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3091
3092
3093 .vitem &%-bP%&
3094 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3095 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3096 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3097 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3098 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3099 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3100 arguments, for example:
3101 .code
3102 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3103 .endd
3104 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3105 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3106 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3107 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3108 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3109 users, the output is as in this example:
3110 .code
3111 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3112 .endd
3113 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output.
3115 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3116 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3117
3118 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3119 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3120 name will not be output.
3121
3122 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3123 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3124 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3125 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3126 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3127 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3128 written directly into the spool directory.
3129
3130 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3131 .code
3132 exim -bP +local_domains
3133 .endd
3134 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3135 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3136
3137 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3138 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3140 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3141 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3142 that driver are output. For example:
3143 .code
3144 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3145 .endd
3146 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3147 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3148 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3149 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3150 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3151 &%authenticators%&.
3152
3153 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3154 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3155 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3156 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3157 The output format is one item per line.
3158
3159 .vitem &%-bp%&
3160 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3161 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3162 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3163 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3164 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3165 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3166 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3167 to allow any user to see the queue.
3168
3169 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3170 .code
3171 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3172 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3173 <other addresses>
3174 .endd
3175 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3176 .cindex "size" "of message"
3177 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3178 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3179 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3180 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3181 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3182 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3183 before the sender address.
3184
3185 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3186 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3187 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3188
3189 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3190 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3191 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3192 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3193 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3194 complete.
3195
3196
3197 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3198 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3199 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3200 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3201 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3202 of just &"D"&.
3203
3204
3205 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3206 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3207 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3208 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3209 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3210 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3211
3212
3213 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3214 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3215 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3216 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3217 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3218 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3219
3220 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3221 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3222 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3223
3224 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3225 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3226 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3227
3228
3229 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3230 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3231 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3232 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3233 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3234 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3235
3236
3237 .vitem &%-brt%&
3238 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3239 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3240 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3241 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3242 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3243 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3244 .code
3245 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3246 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3247 .endd
3248 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3249 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3250 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3251 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3252 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3253 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3254 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3255 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3256 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3257 .code
3258 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3259 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3260 .endd
3261
3262 .vitem &%-brw%&
3263 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3264 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3265 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3266 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3267 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3268 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3269 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3270 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3271
3272 .vitem &%-bS%&
3273 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3274 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3275 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3276 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3277 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3278 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3279 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3280 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3281 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3282 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3283
3284 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3285 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3286 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3287
3288 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3289 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3290 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3291 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3292
3293 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3294 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3295 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3296
3297 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3298 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3299 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3300 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3301 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3302
3303 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3304 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3305
3306 .vitem &%-bs%&
3307 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3308 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3309 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3310 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3311 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3312 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3313 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3314 messages to the MTA.
3315
3316 In
3317 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3318 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3319 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3320 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3321 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3322 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3323 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3324
3325 .cindex "inetd"
3326 The
3327 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3328 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3329 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3330 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3331 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3332 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3333 the listening daemon.
3334
3335 .vitem &%-bt%&
3336 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3337 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3338 .cindex "address" "testing"
3339 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3340 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3341 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3342 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3343 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3344
3345 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3346 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3347
3348 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3349 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3350 security issues.
3351
3352 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3353 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3354 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3355 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3356 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3357 program.
3358
3359 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3360 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3361 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3362 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3363
3364 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3365 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3366 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3367 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3368 always shown.
3369
3370 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3371 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3372 message,
3373 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3374 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3375 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3376 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3377 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3378 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3379 doing such tests.
3380
3381 .vitem &%-bV%&
3382 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3383 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3384 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3385 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3386 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3387 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3388 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3389
3390 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3391 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3392 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3393 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3394 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3395 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3396 dynamic testing facilities.
3397
3398 .vitem &%-bv%&
3399 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3400 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3401 .cindex "address" "verification"
3402 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3403 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3404 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3405 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3406 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3407 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3408
3409 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3410 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3411 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3412
3413 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3414 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3415
3416 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3417 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3418 security issues.
3419
3420 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3421 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3422 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3423 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3424 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3425
3426 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3427 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3428 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3429 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3430 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3431 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3432 to succeed.
3433
3434 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3435 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3436 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3437
3438 The
3439 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3440 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3441 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3442 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3443
3444 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3445 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3446 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3447 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3448
3449 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3450 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3451 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3452 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3453 might happen.
3454
3455 .vitem &%-bw%&
3456 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3457 .cindex "daemon"
3458 .cindex "inetd"
3459 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3460 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3461 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3462 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3463
3464 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3465 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3466 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3467 each port only when the first connection is received.
3468
3469 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3470 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3471
3472 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3473 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3474 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3475 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3476 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3477 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3478 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3479 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3480 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3481 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3482 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3483
3484 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3485 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3486 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3487 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3488 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3489 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3490 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3491 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3492 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3493
3494 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3495 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3496 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3497 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3498 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3499 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3500 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3501
3502 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3503 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3504 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3505 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3506 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3507 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3508 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3509
3510 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3511 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3512 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3513 configuration file.
3514
3515 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3516 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3517 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3518 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3519 specified by this option.
3520
3521
3522 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3523 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3524 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3525 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3526 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3527 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3528 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3529 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3530
3531 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3532 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3533 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3534 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3535 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3536 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3537 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3538
3539 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3540 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3541 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3542 synonymous:
3543 .code
3544 exim -DABC ...
3545 exim -DABC= ...
3546 .endd
3547 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3548 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3549 example:
3550 .code
3551 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3552 .endd
3553 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3554
3555
3556 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3557 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3558 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3559 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3560 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3561 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3562 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3563 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3564 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3565 return code.
3566
3567 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3568 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3569 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3570 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3571 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3572 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3573 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3574 are:
3575 .display
3576 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3577 &`auth `& authenticators
3578 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3579 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3580 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3581 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3582 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3583 &`filter `& filter handling
3584 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3585 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3586 &`ident `& ident lookup
3587 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3588 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3589 &`load `& system load checks
3590 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3591 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3592 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3593 &`memory `& memory handling
3594 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3595 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3596 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3597 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3598 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3599 &`retry `& retry handling
3600 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3601 &`route `& address routing
3602 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3603 &`tls `& TLS logic
3604 &`transport `& transports
3605 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3606 &`verify `& address verification logic
3607 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3608 .endd
3609 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3610 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3611 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3612 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3613 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3614 turn everything off.
3615
3616 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3617 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3618 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3619 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3620 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3621 rather than stderr.
3622
3623 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3624 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3625 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3626 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3627 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3628 run in parallel.
3629
3630 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3631 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3632 in processing.
3633
3634 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3635 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3636
3637 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3638 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3639 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3640 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3641 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3642 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3643
3644 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3645 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3646 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3647 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3648 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3649
3650 .vitem &%-E%&
3651 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3652 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3653 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3654 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3655 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3656 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3657 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3658 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3659 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3660
3661 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3662 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3663 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3664 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3665 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3666 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3667
3668 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3669 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3670 .cindex "sender" "name"
3671 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3672 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3673 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3674 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3675 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3676 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3677
3678 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3679 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3680 .cindex "sender" "address"
3681 .cindex "address" "sender"
3682 .cindex "trusted users"
3683 .cindex "envelope sender"
3684 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3685 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3686 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3687 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3688 users to use it.
3689
3690 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3691 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3692 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3693 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3694 domain.
3695
3696 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3697 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3698 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3699 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3700 examples of shell commands:
3701 .code
3702 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3703 exim -f "" user@domain
3704 .endd
3705 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3706 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3707 &%-bv%& options.
3708
3709 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3710 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3711 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3712 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3713
3714 White
3715 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3716 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3717 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3718 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3719 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3720 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3721
3722 .vitem &%-G%&
3723 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3724 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3725 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3726 .code
3727 control = suppress_local_fixups
3728 .endd
3729 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3730 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3731 in future.
3732
3733 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3734 this option.
3735
3736 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3737 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3738 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3739 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3740 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3741 headers.)
3742
3743 .vitem &%-i%&
3744 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3745 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3746 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3747 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3748 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3749 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3750 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3751
3752 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3753 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3754 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3755 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3756 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3757 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3758 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3759 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3760
3761 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3762
3763 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3764 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3765 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3766 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3767 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3768 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3769 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3770 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3771 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3772
3773 Retry
3774 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3775 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3776 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3777 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3778 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3779 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3780
3781 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3782 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3783 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3784 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3785
3786 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3787 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3788 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3789 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3790 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3791 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3792 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3793 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3794 can be used only by an admin user.
3795
3796 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3797 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3798 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3799 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3800 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3801 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3802 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3803 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3804 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3805 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3806 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3807
3808 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3809 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3810 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3812 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3813
3814 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3815 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3818 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3819
3820 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3821 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3824 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3825 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3826 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3827 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3828
3829 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3830 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3831 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3833 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3834 connection.
3835
3836 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3837 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3838 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3839 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3840 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3841
3842 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3843 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3844 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3845 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3846 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3847 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3848 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3849 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3850 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3851 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3852 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3853 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3854 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3855 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3856 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3857
3858 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3859 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3860 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3861 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3862 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3863 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3864 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3865 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3866 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3867 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3868
3869 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3870 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3871 .cindex "freezing messages"
3872 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3873 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3874 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3875 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3876 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3877 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3878 user.
3879
3880 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3881 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3882 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3883 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3884 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3885 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3886 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3887 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3888 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3889 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3890 user.
3891
3892 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3893 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3894 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3895 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3896 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3897 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3898 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3899
3900 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3901 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3902 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3903 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3904 .cindex "removing recipients"
3905 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3906 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3907 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3908 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3909 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3910 can be used only by an admin user.
3911
3912 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3913 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3914 .cindex "removing messages"
3915 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3916 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3917 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3918 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3919 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3920 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3921 placed on the queue.
3922
3923 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3924 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3925 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3926 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3927 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3928 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3929 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3930 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3931 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3932 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3933 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3934
3935 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3936 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3937 .cindex "thawing messages"
3938 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3939 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3940 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3941 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3942 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3943 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3944 by an admin user.
3945
3946 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3947 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3948 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3949 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3950 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3951 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3952
3953 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3954 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3955 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3956 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3957 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3958 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3959 only by an admin user.
3960
3961 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3962 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3963 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3964 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3965 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3966 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3967 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3968
3969 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3970 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3971 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3972 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3973 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3974 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3975
3976 .vitem &%-m%&
3977 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3978 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3979 treats it that way too.
3980
3981 .vitem &%-N%&
3982 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3983 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3984 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3985 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3986 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3987 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3988 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3989 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3990 than &"=>"&.
3991
3992 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3993 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3994 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3995 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3996 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3997 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3998 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3999 for that message.
4000
4001 .vitem &%-n%&
4002 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4003 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4004 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4005 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4006
4007 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4008 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4009 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4010 Exim.
4011
4012 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4013 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4014 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4015 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4016 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4017 description above.
4018
4019 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4020 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4021 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4022 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4023 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4024 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4025 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4026 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4027
4028 .vitem &%-odb%&
4029 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4030 .cindex "background delivery"
4031 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4032 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4033 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4034 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4035 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4036 processes to finish.
4037
4038 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4039 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4040 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4041 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4042
4043 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4044 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4045 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4046 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4047
4048 .vitem &%-odf%&
4049 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4050 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4051 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4052 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4053 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4054 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4055 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4056
4057 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4058 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4059 during deliveries.
4060
4061 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4062 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4063
4064 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4065 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4066 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4067 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4068
4069
4070 .vitem &%-odi%&
4071 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4072 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4073 Sendmail.
4074
4075 .vitem &%-odq%&
4076 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4077 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4078 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4079 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4080 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4081 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4082 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4083 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4084 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4085 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4086 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4087 forces queueing.
4088
4089 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4090 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4091 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4092 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4093 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4094 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4095 configuration file is in effect.
4096
4097 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4098 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4099 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4100 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4101 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4102 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4103 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4104 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4105 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4106 &%-qq%& option.
4107
4108 .vitem &%-oee%&
4109 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4110 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4111 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4112 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4113 message.
4114
4115 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4116 Provided
4117 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4118 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4119 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4120 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4121
4122 .vitem &%-oem%&
4123 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4124 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4125 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4126 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4127 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4128 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4129
4130 .vitem &%-oep%&
4131 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4132 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4133 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4134 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4135 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4136 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4137
4138 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4139 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4140 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4141 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4142 effect as &%-oep%&.
4143
4144 .vitem &%-oew%&
4145 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4146 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4147 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4148 effect as &%-oem%&.
4149
4150 .vitem &%-oi%&
4151 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4152 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4153 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4154 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4155 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4156 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4157 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4158
4159 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4160 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4161 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4162
4163 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4164 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4165 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4166 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4167 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4168 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4169 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4170 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4171
4172 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4173 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4174 .code
4175 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4176 .endd
4177 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4178 followed by a colon and the port number:
4179 .code
4180 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4181 .endd
4182 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4183 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4184 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4185 whichever one is last.
4186
4187 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4188 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4189 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4190 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4191 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4192 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4193 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4194 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4195
4196 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4197 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4198 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4199 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4200 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4201 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4202 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4203 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4204
4205 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4206 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4207 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4208 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4209 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4210 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4211 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4212 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4213 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4214 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4215
4216 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4217 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4218 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4219 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4220 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4221 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4222 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4223
4224 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4225 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4226 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4227 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4228 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4229 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4230 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4231 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4232 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4233 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4234 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4235 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4236
4237 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4238 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4239 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4240 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4241 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4242 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4243 uses the name it is given.
4244
4245 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4246 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4247 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4248 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4249 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4250 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4251 used, when there is no default.
4252
4253 .vitem &%-om%&
4254 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4255 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4256 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4257 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4258 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4259
4260 .vitem &%-oo%&
4261 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4262 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4263 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4264 whatever that means.
4265
4266 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4267 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4268 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4269 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4270 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4271 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4272 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4273 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4274 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4275
4276 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4277 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4278 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4279 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4280 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4281 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4282 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4283
4284 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4285 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4286 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4287 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4288 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4289 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4290 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4291 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4292
4293 .vitem &%-ov%&
4294 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4295 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4296
4297 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4298 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4299 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4300 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4301 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4302 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4303 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4304 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4305 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4306 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4307
4308 .vitem &%-pd%&
4309 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4310 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4311 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4312 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4313 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4314 needed.
4315
4316 .vitem &%-ps%&
4317 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4318 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4319 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4320 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4321 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4322 started.
4323
4324 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4325 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4326 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4327 .display
4328 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4329 .endd
4330 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4331 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4332 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4333 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4334 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4335
4336 .vitem &%-q%&
4337 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4338 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4339 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4340 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4341 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4342 and &%-S%& options).
4343
4344 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4345 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4346 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4347 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4348 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4349 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4350
4351 If
4352 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4353 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4354 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4355 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4356 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4357 proceeding.
4358
4359 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4360 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4361 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4362 this to be repeated periodically.
4363
4364 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4365 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4366 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4367 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4368
4369 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4370 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4371 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4372
4373 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4374 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4375 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4376 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4377
4378 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4379 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4380 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4381 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4382 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4383 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4384 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4385 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4386 transports are run.
4387
4388 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4389 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4390 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4391 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4392 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4393 delivered down a single SMTP
4394 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4395 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4396 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4397 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4398 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4399 intermittently.
4400
4401 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4402 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4403 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4404 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4405 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4406 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4407 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4408
4409 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4410 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4411 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4412 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4413 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4414 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4415 their retry times are tried.
4416
4417 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4418 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4419 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4420 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4421 frozen or not.
4422
4423 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4424 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4425 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4426 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4427 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4428 for later delivery.
4429
4430 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4431 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4432 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4433 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4434 starting message id. For example:
4435 .code
4436 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4437 .endd
4438 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4439 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4440 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4441 .code
4442 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4443 .endd
4444 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4445 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4446 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4447 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4448 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4449 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4450
4451 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4452 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4453 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4454 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4455 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4456 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4457 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4458 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4459 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4460 .code
4461 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4462 .endd
4463 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4464 process every 30 minutes.
4465
4466 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4467 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4468
4469 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4470 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4471 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4472 compatibility.
4473
4474 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4475 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4476 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4477
4478 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4479 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4480 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4481 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4482 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4483 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4484 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4485 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4486 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4487
4488 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4489 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4490 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4491 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4492 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4493 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4494
4495 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4496 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4497 .code
4498 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4499 .endd
4500 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4501 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4502 applied to each queue run.
4503
4504 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4505 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4506 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4507 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4508 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4509 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4510 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4511 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4512 address will be skipped.
4513
4514 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4515 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4516 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4517 &'ff'& is present.
4518
4519 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4520 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4521 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4522 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4523 an arbitrary command instead.
4524
4525 .vitem &%-r%&
4526 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4527 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4528
4529 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4530 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4531 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4532 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4533 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4534 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4535 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4536 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4537
4538 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4539 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4540 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4541 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4542 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4543
4544 .vitem &%-t%&
4545 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4546 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4547 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4548 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4549 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4550 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4551 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4552 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4553 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4554 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4555
4556 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4557 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4558 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4559 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4560 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4561 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4562 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4563 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4564 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4565 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4566 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4567
4568 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4569 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4570 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4571 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4572 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4573 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4574
4575 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4576 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4577 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4578 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4579 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4580 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4581 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4582 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4583 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4584
4585 .vitem &%-ti%&
4586 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4587 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4588 compatibility with Sendmail.
4589
4590 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4591 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4592 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4593 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4594 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4595 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4596 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4597 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4598
4599
4600 .vitem &%-U%&
4601 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4602 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4603 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4604 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4605 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4606 set. Exim ignores this option.
4607
4608 .vitem &%-v%&
4609 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4610 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4611 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4612 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4613 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4614 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4615 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4616 unconditional.
4617
4618 .vitem &%-x%&
4619 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4620 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4621 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4622 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4623 this option.
4624
4625 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4626 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4627 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4628 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4629 .endlist
4630
4631 .ecindex IIDclo1
4632 .ecindex IIDclo2
4633
4634
4635 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4636 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4637 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4638 . creates a man page for the options.
4639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4640
4641 .literal xml
4642 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4643 .literal off
4644
4645
4646
4647
4648
4649 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4650 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4651
4652
4653 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4654 "The runtime configuration file"
4655
4656 .cindex "run time configuration"
4657 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4658 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4659 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4660 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4661 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4662 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4663 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4664 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4665 control.
4666
4667 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4668 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4669 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4670 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4671 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4672 actually alter the string.
4673
4674 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4675 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4676 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4677 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4678 existing file in the list.
4679
4680 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4681 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4682 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4683 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4684 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4685 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4686 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4687 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4688 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4689 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4690 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4691
4692 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4693 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4694 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4695 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4696 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4697
4698 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4699 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4700 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4701 compromise the Exim user account.
4702
4703 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4704 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4705 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4706 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4707 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4708 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4709 configuration.
4710
4711
4712
4713 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4714 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4715 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4716 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4717 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4718 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4719 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4720 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4721 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4722 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4723 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4724
4725 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4726 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4727 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4728 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4729 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4730 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4731 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4732 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4733 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4734 &%-M%&).
4735
4736 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4737 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4738 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4739 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4740 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4741
4742 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4743 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4744 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4745 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4746 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4747 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4748
4749 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4750 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4751 necessarily be discarded.
4752 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4753 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4754 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4755 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4756 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4757 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4758
4759 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4760 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4761 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4762 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4763 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4764 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4765 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4766
4767 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4768 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4769 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4770
4771
4772
4773 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4774 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4775 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4776 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4777 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4778 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4779 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4780 optional parts are:
4781
4782 .ilist
4783 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4784 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4785 .next
4786 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4787 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4788 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4789 .next
4790 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4791 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4792 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4793 .next
4794 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4795 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4796 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4797 .next
4798 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4799 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4800 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4801 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4802 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4803 .next
4804 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4805 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4806 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4807 .next
4808 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4809 want to use this feature, you must set
4810 .code
4811 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4812 .endd
4813 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4814 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4815 .endlist
4816
4817 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4818 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4819 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4820 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4821
4822 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4823 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4824 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4825 and does not introduce a comment.
4826
4827 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4828 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4829 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4830 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4831 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4832
4833 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4834 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4835 change settings as required.
4836
4837 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4838 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4839 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4840 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4841 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4842 described.
4843
4844
4845
4846 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4847 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4848 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4849 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4850 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4851 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4852 using this syntax:
4853 .display
4854 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4855 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4856 .endd
4857 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4858 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4859 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4860 name is required.
4861
4862 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4863 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4864 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4865 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4866
4867 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4868 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4869 for example:
4870 .code
4871 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4872 .include /some/file
4873 .endd
4874 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4875 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4876 inclusion appears.
4877
4878
4879
4880 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4881 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4882 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4883 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4884 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4885 definition, and must be of the form
4886 .display
4887 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4888 .endd
4889 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4890 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4891 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4892 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4893 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4894
4895 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4896 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4897 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4898
4899 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4900 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4901 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4902 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4903 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4904 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4905 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4906 define
4907 .display
4908 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4909 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4910 .endd
4911 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4912 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4913 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4914 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4915 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4916 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4917
4918
4919 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4920 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4921 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4922 &'='&. For example:
4923 .code
4924 MAC = initial value
4925 ...
4926 MAC == updated value
4927 .endd
4928 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4929 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4930 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4931 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4932 .code
4933 MAC = initial value
4934 ...
4935 MAC == MAC and something added
4936 .endd
4937 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4938 from a number of other files.
4939
4940 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4941 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4942 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4943 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4944 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4945 file to be ignored.
4946
4947
4948
4949 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4950 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4951 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4952 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4953 .code
4954 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4955 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4956 .endd
4957 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4958 .code
4959 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4960 .endd
4961 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4962 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4963 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4964
4965
4966 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4967 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4968 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4969 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4970 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4971 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4972 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4973
4974 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4975 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4976 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4977 line. Thus:
4978 .code
4979 .ifdef AAA
4980 message_size_limit = 50M
4981 .else
4982 message_size_limit = 100M
4983 .endif
4984 .endd
4985 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4986 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4987 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4988 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4989
4990 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4991 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4992 in this line"& will always be true.
4993
4994 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4995 to clarify complicated nestings.
4996
4997
4998
4999 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5000 .cindex "common option syntax"
5001 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5002 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5003 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5004 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5005 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5006 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5007 space) and then the value. For example:
5008 .code
5009 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5010 .endd
5011 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5012 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5013 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5014 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5015 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5016 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5017 word &"hide"&. For example:
5018 .code
5019 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5020 .endd
5021 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5022 .code
5023 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5024 .endd
5025 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5026 all instances of the same driver.
5027
5028 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5029 that are found in option settings.
5030
5031
5032 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5033 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5034 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5035 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5036 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5037 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5038 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5039 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5040 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5041 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5042 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5043 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5044 .code
5045 queue_only
5046 queue_only = true
5047 .endd
5048 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5049 .code
5050 no_queue_only
5051 queue_only = false
5052 .endd
5053 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5054
5055
5056
5057
5058 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5059 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5060 .cindex "format" "integer"
5061 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5062 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5063 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5064 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5065 hexadecimal number.
5066
5067 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5068 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5069 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5070 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5071 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5072 used.
5073
5074
5075 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5076 .cindex "integer format"
5077 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5078 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5079 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5080 Such options are always output in octal.
5081
5082
5083 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5084 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5085 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5086 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5087 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5088
5089
5090
5091 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5092 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5093 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5094 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5095 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5096
5097 .table2 30pt
5098 .irow &%s%& seconds
5099 .irow &%m%& minutes
5100 .irow &%h%& hours
5101 .irow &%d%& days
5102 .irow &%w%& weeks
5103 .endtable
5104
5105 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5106 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5107 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5108
5109
5110
5111 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5112 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5113 .cindex "format" "string"
5114 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5115 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5116 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5117 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5118 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5119 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5120 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5121 therefore equivalent:
5122 .code
5123 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5124 trusted_users = uucp:\
5125 # This comment line is ignored
5126 mail
5127 .endd
5128 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5129 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5130 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5131 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5132 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5133
5134 .table2 100pt
5135 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5136 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5137 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5138 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5139 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5140 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5141 character"
5142 .endtable
5143
5144 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5145 character, that character replaces the pair.
5146
5147 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5148 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5149 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5150 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5151 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5152 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5153
5154
5155 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5156 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5157 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5158 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5159 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5160 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5161 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5162 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5163 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5164 within a quoted configuration string.
5165
5166
5167 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5168 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5169 .cindex "format" "user name"
5170 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5171 .cindex "format" "group name"
5172 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5173 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5174 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5175 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5176
5177
5178 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5179 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5180 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5181 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5182 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5183 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5184 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5185 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5186 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5187 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5188 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5189
5190 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5191 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5192 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5193 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5194 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5195 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5196 example, the list
5197 .code
5198 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5199 .endd
5200 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5201
5202 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5203 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5204 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5205 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5206
5207 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5208 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5209 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5210 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5211 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5212 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5213 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5214 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5215 .code
5216 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5217 .endd
5218 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5219 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5220 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5221
5222 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5223 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5224 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5225 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5226 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5227 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5228 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5229 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5230 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5231 .code
5232 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5233 .endd
5234 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5235 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5236 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5237 the value in quotes. For example:
5238 .code
5239 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5240 .endd
5241 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5242 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5243 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5244 enclosing an empty list item.
5245
5246
5247
5248 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5249 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5250 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5251 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5252 .code
5253 senders = user@domain :
5254 .endd
5255 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5256 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5257 items, the second of which is empty:
5258 .code
5259 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5260 .endd
5261 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5262 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5263 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5264 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5265 .code
5266 senders = :
5267 .endd
5268 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5269 is at the end of the list.
5270
5271
5272
5273
5274 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5275 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5276 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5277 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5278 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5279 a sequence of lines like this:
5280 .display
5281 <&'instance name'&>:
5282 <&'option'&>
5283 ...
5284 <&'option'&>
5285 .endd
5286 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5287 followed by three options settings:
5288 .code
5289 localuser:
5290 driver = accept
5291 check_local_user
5292 transport = local_delivery
5293 .endd
5294 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5295 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5296 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5297 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5298 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5299 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5300
5301 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5302 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5303
5304 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5305 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5306 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5307 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5308 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5309 server.
5310
5311 .cindex "generic options"
5312 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5313 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5314 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5315 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5316 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5317 .cindex "private options"
5318 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5319 they all have default values.
5320
5321 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5322 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5323 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5324
5325 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5326 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5327 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5328 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5329 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5330 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5331 configuration lines:
5332 .code
5333 remote_smtp:
5334 driver = smtp
5335 .endd
5336 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5337 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5338 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5339 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5340 thus:
5341 .code
5342 special_smtp:
5343 driver = smtp
5344 port = 1234
5345 command_timeout = 10s
5346 .endd
5347 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5348 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5349 lines.
5350
5351 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5352 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5353 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5354 option.
5355
5356
5357
5358
5359
5360
5361 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5362 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5363
5364 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5365 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5366 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5367 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5368 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5369 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5370 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5371 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5372 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5373 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5374 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5375
5376
5377
5378 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5379 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5380 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5381 the line
5382 .code
5383 # primary_hostname =
5384 .endd
5385 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5386 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5387 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5388 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5389
5390 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5391 .code
5392 domainlist local_domains = @
5393 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5394 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5395 .endd
5396 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5397 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5398 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5399 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5400
5401 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5402 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5403 on the local host.
5404
5405 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5406 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5407 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5408 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5409 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5410 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5411
5412 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5413 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5414 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5415 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5416 domain is permitted.
5417
5418 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5419 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5420 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5421 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5422 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5423 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5424
5425 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5426 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5427 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5428
5429 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5430 .code
5431 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5432 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5433 .endd
5434 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5435 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5436 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5437 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5438 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5439 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5440 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5441 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5442 contents of a message to be checked.
5443
5444 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5445 .code
5446 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5447 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5448 .endd
5449 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5450 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5451 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5452 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5453
5454 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5455 .code
5456 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5457 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5458 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5459 .endd
5460 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5461 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5462 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5463 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5464 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5465 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5466 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5467
5468 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5469 .code
5470 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5471 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5472 .endd
5473 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5474 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5475 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5476 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5477 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5478 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5479 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5480 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5481 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5482 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5483 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5484 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5485 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5486 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5487 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5488 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5489
5490 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5491 .code
5492 # qualify_domain =
5493 # qualify_recipient =
5494 .endd
5495 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5496 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5497 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5498 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5499 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5500 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5501
5502 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5503 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5504 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5505 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5506 .code
5507 # allow_domain_literals
5508 .endd
5509 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5510 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5511 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5512 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5513 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5514 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5515
5516 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5517 .code
5518 never_users = root
5519 .endd
5520 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5521 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5522 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5523 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5524 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5525 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5526 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5527 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5528
5529 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5530 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5531 line,
5532 .code
5533 host_lookup = *
5534 .endd
5535 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5536 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5537 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5538 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5539 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5540 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5541 unreachable.
5542
5543 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5544 1413 (hence their names):
5545 .code
5546 rfc1413_hosts = *
5547 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5548 .endd
5549 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5550 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5551 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5552 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5553 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5554 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5555 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5556
5557 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5558 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5559 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5560 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5561 .code
5562 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5563 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5564 .endd
5565 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5566 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5567
5568 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5569 .code
5570 # percent_hack_domains =
5571 .endd
5572 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5573 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5574 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5575
5576 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5577 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5578 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5579 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5580 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5581 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5582 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5583 always bounce messages.
5584 .code
5585 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5586 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5587 .endd
5588 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5589 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5590 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5591 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5592 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5593
5594
5595
5596 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5597 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5598 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5599 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5600 It starts with the line
5601 .code
5602 begin acl
5603 .endd
5604 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5605 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5606 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5607
5608 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5609 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5610 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5611 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5612 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5613 result of the ACL processing.
5614 .code
5615 acl_check_rcpt:
5616 .endd
5617 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5618 ACL, and names it.
5619 .code
5620 accept hosts = :
5621 .endd
5622 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5623 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5624 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5625 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5626 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5627 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5628
5629 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5630 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5631 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5632 manner.
5633 .code
5634 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5635 domains = +local_domains
5636 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5637
5638 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5639 domains = !+local_domains
5640 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5641 .endd
5642 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5643 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5644 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5645 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5646 in Internet mail addresses.
5647
5648 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5649 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5650 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5651 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5652 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5653 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5654 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5655 policy of being as safe as possible.
5656
5657 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5658 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5659 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5660 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5661 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5662 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5663
5664 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5665 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5666 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5667 have to modify this rule.
5668
5669 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5670 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5671 common convention of local parts constructed as
5672 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5673 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5674 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5675 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5676 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5677 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5678
5679 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5680 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5681 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5682 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5683 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5684 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5685 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5686 .code
5687 accept local_parts = postmaster
5688 domains = +local_domains
5689 .endd
5690 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5691 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5692 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5693 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5694 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5695
5696 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5697 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5698 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5699 .code
5700 require verify = sender
5701 .endd
5702 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5703 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5704 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5705 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5706 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5707 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5708 discusses the details of address verification.
5709 .code
5710 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5711 control = submission
5712 .endd
5713 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5714 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5715 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5716 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5717 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5718 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5719 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5720 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5721 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5722 .code
5723 accept authenticated = *
5724 control = submission
5725 .endd
5726 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5727 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5728 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5729 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5730 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5731 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5732 .code
5733 require message = relay not permitted
5734 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5735 .endd
5736 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5737 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5738 .code
5739 require verify = recipient
5740 .endd
5741 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5742 fails, the address is rejected.
5743 .code
5744 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5745 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5746 # $dnslist_text
5747 # dnslists = black.list.example
5748 #
5749 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5750 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5751 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5752 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5753 .endd
5754 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5755 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5756 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5757 line.
5758 .code
5759 # require verify = csa
5760 .endd
5761 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5762 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5763 records.
5764 .code
5765 accept
5766 .endd
5767 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5768 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5769 .code
5770 acl_check_data:
5771 .endd
5772 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5773 of this ACL are commented out:
5774 .code
5775 # deny malware = *
5776 # message = This message contains a virus \
5777 # ($malware_name).
5778 .endd
5779 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5780 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5781 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5782 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5783 .code
5784 # warn spam = nobody
5785 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5786 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5787 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5788 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5789 .endd
5790 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5791 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5792 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5793 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5794 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5795 whatever the spam score.
5796 .code
5797 accept
5798 .endd
5799 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5800
5801
5802 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5803 .cindex "default" "routers"
5804 .cindex "routers" "default"
5805 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5806 by the line
5807 .code
5808 begin routers
5809 .endd
5810 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5811 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5812 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5813 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5814 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5815 .code
5816 # domain_literal:
5817 # driver = ipliteral
5818 # domains = !+local_domains
5819 # transport = remote_smtp
5820 .endd
5821 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5822 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5823 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5824 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5825 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5826 .code
5827 dnslookup:
5828 driver = dnslookup
5829 domains = ! +local_domains
5830 transport = remote_smtp
5831 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5832 no_more
5833 .endd
5834 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5835 domains. This is specified by the line
5836 .code
5837 domains = ! +local_domains
5838 .endd
5839 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5840 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5841 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5842 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5843 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5844 passed on to the following routers.
5845
5846 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5847 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5848 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5849 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5850 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5851
5852 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5853 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5854 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5855 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5856 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5857 the address fails and is bounced.
5858
5859 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5860 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5861 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5862 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5863 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5864 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5865 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5866 out.
5867 .code
5868 system_aliases:
5869 driver = redirect
5870 allow_fail
5871 allow_defer
5872 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5873 # user = exim
5874 file_transport = address_file
5875 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5876 .endd
5877 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5878 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5879 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5880 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5881 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5882 the next router.
5883
5884 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5885 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5886 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5887 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5888 .code
5889 userforward:
5890 driver = redirect
5891 check_local_user
5892 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5893 # local_part_suffix_optional
5894 file = $home/.forward
5895 # allow_filter
5896 no_verify
5897 no_expn
5898 check_ancestor
5899 file_transport = address_file
5900 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5901 reply_transport = address_reply
5902 .endd
5903 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5904 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5905 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5906 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5907 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5908 namely:
5909 .code
5910 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5911 # local_part_suffix_optional
5912 .endd
5913 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5914 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5915 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5916 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5917 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5918 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5919 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5920
5921 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5922 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5923 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5924 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5925
5926 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5927 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5928 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5929 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5930 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5931 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5932 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5933
5934 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5935 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5936 There are two reasons for doing this:
5937
5938 .olist
5939 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5940 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5941 unnecessary work.
5942 .next
5943 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5944 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5945 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5946 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5947 this time.
5948 .endlist
5949
5950 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5951 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5952 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5953 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5954
5955 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5956 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5957 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5958 .code
5959 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5960 .endd
5961 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5962 transport.
5963 .code
5964 localuser:
5965 driver = accept
5966 check_local_user
5967 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5968 # local_part_suffix_optional
5969 transport = local_delivery
5970 .endd
5971 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5972 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5973 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5974 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5975 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5976
5977
5978 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5979 .cindex "default" "transports"
5980 .cindex "transports" "default"
5981 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5982 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5983 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5984 .code
5985 begin transports
5986 .endd
5987 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5988 .code
5989 remote_smtp:
5990 driver = smtp
5991 .endd
5992 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5993 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5994 .code
5995 local_delivery:
5996 driver = appendfile
5997 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5998 delivery_date_add
5999 envelope_to_add
6000 return_path_add
6001 # group = mail
6002 # mode = 0660
6003 .endd
6004 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6005 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6006 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6007 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6008 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6009 show how this can be done.
6010
6011 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6012 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6013 similarly-named options above.
6014 .code
6015 address_pipe:
6016 driver = pipe
6017 return_output
6018 .endd
6019 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6020 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6021 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6022 sender.
6023 .code
6024 address_file:
6025 driver = appendfile
6026 delivery_date_add
6027 envelope_to_add
6028 return_path_add
6029 .endd
6030 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6031 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6032 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6033 .code
6034 address_reply:
6035 driver = autoreply
6036 .endd
6037 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6038 filter files.
6039
6040
6041
6042 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6043 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6044 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6045 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6046 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6047 introduced by the line
6048 .code
6049 begin retry
6050 .endd
6051 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6052 errors:
6053 .code
6054 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6055 .endd
6056 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6057 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6058 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6059 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6060
6061 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6062 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6063 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6064
6065
6066 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6067 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6068 .code
6069 begin rewrite
6070 .endd
6071 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6072 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6073
6074
6075
6076 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6077 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6078 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6079 .code
6080 begin authenticators
6081 .endd
6082 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6083 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6084 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6085 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6086 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6087 to support most MUA software.
6088
6089 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6090 .code
6091 #PLAIN:
6092 # driver = plaintext
6093 # server_set_id = $auth2
6094 # server_prompts = :
6095 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6096 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6097 .endd
6098 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6099 .code
6100 #LOGIN:
6101 # driver = plaintext
6102 # server_set_id = $auth1
6103 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6104 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6105 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6106 .endd
6107
6108 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6109 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6110 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6111 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6112 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6113 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6114 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6115 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6116
6117 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6118 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6119 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6120 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6121
6122 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6123 usercode and password are in different positions.
6124 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6125
6126 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6127
6128
6129
6130 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6132
6133 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6134
6135 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6136 .cindex "PCRE"
6137 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6138 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6139 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6140 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6141 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6142 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6143
6144 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6145 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6146 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6147 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6148 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6149 case-insensitive.
6150
6151 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6152 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6153 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6154 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6155 .code
6156 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6157 .endd
6158 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6159 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6160 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6161 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6162 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6163 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6164 matched.
6165
6166 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6167 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6168 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6169 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6170 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6171 match anywhere in the subject string.
6172
6173 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6174 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6175 .code
6176 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6177 .endd
6178 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6179 You need to use:
6180 .code
6181 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6182 .endd
6183 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6184 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6185
6186
6187
6188 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6190
6191 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6192 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6193 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6194 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6195 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6196 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6197
6198 .olist
6199 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6200 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6201 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6202 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6203 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6204 .next
6205 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6206 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6207 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6208 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6209 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6210 .endlist
6211
6212 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6213 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6214 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6215 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6216 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6217 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6218
6219 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6220 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6221 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6222 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6223 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6224 .code
6225 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6226 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6227 .endd
6228 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6229 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6230 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6231 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6232 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6233 .code
6234 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6235 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6236 .endd
6237 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6238 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6239
6240 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6241 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6242 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6243 .code
6244 domain1:
6245 domain2:
6246 .endd
6247 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6248 matches the list item.
6249
6250 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6251 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6252 .code
6253 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6254 .endd
6255 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6256 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6257 causes a second lookup to occur.
6258
6259 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6260 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6261 lookup is permitted.
6262
6263
6264 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6265 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6266 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6267 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6268
6269 .ilist
6270 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6271 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6272 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6273 .next
6274 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6275 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6276 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6277 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6278 .endlist
6279
6280 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6281 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6282 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6283 .code
6284 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6285 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6286 .endd
6287 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6288 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6289 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6290
6291
6292
6293
6294 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6295 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6296 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6297 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6298
6299 .ilist
6300 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6301 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6302 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6303 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6304 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6305 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6306 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6307 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6308 be found in several places:
6309 .display
6310 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6311 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6312 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6313 .endd
6314 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6315 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6316 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6317 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6318 .next
6319 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6320 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6321 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6322 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6323 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6324 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6325 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6326
6327 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6328 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6329 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6330 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6331 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6332 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6333 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6334 .next
6335 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6336 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6337 .cindex "sasldb2"
6338 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6339 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6340 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6341 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6342 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6343 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6344 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6345 .next
6346 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6347 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6348 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6349 .cindex "Courier"
6350 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6351 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6352 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6353 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6354 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6355 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6356 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6357 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6358 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6359 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6360 .next
6361 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6362 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6363 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6364 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6365 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6366 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6367 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6368 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6369 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6370 .next
6371 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6372 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6373 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6374 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6375 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6376 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6377 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6378 .code
6379 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6380 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6381 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6382 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6383 .endd
6384 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6385 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6386 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6387 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6388 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6389
6390 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6391 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6392 lookup types support only literal keys.
6393
6394 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6395 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6396 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6397 .next
6398 .cindex "linear search"
6399 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6400 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6401 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6402 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6403 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6404 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6405 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6406 in the file is used.
6407
6408 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6409 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6410 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6411 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6412 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6413 colon, for example:
6414 .code
6415 baduser: :fail:
6416 .endd
6417 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6418 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6419 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6420 wildcarding of any kind.
6421
6422 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6423 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6424 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6425 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6426 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6427 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6428 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6429 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6430 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6431
6432 .next
6433 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6434 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6435 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6436 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6437 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6438 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6439 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6440 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6441
6442 .next
6443 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6444 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6445 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6446 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6447 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6448 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6449 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6450 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6451 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6452
6453 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6454 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6455 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6456 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6457
6458 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6459 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6460
6461 .olist
6462 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6463 .code
6464 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6465 *fish data for anythingfish
6466 .endd
6467 .next
6468 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6469 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6470 .code
6471 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6472 .endd
6473 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6474 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6475 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6476 .code
6477 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6478 .endd
6479 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6480 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6481 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6482 .code
6483 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6484 .endd
6485
6486 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6487 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6488 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6489 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6490 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6491
6492 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6493 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6494 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6495 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6496 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6497
6498 .next
6499 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6500 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6501 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6502 example:
6503 .code
6504 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6505 .endd
6506 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6507 .endlist olist
6508
6509 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6510 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6511 be followed by optional colons.
6512
6513 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6514 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6515 lookup types support only literal keys.
6516 .endlist ilist
6517
6518
6519 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6520 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6521 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6522 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6523 many of them are given in later sections.
6524
6525 .ilist
6526 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6527 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6528 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6529 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6530 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6531 .next
6532 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6533 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6534 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6535 .next
6536 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6537 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6538 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6539 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6540 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6541 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6542 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6543 .next
6544 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6545 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6546 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6547 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6548 .next
6549 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6550 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6551 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6552 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6553 .next
6554 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6555 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6556 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6557 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6558 .next
6559 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6560 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6561 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6562 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6563 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6564 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6565 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6566 password value. For example:
6567 .code
6568 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6569 .endd
6570 .next
6571 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6572 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6573 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6574 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6575
6576 .next
6577 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6578 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6579 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6580 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6581
6582 .next
6583 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6584 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6585 .next
6586 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6587 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6588 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6589 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6590 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6591 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6592 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6593 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6594 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6595 .code
6596 require condition = \
6597 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6598 .endd
6599 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6600 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6601 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6602 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6603 .endlist
6604
6605
6606
6607 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6608 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6609 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6610 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6611 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6612 options such as a list of local domains.
6613
6614 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6615 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6616 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6617 or may give up altogether.
6618
6619
6620
6621 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6622 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6623 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6624 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6625 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6626 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6627 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6628 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6629
6630 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6631 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6632 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6633
6634 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6635 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6636 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6637
6638 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6639 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6640 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6641 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6642 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6643 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6644 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6645 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6646 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6647 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6648 .code
6649 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6650 .endd
6651 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6652 looks up these keys, in this order:
6653 .code
6654 jane@eyre.example
6655 *@eyre.example
6656 *
6657 .endd
6658 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6659 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6660 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6661 Exim move on to try the next key.
6662
6663
6664
6665 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6666 .cindex "partial matching"
6667 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6668 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6669 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6670 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6671 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6672 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6673 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6674 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6675 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6676 a key in a DBM file is
6677 .code
6678 *.dates.fict.example
6679 .endd
6680 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6681 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6682 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6683 file.
6684
6685 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6686 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6687 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6688
6689 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6690 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6691 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6692 partial matching keys
6693 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6694 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6695 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6696
6697 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6698 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6699 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6700 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6701 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6702 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6703 remains.
6704
6705 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6706 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6707 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6708 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6709 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6710 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6711 .code
6712 2250.dates.fict.example
6713 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6714 *.dates.fict.example
6715 *.fict.example
6716 .endd
6717 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6718 finishes.
6719
6720 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6721 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6722 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6723 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6724 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6725 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6726 .code
6727 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6728 .endd
6729 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6730 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6731 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6732 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6733 .code
6734 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6735 .endd
6736 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6737 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6738
6739 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6740 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6741 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6742
6743 .ilist
6744 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6745 .next
6746 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6747 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6748 .next
6749 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6750 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6751 for &"*"& on its own.
6752 .next
6753 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6754 .endlist
6755
6756
6757 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6758 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6759 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6760 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6761 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6762 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6763 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6764
6765 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6766 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6767 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6768 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6769 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6770
6771
6772
6773
6774 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6775 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6776 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6777 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6778 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6779 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6780 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6781
6782 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6783 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6784 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6785 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6786 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6787 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6788
6789 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6790 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6791 complete.
6792
6793
6794
6795
6796 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6797 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6798 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6799 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6800 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6801 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6802 .code
6803 [name=$local_part]
6804 .endd
6805 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6806 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6807 .code
6808 [name="$local_part"]
6809 .endd
6810 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6811 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6812 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6813 of the following form is provided:
6814 .code
6815 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6816 .endd
6817 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6818 .code
6819 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6820 .endd
6821 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6822 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6823 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6824
6825
6826
6827
6828 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6829 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6830 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6831 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6832 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6833 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6834 an expansion string could contain:
6835 .code
6836 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6837 .endd
6838 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6839 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6840 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6841 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6842
6843 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, TLSA and TXT,
6844 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6845 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6846 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6847 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6848 .code
6849 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6850 .endd
6851 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6852 altered and nothing is added.
6853
6854 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6855 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6856 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6857 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6858 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6859
6860 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6861 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6862 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6863 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6864 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6865 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6866 .code
6867 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6868 .endd
6869 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6870 white space is ignored.
6871
6872 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6873 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6874 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6875 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6876 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6877 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6878 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6879 .code
6880 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6881 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6882 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6883 .endd
6884 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6885 white space is ignored.
6886
6887 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6888 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6889 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6890 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6891 the pseudo-type MXH:
6892 .code
6893 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6894 .endd
6895 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6896 returned.
6897
6898 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6899 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6900 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6901 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6902 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6903 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6904 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6905 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6906 .code
6907 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6908 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6909 .endd
6910 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6911 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6912 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6913
6914 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6915 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6916 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6917 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6918 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6919 such a list.
6920
6921 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6922 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6923 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6924 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6925 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6926 result of a successful lookup such as:
6927 .code
6928 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6929 .endd
6930 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6931 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6932 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6933
6934 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6935 The pseudo-type A+ performs an A6 lookup (if configured) followed by an AAAA
6936 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
6937 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
6938 .code
6939 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
6940 .endd
6941
6942
6943 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6944 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6945 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6946 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6947 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6948 .code
6949 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6950 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6951 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6952 .endd
6953 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6954 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6955 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6956 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6957
6958 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6959 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6960 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6961
6962 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6963 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6964 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6965 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6966 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6967 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6968 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6969 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6970 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6971 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6972 .code
6973 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6974 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6975 .endd
6976 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6977 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6978
6979
6980
6981
6982 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6983 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6984 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6985 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6986 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6987 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6988 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6989 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6990 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6991 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6992 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6993 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6994 .code
6995 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6996 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6997 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6998 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6999 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7000 .endd
7001 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7002 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7003
7004 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7005 the way they handle the results of a query:
7006
7007 .ilist
7008 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7009 gives an error.
7010 .next
7011 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7012 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7013 .next
7014 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7015 from all of them are returned.
7016 .endlist
7017
7018
7019 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7020 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7021 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7022 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7023
7024
7025 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7026 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7027 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7028 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7029 .code
7030 data = ${lookup ldap \
7031 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7032 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7033 .endd
7034 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7035 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7036 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7037 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7038
7039 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7040 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7041 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7042
7043 .new
7044 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7045 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7046 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7047 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7048 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7049 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7050 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7051 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7052 &_exim.conf_&.
7053 .wen
7054
7055
7056 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7057 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7058 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7059 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7060 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7061 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7062
7063 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7064 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7065 the string:
7066 .code
7067 * => \2A
7068 ( => \28
7069 ) => \29
7070 \ => \5C
7071 .endd
7072 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7073 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7074 .code
7075 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7076 .endd
7077 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7078 .code
7079 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7080 .endd
7081 yields
7082 .code
7083 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7084 .endd
7085 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7086 .code
7087 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7088 .endd
7089 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7090 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7091 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7092 .code
7093 , + " \ < > ;
7094 .endd
7095 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7096 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7097 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7098 .code
7099 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7100 .endd
7101 yields
7102 .code
7103 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7104 .endd
7105 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7106 .code
7107 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7108 .endd
7109 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7110 authentication below.
7111
7112
7113 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7114 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7115 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7116 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7117 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7118 by starting it with
7119 .code
7120 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7121 .endd
7122 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7123 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7124 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7125 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7126 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7127 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7128 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7129 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7130 failures, and timeouts.
7131
7132 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7133 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7134 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7135 doubled. For example
7136 .code
7137 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7138 .endd
7139 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7140 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7141 the local host) is used.
7142
7143 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7144 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7145 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7146 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7147 not available.
7148
7149 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7150 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7151 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7152 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7153 .code
7154 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7155 .endd
7156 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7157 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7158 .code
7159 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7160 .endd
7161 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7162 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7163 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7164 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7165 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7166 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7167 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7168 backup host.
7169
7170 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7171 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7172 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7173
7174 .ilist
7175 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7176 interface.
7177 .next
7178 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7179 .endlist
7180
7181
7182 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7183 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7184
7185
7186
7187 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7188 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7189 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7190 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7191 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7192 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7193 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7194 them. The following names are recognized:
7195 .display
7196 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7197 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7198 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7199 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7200 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7201 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7202 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7203 .endd
7204 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7205 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7206 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7207 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7208
7209 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7210 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7211 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7212 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7213 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7214 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7215 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7216 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7217 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7218
7219 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7220 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7221
7222
7223 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7224 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7225 .code
7226 ${lookup ldap
7227 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7228 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7229 {$value}fail}
7230 .endd
7231 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7232 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7233 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7234 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7235
7236 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7237 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7238 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7239
7240 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7241 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7242 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7243 quoting has two advantages:
7244
7245 .ilist
7246 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7247 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7248 .next
7249 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7250 .endlist
7251
7252 For example, a setting such as
7253 .code
7254 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7255 .endd
7256 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7257
7258 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7259 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7260 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7261 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7262 .code
7263 PASS=${quote:$3}
7264 .endd
7265 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7266 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7267 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7268
7269
7270
7271 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7272 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7273 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7274 as a sequence of values, for example
7275 .code
7276 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7277 .endd
7278 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7279 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7280 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7281 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7282 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7283 directory.
7284
7285 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7286 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7287 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7288
7289 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7290 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7291 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7292 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7293 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7294 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7295 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7296
7297 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7298 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7299 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7300 .code
7301 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7302 value1.1, value1.2
7303
7304 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7305 value two
7306
7307 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7308 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7309
7310 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7311 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7312 .endd
7313 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7314 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7315 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7316 results of LDAP lookups.
7317
7318
7319
7320
7321 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7322 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7323 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7324 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7325 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7326 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7327 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7328 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7329 .code
7330 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7331 .endd
7332 might return the string
7333 .code
7334 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7335 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7336 .endd
7337 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7338 .code
7339 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7340 .endd
7341 would just return
7342 .code
7343 Martin Guerre
7344 .endd
7345 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7346 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7347 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7348
7349
7350
7351 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7352 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7353 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7354 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7355 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7356 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7357 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7358 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7359 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7360 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7361 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7362 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7363 might be
7364 .code
7365 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7366 {$value}fail}
7367 .endd
7368 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7369 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7370 .code
7371 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7372 {$value}}
7373 .endd
7374 might be
7375 .code
7376 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7377 .endd
7378 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7379 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7380 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7381 .code
7382 Mister X
7383 .endd
7384 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7385 with a newline between the data for each row.
7386
7387
7388 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7389 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7390 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7391 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7392 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7393 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7394 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7395 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7396 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7397 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7398 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7399 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7400 information.
7401 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7402 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7403 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7404 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7405 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7406 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7407 .code
7408 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7409 .endd
7410 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7411 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7412 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7413 .code
7414 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7415 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7416 .endd
7417 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7418 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7419 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7420 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7421 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7422 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7423
7424 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7425 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7426 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7427 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7428 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7429 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7430 characters are not special.
7431
7432 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7433 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7434 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7435 done by starting the query with
7436 .display
7437 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7438 .endd
7439 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7440 .olist
7441 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7442 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7443 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7444 taken from there.
7445 .next
7446 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7447 .endlist
7448 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7449 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7450 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7451
7452 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7453 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7454 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7455 like this:
7456 .code
7457 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7458 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7459 master/db/name/pw
7460 .endd
7461 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7462 .code
7463 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7464 .endd
7465 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7466 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7467 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7468 .code
7469 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7470 .endd
7471
7472
7473 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7474 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7475 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7476 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7477 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7478 .display
7479 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7480 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7481 .endd
7482 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7483 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7484
7485 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7486 the queries.
7487
7488 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7489 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7490
7491 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7492 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7493 is zero because no rows are affected.
7494
7495
7496 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7497 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7498 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7499 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7500 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7501 looks like this:
7502 .code
7503 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7504 .endd
7505 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7506 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7507 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7508
7509 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7510 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7511 affected.
7512
7513 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7514 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7515 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7516 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7517 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7518 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7519 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7520 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7521 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7522 .code
7523 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7524 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7525 .endd
7526 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7527 .code
7528 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7529 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7530 .endd
7531 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7532 quote, which it doubles.
7533
7534 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7535 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7536 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7537 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7538 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7539 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7540 option.
7541 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7542 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7543
7544
7545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7547
7548 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7549 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7550 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7551 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7552 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7553 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7554 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7555 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7556 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7557
7558 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7559 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7560 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7561 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7562
7563
7564
7565 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7566 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7567 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7568 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7569 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7570 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7571 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7572 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7573
7574
7575 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7576 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7577 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7578
7579 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7580 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7581 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7582 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7583 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7584 .code
7585 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7586 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7587 .endd
7588 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7589 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7590 senders based on the receiving domain.
7591
7592
7593
7594
7595 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7596 .cindex "list" "negation"
7597 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7598 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7599 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7600 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7601 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7602 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7603
7604 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7605 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7606 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7607 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7608 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7609 .code
7610 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7611 .endd
7612 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7613 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7614 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7615 .code
7616 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7617 .endd
7618 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7619 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7620 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7621
7622 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7623 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7624 item.
7625
7626
7627
7628 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7629 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7630 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7631 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7632 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7633 file names are not allowed,
7634 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7635 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7636 lines:
7637
7638 .ilist
7639 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7640 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7641 .next
7642 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7643 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7644 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7645 .code
7646 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7647 .endd
7648 .endlist
7649
7650 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7651 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7652 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7653 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7654
7655 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7656 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7657 .code
7658 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7659 .endd
7660 and the file contains the lines
7661 .code
7662 !a.b.c
7663 *.b.c
7664 .endd
7665 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7666 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7667
7668
7669
7670 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7671 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7672 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7673 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7674 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7675 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7676 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7677 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7678
7679 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7680 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7681 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7682 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7683
7684
7685
7686
7687 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7688 .cindex "named lists"
7689 .cindex "list" "named"
7690 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7691 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7692 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7693 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7694 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7695 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7696 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7697 .code
7698 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7699 .endd
7700 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7701 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7702 configured with the line
7703 .code
7704 domains = +local_domains
7705 .endd
7706 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7707 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7708 .code
7709 dnslookup:
7710 driver = dnslookup
7711 domains = ! +local_domains
7712 transport = remote_smtp
7713 no_more
7714 .endd
7715 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7716 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7717 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7718 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7719 .code
7720 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7721 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7722 .endd
7723 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7724 .code
7725 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7726 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7727 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7728 .endd
7729 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7730 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7731 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7732 .code
7733 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7734 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7735 .endd
7736 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7737 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7738 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7739 .code
7740 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7741 .endd
7742 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7743 referenced lists if you can.
7744
7745 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7746 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7747 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7748 .code
7749 domains = +local_domains
7750 .endd
7751 on several of your routers
7752 or in several ACL statements,
7753 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7754 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7755 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7756 the same each time they are referenced.
7757
7758 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7759 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7760 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7761 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7762
7763
7764
7765 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7766 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7767 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7768 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7769 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7770 write
7771 .code
7772 ALIST = host1 : host2
7773 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7774 .endd
7775 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7776 .code
7777 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7778 .endd
7779 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7780 list, and write
7781 .code
7782 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7783 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7784 .endd
7785 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7786 .code
7787 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7788 .endd
7789
7790
7791 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7792 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7793 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7794 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7795 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7796 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7797 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7798 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7799 message. For example:
7800 .code
7801 domainlist special_domains = \
7802 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7803 .endd
7804 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7805 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7806 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7807 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7808 same list each time.
7809
7810 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7811 cache the result anyway. For example:
7812 .code
7813 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7814 .endd
7815 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7816 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7817
7818
7819
7820 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7821 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7822 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7823 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7824 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7825
7826 .ilist
7827 .cindex "primary host name"
7828 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7829 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7830 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7831 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7832 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7833 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7834 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7835 differ only in their names.
7836 .next
7837 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7838 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7839 .cindex "domain literal"
7840 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7841 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7842 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7843 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7844 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7845 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7846 .next
7847 .cindex "@mx_any"
7848 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7849 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7850 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7851 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7852 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7853 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7854 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7855 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7856 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7857 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7858 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7859
7860 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7861 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7862 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7863 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7864 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7865
7866 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7867 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7868 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7869 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7870 on a router). For example:
7871 .code
7872 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7873 .endd
7874 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7875 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7876
7877 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7878 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7879 contain negative items.
7880
7881 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7882 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7883 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7884 .code
7885 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7886 an.other.domain : ...
7887 .endd
7888 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7889 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7890 .code
7891 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7892 an.other.domain ? ...
7893 .endd
7894 .next
7895 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7896 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7897 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7898 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7899 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7900 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7901 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7902 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7903 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7904 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
7905
7906 .next
7907 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7908 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7909 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7910 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7911 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7912 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7913 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7914 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7915 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7916
7917 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7918 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7919 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7920 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7921 expression by expansion, of course).
7922 .next
7923 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7924 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7925 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7926 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7927 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7928 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7929 .code
7930 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7931 .endd
7932 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7933 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7934 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7935 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7936 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7937 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7938 other statements in the same ACL.
7939
7940 .next
7941 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7942 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7943 .code
7944 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7945 .endd
7946 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7947 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7948
7949 .next
7950 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7951 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7952 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7953 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7954 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7955 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7956 expansion variable.
7957 .next
7958 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7959 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7960 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7961 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7962 .code
7963 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7964 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7965 .endd
7966 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7967 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7968 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7969 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7970 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7971 .next
7972 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7973 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7974 between the pattern and the domain.
7975 .endlist
7976
7977 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7978 .code
7979 domainlist funny_domains = \
7980 @ : \
7981 lib.unseen.edu : \
7982 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7983 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7984 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7985 nis;domains.byname : \
7986 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7987 .endd
7988 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7989 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7990 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7991 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7992 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7993 patterns earlier.
7994
7995
7996
7997 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7998 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7999 .cindex "list" "host list"
8000 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8001 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8002 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8003 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8004 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8005 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8006 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8007
8008
8009 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8010 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8011 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8012 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8013 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8014 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8015 not used.
8016
8017 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8018 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8019 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8020
8021
8022
8023 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8024 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8025 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8026 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8027 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8028 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8029 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8030 concerns.)
8031
8032 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8033 inspecting its IP address:
8034
8035 .ilist
8036 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8037 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8038 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8039 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8040 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8041 with the IP address of the subject host.
8042
8043 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8044 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8045 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8046 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8047 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8048
8049 .next
8050 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8051 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8052 domain name, as just described.
8053
8054 .next
8055 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8056 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8057 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8058 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8059 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8060 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8061 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8062 that can never match a client host.
8063
8064 .next
8065 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8066 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8067 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8068 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8069 .code
8070 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8071 accept hosts = @[]
8072 .endd
8073 .next
8074 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8075 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8076 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8077 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8078 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8079 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8080 significant end of the address.
8081
8082 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8083 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8084 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8085 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8086 .code
8087 192.168.23.236/31
8088 .endd
8089 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8090 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8091 matches.
8092
8093 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8094 .code
8095 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8096 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8097 .endd
8098 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8099 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8100 For example:
8101 .code
8102 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8103 .endd
8104 could make use of a file containing
8105 .code
8106 172.16.0.0/12
8107 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8108 .endd
8109 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8110 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8111 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8112 .code
8113 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8114 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8115 .endd
8116 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8117 list.
8118 .endlist
8119
8120
8121
8122 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8123 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8124 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8125 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8126 address, the pattern takes this form:
8127 .display
8128 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8129 .endd
8130 For example:
8131 .code
8132 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8133 .endd
8134 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8135 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8136 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8137 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8138 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8139 returned by the lookup is not used.
8140
8141 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8142 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8143 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8144 patterns of this form:
8145 .display
8146 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8147 .endd
8148 For example:
8149 .code
8150 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8151 .endd
8152 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8153 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8154 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8155 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8156 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8157
8158 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8159 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8160 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8161 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8162 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8163 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8164 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8165 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8166 addresses are always used.
8167
8168 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8169 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8170 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8171 configurations.
8172
8173 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8174 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8175 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8176 case the IP address is used on its own.
8177
8178
8179
8180 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8181 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8182 .cindex "unknown host name"
8183 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8184 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8185 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8186 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8187 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8188 above.)
8189
8190 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8191 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8192 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8193 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8194 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8195 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8196 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8197
8198 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8199 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8200
8201 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8202 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8203 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8204 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8205 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8206 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8207 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8208 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8209 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8210
8211 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8212 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8213
8214 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8215 .cindex "alias for host"
8216 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8217 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8218
8219 .ilist
8220 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8221 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8222 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8223 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8224 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8225 expression.
8226 .next
8227 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8228 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8229 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8230 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8231 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8232 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8233 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8234 example,
8235 .code
8236 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8237 .endd
8238 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8239 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8240 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8241 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8242 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8243 .code
8244 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8245 .endd
8246 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8247 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8248 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8249 required.
8250 .endlist
8251
8252
8253
8254
8255 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8256 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8257 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8258 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8259 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8260 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8261
8262 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8263 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8264
8265 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8266 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8267 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8268 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8269 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8270 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8271 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8272 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8273 not recognized in an indirected file).
8274
8275 .ilist
8276 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8277 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8278 .code
8279 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8280 .endd
8281 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8282 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8283
8284 .next
8285 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8286 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8287 example:
8288 .code
8289 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8290 192.168.4.5
8291 .endd
8292 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8293 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8294 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8295 .endlist
8296
8297 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8298 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8299 list.
8300
8301 To explain the host/ip processing logic a different way for the same ACL:
8302
8303 .ilist
8304 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8305 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8306 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8307 .code
8308 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8309 .endd
8310 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8311 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8312 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8313 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8314 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8315 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8316 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8317
8318 .next
8319 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8320 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8321 .code
8322 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8323 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8324 .endd
8325 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8326 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8327 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8328 this section.
8329 .endlist
8330
8331
8332
8333 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8334 "SECTtemdnserr"
8335 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8336 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8337 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8338 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8339 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8340 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8341 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8342 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8343 host lists such as whitelists.
8344
8345
8346
8347 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8348 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8349 .cindex "unknown host name"
8350 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8351 If a pattern is of the form
8352 .display
8353 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8354 .endd
8355 for example
8356 .code
8357 dbm;/host/accept/list
8358 .endd
8359 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8360 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8361 is not used.
8362
8363 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8364 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8365 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8366 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8367 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8368 lookup, both using the same file.
8369
8370
8371
8372 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8373 If a pattern is of the form
8374 .display
8375 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8376 .endd
8377 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8378 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8379 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8380 .code
8381 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8382 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8383 .endd
8384 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8385 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8386 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8387 operator.
8388
8389 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8390 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8391 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8392
8393 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8394 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8395 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8396 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8397 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8398 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8399
8400
8401
8402 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8403 "SECTmixwilhos"
8404 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8405 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8406 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8407 ACL you could have:
8408 .code
8409 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8410 .endd
8411 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8412 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8413 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8414 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8415 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8416 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8417
8418 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8419 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8420 .code
8421 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8422 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8423 .endd
8424 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8425 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8426
8427
8428
8429
8430
8431 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8432 .cindex "list" "address list"
8433 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8434 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8435 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8436 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8437 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8438 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8439 using this option setting:
8440 .code
8441 senders = :
8442 .endd
8443 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8444 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8445 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8446 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8447
8448 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8449 example:
8450 .code
8451 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8452 .endd
8453 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8454 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8455 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8456 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8457 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8458 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8459 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8460 .code
8461 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8462 *@+hostile_domains:\
8463 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8464 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8465 .endd
8466 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8467 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8468 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8469 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8470 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8471
8472 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8473 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8474 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8475 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8476 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8477 .code
8478 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8479 .endd
8480
8481 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8482 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8483 senders:
8484
8485 .ilist
8486 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8487 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8488 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8489 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8490 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8491 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8492 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8493 .code
8494 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8495 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8496 .endd
8497 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8498 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8499
8500 .next
8501 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8502 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8503 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8504 example:
8505 .code
8506 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8507 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8508 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8509 .endd
8510 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8511 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8512 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8513 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8514
8515 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8516 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8517 panic log.
8518 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8519 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8520 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8521 default. For example, with this lookup:
8522 .code
8523 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8524 .endd
8525 the file could contains lines like this:
8526 .code
8527 user1@domain1.example
8528 *@domain2.example
8529 .endd
8530 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8531 that are tried is:
8532 .code
8533 nimrod@jaeger.example
8534 *@jaeger.example
8535 *
8536 .endd
8537 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8538 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8539
8540 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8541 .code
8542 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8543 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8544 .endd
8545 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8546 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8547 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8548 .endlist
8549
8550
8551 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8552 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8553 always fails.
8554
8555
8556 .ilist
8557 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8558 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8559 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8560 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8561 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8562 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8563 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8564 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8565 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8566
8567 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8568 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8569 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8570 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8571 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8572 with
8573 .code
8574 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8575 .endd
8576 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8577 .code
8578 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8579 .endd
8580 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8581
8582 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8583 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8584 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8585 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8586 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8587 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8588 .code
8589 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8590 spammer3 : spammer4
8591 .endd
8592 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8593 doubling.
8594
8595 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8596 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8597 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8598 might have entries like
8599 .code
8600 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8601 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8602 *: ^\d{8}$
8603 .endd
8604 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8605 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8606 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8607 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8608
8609 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8610 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8611 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8612
8613 .next
8614 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8615 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8616 can only return a single list of local parts.
8617 .endlist
8618
8619 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8620 in these two examples:
8621 .code
8622 senders = +my_list
8623 senders = *@+my_list
8624 .endd
8625 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8626 example it is a named domain list.
8627
8628
8629
8630
8631 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8632 .cindex "case of local parts"
8633 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8634 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8635 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8636 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8637 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8638 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8639 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8640 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8641 default.
8642
8643 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8644 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8645 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8646 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8647 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8648 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8649 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8650 case-independent.
8651
8652 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8653 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8654 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8655 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8656 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8657 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8658 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8659 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8660
8661
8662
8663 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8664 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8665 .cindex "local part" "list"
8666 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8667 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8668 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8669 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8670 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8671 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8672 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8673 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8674
8675 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8676 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8677 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8678 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8679 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8680 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8681 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8682 types.
8683 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8684
8685
8686
8687
8688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8689 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8690
8691 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8692 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8693 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8694 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8695
8696 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8697 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8698 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8699 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8700 escape character, as described in the following section.
8701
8702 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8703 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8704 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8705 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8706 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8707 reasons.
8708
8709
8710
8711 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8712 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8713 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8714 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8715 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8716 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8717 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8718 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8719
8720 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8721 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8722 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8723 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8724 .code
8725 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8726 .endd
8727 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8728 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8729 string.
8730
8731
8732
8733 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8734 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8735 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8736 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8737 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8738 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8739 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8740 encoding.
8741
8742 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8743 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8744 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8745
8746
8747 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8748 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8749 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8750 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8751 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8752 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8753 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8754 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8755 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8756 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8757 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8758 and &%nhash%&.
8759
8760 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8761 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8762 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8763
8764 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8765 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8766 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8767 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8768 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8769 .code
8770 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8771 .endd
8772 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8773 Exim message identifier. For example:
8774 .code
8775 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8776 .endd
8777 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8778 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8779
8780
8781 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8782 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8783 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8784 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8785 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8786 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8787 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8788 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8789 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8790 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8791 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8792 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8793 being expanded.
8794
8795
8796
8797
8798 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8799 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8800 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8801 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8802 white space is significant.
8803
8804 .vlist
8805 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8806 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8807 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8808 .code
8809 $local_part
8810 ${domain}
8811 .endd
8812 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8813 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8814 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8815 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8816 given, the expansion fails.
8817
8818 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8819 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8820 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8821 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8822 .code
8823 ${lc:$local_part}
8824 .endd
8825 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8826 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8827 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8828 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8829 string easier to understand.
8830
8831 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8832 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8833 expansion item below.
8834
8835
8836 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8837 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8838 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8839 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8840 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8841 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8842 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8843 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8844 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8845 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8846 the result of the expansion.
8847 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8848 the expansion result is an empty string.
8849 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8850
8851
8852 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8853 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8854 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
8855 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8856 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8857 .code
8858 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8859 .endd
8860 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8861 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8862 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8863
8864 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8865 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8866 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8867 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8868 must have the following type:
8869 .code
8870 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8871 .endd
8872 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8873 function should return one of the following values:
8874
8875 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8876 into the expanded string that is being built.
8877
8878 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8879 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8880
8881 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8882 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8883
8884 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8885
8886 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8887 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8888 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8889
8890 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8891 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8892 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8893 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8894 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8895 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8896 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8897 form:
8898 .display
8899 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8900 .endd
8901 .vindex "&$value$&"
8902 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8903 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8904 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8905 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8906 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8907 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8908 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8909 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8910 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8911
8912 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8913 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8914 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8915 yield &"2001"&:
8916 .code
8917 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8918 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8919 .endd
8920 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8921 appear, for example:
8922 .code
8923 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8924 .endd
8925 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8926 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8927
8928
8929 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8930 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8931 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8932 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8933 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8934 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8935 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8936 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8937 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8938 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8939 <&'string3'&> as before.
8940
8941 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8942 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8943 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8944 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8945 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8946 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8947 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8948 provided. For example:
8949 .code
8950 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8951 .endd
8952 yields &"42"&, and
8953 .code
8954 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8955 .endd
8956 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8957 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8958
8959
8960 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8961 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8962 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8963 .vindex "&$item$&"
8964 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8965 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8966 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8967 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8968 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8969 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8970 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8971 .code
8972 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8973 .endd
8974 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8975 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8976
8977
8978 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8979 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8980 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8981 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8982 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8983 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8984
8985 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8986 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8987 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8988 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8989 .code
8990 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8991 .endd
8992 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8993 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8994 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8995 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8996 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8997 .code
8998 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8999 .endd
9000 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9001 letters appear. For example:
9002 .display
9003 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9004 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9005 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9006 .endd
9007
9008 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9009 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9010 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9011 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9012 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9013 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9014 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9015 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9016 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9017 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9018 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9019 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9020 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9021 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9022 .code
9023 $header_reply-to:
9024 .endd
9025 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9026 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9027 lines) may be present.
9028
9029 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9030 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9031
9032 .ilist
9033 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9034 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9035 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9036
9037 .next
9038 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9039 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9040 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9041 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9042 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9043 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9044 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9045 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9046
9047 .next
9048 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9049 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9050 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9051 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9052 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9053 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9054 .endlist ilist
9055
9056 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9057 command of the following form:
9058 .code
9059 headers charset "UTF-8"
9060 .endd
9061 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9062 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9063 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9064 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9065 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9066 ISO-8859-1.
9067
9068 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9069 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9070 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9071 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9072
9073 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9074 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9075 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9076 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9077 router or transport are not accessible.
9078
9079 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9080 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9081 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9082 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9083 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9084 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9085
9086 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9087 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9088 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9089 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9090 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9091 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9092 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9093
9094 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9095 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9096 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9097 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9098 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9099 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9100 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9101 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9102
9103
9104 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9105 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9106 .cindex &%hmac%&
9107 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9108 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9109 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9110 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9111 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9112 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9113 present. For example:
9114 .code
9115 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9116 .endd
9117 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9118 produces:
9119 .code
9120 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9121 .endd
9122 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9123 an Exim configuration:
9124 .code
9125 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9126 .endd
9127 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9128 .code
9129 headers_add = \
9130 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9131 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9132 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9133 .endd
9134 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9135 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9136 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9137 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9138 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9139 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9140
9141
9142 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9143 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9144 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9145 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9146 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9147 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9148 .code
9149 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9150 .endd
9151 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9152 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9153 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9154 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9155 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9156
9157 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9158 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9159 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9160 .code
9161 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9162 .endd
9163 you can use
9164 .code
9165 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9166 .endd
9167
9168 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9169 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9170 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9171 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9172 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9173 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9174 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9175 some of the braces:
9176 .code
9177 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9178 .endd
9179 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9180 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9181 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9182
9183
9184 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9185 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9186 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9187 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9188 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9189 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9190 apart from an optional leading minus,
9191 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9192
9193 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9194 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9195
9196 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9197 If the number is negative, the fields are
9198 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9199 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9200 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9201
9202 If the modulus of the
9203 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9204 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9205
9206 For example:
9207 .code
9208 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9209 .endd
9210 yields &"42"&, and
9211 .code
9212 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9213 .endd
9214 yields &"result: 99"&.
9215
9216 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9217 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9218 extracted is used.
9219 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9220
9221
9222 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9223 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9224 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9225 described in the next item.
9226
9227 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9228 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9229 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9230 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9231 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9232 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9233 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9234 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9235 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9236
9237 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9238 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9239 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9240 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9241 out by the system administrator.
9242
9243 .vindex "&$value$&"
9244 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9245 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9246 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9247 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9248 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9249 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9250 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9251 original lookup fails.
9252
9253 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9254 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9255 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9256 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9257 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9258 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9259 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9260 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9261
9262 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9263 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9264 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9265 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9266
9267 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9268 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9269 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9270 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9271
9272 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9273 .code
9274 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9275 .endd
9276 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9277 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9278 .code
9279 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9280 {$value}fail}
9281 .endd
9282
9283
9284 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9285 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9286 .vindex "&$item$&"
9287 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9288 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9289 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9290 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9291 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9292 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9293 .code
9294 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9295 .endd
9296 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9297 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9298 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9299
9300 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9301 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9302 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9303 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9304 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9305 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9306 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9307 .code
9308 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9309 .endd
9310 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9311 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9312 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9313 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9314 example,
9315 .code
9316 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9317 .endd
9318 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9319
9320
9321
9322 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9323 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9324 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9325 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9326 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9327 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9328 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9329 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9330
9331 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9332 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9333 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9334 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9335 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9336 not its contents.
9337
9338 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9339 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9340 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9341
9342 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9343 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9344
9345
9346 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9347 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9348 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9349 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9350 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9351 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9352 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9353 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9354
9355 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9356 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9357 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9358 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9359 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9360 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9361 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9362 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9363 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9364 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9365
9366 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9367 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9368 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9369 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9370
9371 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9372 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9373 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9374 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9375 is the expansion of the third argument.
9376
9377 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9378 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9379 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9380
9381 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9382 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9383 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9384 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9385 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9386 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9387 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9388 newlines are left in the string.
9389 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9390 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9391 the string expansion fails.
9392
9393 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9394 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9395
9396
9397
9398 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9399 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9400 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9401 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9402 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9403 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9404 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9405 examples:
9406 .code
9407 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9408 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9409 .endd
9410 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9411 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9412 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9413 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9414 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9415 example:
9416 .code
9417 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9418 .endd
9419 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9420 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9421 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9422 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9423 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9424 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9425 .code
9426 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9427 .endd
9428 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9429 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9430 turns them into spaces:
9431 .code
9432 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9433 .endd
9434 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9435 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9436 addition, the following errors can occur:
9437
9438 .ilist
9439 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9440 .next
9441 Failure to connect the socket;
9442 .next
9443 Failure to write the request string;
9444 .next
9445 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9446 .endlist
9447
9448 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9449 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9450 errors occurs. For example:
9451 .code
9452 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9453 {socket failure}}
9454 .endd
9455 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9456 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9457 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9458 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9459 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9460
9461 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9462 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9463
9464
9465 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9466 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9467 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9468 .vindex "&$value$&"
9469 .vindex "&$item$&"
9470 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9471 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9472 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9473 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9474 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9475 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9476 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9477 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9478 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9479 .code
9480 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9481 .endd
9482 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9483 can be found:
9484 .code
9485 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9486 .endd
9487 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9488 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9489 expansion items.
9490
9491 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9492 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9493 expansion item above.
9494
9495 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9496 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9497 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9498 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9499 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9500 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9501 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9502 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9503
9504 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9505 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9506 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9507 .vindex "&$value$&"
9508 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9509 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9510 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9511 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9512 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9513 &$value$&.
9514
9515 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9516 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9517 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9518 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9519
9520 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9521 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9522 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9523 troubleshoot:
9524 .code
9525 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9526 log_message = Output of id: $value
9527 .endd
9528 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9529 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9530 .code
9531 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9532 .endd
9533
9534 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9535 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9536 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9537 .code
9538 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9539 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9540 ...
9541 endif
9542 .endd
9543 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9544 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9545 commands.
9546
9547 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9548 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9549 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9550 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9551
9552 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9553 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9554
9555
9556 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9557 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9558 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9559 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9560 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9561 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9562 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9563 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9564 .code
9565 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9566 .endd
9567 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9568 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9569 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9570 .code
9571 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9572 .endd
9573 yields &"defabc"&, and
9574 .code
9575 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9576 .endd
9577 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9578 the regular expression from string expansion.
9579
9580
9581
9582 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9583 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9584 .cindex "substring extraction"
9585 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9586 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9587 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9588 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9589 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9590 .code
9591 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9592 .endd
9593 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9594 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9595 omitted.
9596
9597 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9598 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9599 length required. For example
9600 .code
9601 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9602 .endd
9603 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9604 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9605 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9606 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9607
9608 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9609 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9610 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9611 .code
9612 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9613 .endd
9614 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9615 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9616 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9617 .code
9618 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9619 .endd
9620 yields an empty string, but
9621 .code
9622 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9623 .endd
9624 yields &"1"&.
9625
9626 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9627 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9628 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9629 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9630 .code
9631 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9632 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9633 .endd
9634 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9635
9636
9637
9638 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9639 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9640 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9641 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9642 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9643 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9644 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9645 replacement list. For example
9646 .code
9647 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9648 .endd
9649 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9650 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9651 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9652 place.
9653 .endlist
9654
9655
9656
9657 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9658 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9659 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9660 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9661 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9662 following operations can be performed:
9663
9664 .vlist
9665 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9666 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9667 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9668 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9669 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9670 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9671
9672
9673 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9674 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9675 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9676 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9677 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9678 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9679 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9680 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9681 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9682
9683 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9684 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9685 character. For example:
9686 .code
9687 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9688 .endd
9689 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9690 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9691 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9692 processing lists.
9693
9694 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9695 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9696 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9697 email address seperator. For the example header line:
9698 .code
9699 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9700 .endd
9701 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9702 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9703 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9704 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9705 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9706 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9707 quoted.
9708 .code
9709 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9710 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9711 user@example.com
9712 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9713 Last:user@example.com
9714 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9715 user@example.com
9716 .endd
9717
9718 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9719 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9720 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9721 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9722 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9723 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9724 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9725 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9726 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9727
9728 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9729 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9730 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9731 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9732 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9733 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9734 string.
9735
9736
9737 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9738 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9739 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9740 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9741 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9742
9743
9744 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9745 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9746 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9747 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9748 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9749 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9750 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9751
9752
9753 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9754 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9755 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9756 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9757 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9758 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9759 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9760 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9761 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9762 C programming language):
9763 .table2 70pt 300pt
9764 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9765 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9766 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9767 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9768 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9769 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9770 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9771 .endtable
9772 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9773 space is permitted before or after operators.
9774
9775 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9776 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9777 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9778 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9779 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9780
9781 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9782 or 1024*1024*1024,
9783 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9784 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9785
9786 .display
9787 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9788 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9789 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9790 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9791 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9792 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9793 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9794 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9795 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9796 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9797 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9798 .endd
9799
9800 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9801 .code
9802 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9803 condition = \
9804 ${if and { \
9805 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9806 { \
9807 < \
9808 {$recipients_count} \
9809 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9810 } \
9811 }{yes}{no}}
9812 .endd
9813 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9814 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9815
9816
9817 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9818 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9819 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9820 example,
9821 .code
9822 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9823 .endd
9824 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9825 and then re-expands what it has found.
9826
9827
9828 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9829 .cindex "Unicode"
9830 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9831 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9832 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9833 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9834 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9835 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9836 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9837 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9838 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9839
9840 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9841 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9842 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9843 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9844 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9845 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9846 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9847
9848
9849 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9850 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9851 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9852 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9853 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9854 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9855 .code
9856 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9857 .endd
9858 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9859 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9860
9861
9862
9863 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9864 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9865 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9866 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9867 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9868 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9869
9870
9871
9872 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9873 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
9874 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
9875 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
9876 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
9877 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
9878 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
9879
9880
9881 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9882 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9883 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9884 .cindex "lower casing"
9885 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9886 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9887 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9888 .code
9889 ${lc:$local_part}
9890 .endd
9891
9892 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9893 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9894 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9895 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9896 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9897 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9898 .code
9899 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9900 .endd
9901 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9902 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9903 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9904
9905
9906 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9907 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
9908 .cindex "list" "item count"
9909 .cindex "list" "count of items"
9910 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
9911 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
9912
9913
9914 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
9915 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
9916 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
9917 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
9918 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
9919 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
9920 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
9921 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
9922 matching list is returned.
9923
9924
9925 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9926 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9927 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9928 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9929 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9930 empty.
9931
9932
9933 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9934 .cindex "masked IP address"
9935 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9936 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9937 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9938 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9939 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9940 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9941 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9942 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9943 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9944 .code
9945 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9946 .endd
9947 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9948 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9949 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9950 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9951 .code
9952 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9953 .endd
9954 returns the string
9955 .code
9956 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9957 .endd
9958 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9959
9960
9961 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9962 .cindex "MD5 hash"
9963 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9964 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9965 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9966 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9967
9968
9969 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9970 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9971 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9972 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9973 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9974 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9975 .code
9976 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9977 .endd
9978 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9979
9980
9981 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9982 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9983 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9984 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9985 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9986 is an empty string or
9987 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9988 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9989 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9990 respectively For example,
9991 .code
9992 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
9993 .endd
9994 becomes
9995 .code
9996 "ab\"*\"cd"
9997 .endd
9998 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9999 variable or a message header.
10000
10001 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10002 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10003 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10004 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10005 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10006 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10007 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10008
10009
10010 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10011 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10012 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10013 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10014 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10015 .code
10016 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10017 .endd
10018 returns
10019 .code
10020 two%20%5C2A%20two
10021 .endd
10022 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10023 yields an unchanged string.
10024
10025
10026 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10027 .cindex "random number"
10028 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10029 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10030 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10031 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10032 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10033 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10034 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10035 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10036 random().
10037
10038
10039 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10040 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10041 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10042 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10043 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10044 for DNS. For example,
10045 .code
10046 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10047 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10048 .endd
10049 returns
10050 .code
10051 4.2.0.192
10052 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10053 .endd
10054
10055
10056 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10057 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10058 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10059 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10060 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10061 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10062 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10063 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10064 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10065 characters
10066 .code
10067 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10068 .endd
10069 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10070 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10071 characters.
10072
10073
10074 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10075 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10076 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10077 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10078 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10079 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10080 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10081 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10082
10083 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10084 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10085 to use this operator as well.
10086
10087
10088
10089 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10090 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10091 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10092 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10093 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10094 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10095 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10096
10097
10098 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10099 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10100 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10101 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10102 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10103 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10104
10105
10106 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10107 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10108 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10109 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10110 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10111 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10112 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10113 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10114 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10115 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10116 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10117 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10118 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10119
10120 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10121 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10122 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10123
10124 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10125 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10126 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10127 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10128 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10129
10130
10131
10132 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10133 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10134 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10135 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10136 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10137 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10138
10139
10140 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10141 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10142 .cindex "substring extraction"
10143 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10144 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10145 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10146 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10147 .code
10148 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10149 .endd
10150 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10151 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10152
10153 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10154 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10155 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10156 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10157 seconds.
10158
10159 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10160 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10161 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10162 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10163 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10164 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10165 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10166
10167 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10168 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10169 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10170 .cindex "upper casing"
10171 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10172 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10173 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10174
10175 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10176 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10177 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10178 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10179 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10180 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10181 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10182 .endlist
10183
10184
10185
10186
10187
10188
10189 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10190 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10191 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10192 while expanding strings:
10193
10194 .vlist
10195 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10196 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10197 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10198 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10199 condition.
10200
10201 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10202 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10203 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10204 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10205 are:
10206 .display
10207 &`= `& equal
10208 &`== `& equal
10209 &`> `& greater
10210 &`>= `& greater or equal
10211 &`< `& less
10212 &`<= `& less or equal
10213 .endd
10214 For example:
10215 .code
10216 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10217 .endd
10218 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10219 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10220 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10221 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10222 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10223 zero.
10224
10225 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10226 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10227 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10228
10229
10230 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10231 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10232 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10233 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10234 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10235 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10236 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10237 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10238 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10239 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10240 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10241 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10242 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10243 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10244
10245 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10246 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10247 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10248 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10249 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10250 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10251 false if zero.
10252 An empty string is treated as false.
10253 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10254 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10255 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10256
10257 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10258 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10259 For example:
10260 .code
10261 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10262 .endd
10263
10264
10265 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10266 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10267 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10268 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10269 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10270 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10271 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10272 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10273
10274 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10275
10276 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10277 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10278 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10279 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10280 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10281 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10282 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10283 included in the binary.
10284
10285 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10286 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10287 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10288 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10289 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10290 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10291 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10292 string in LDAP form is:
10293 .code
10294 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10295 .endd
10296 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10297 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10298 .code
10299 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10300 .endd
10301 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10302 supported:
10303
10304 .ilist
10305 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10306 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10307 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10308 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10309 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10310 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10311 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10312 comparison fails.
10313
10314 .next
10315 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10316 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10317 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10318 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10319 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10320 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10321
10322 .next
10323 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10324 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10325 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10326 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10327 whatever its length.
10328
10329 .next
10330 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10331 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10332 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10333 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10334 .endlist
10335 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10336 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10337 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10338 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10339 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10340 support &[crypt16()]&.
10341
10342 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10343 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10344 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10345 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10346 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10347
10348 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10349 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10350 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10351
10352 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10353 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10354 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10355 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10356 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10357
10358 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10359 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10360 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10361 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10362 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10363 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10364 .code
10365 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10366 .endd
10367 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10368 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10369
10370 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10371 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10372 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10373 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10374 exists in the message. For example,
10375 .code
10376 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10377 .endd
10378 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10379 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10380
10381 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10382 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10383 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10384 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10385 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10386 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10387 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10388 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10389 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10390
10391 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10392 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10393 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10394 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10395 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10396 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10397 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10398 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10399
10400 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10401 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10402 .cindex "first delivery"
10403 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10404 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10405 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10406 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10407
10408
10409 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10410 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10411 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10412 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10413 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10414 .vindex "&$item$&"
10415 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10416 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10417 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10418 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10419 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10420 .ilist
10421 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10422 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10423 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10424 .next
10425 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10426 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10427 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10428 .endlist
10429 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10430 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10431 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10432 list separator is changed to a comma:
10433 .code
10434 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10435 .endd
10436 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10437 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10438
10439 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10440
10441
10442 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10443 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10444 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10445 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10446 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10447 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10448 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10449 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10450 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10451 case-independent.
10452
10453 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10454 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10455 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10456 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10457 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10458 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10459 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10460 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10461 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10462 case-independent.
10463
10464 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10465 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10466 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10467 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10468 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10469 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10470 is true.
10471
10472 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10473 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10474 .code
10475 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10476 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10477 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10478 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10479 .endd
10480
10481 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10482 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10483 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10484 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10485 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10486 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10487 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10488 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10489 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10490 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10491 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10492
10493 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10494 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10495 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10496 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10497 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10498
10499 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10500 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10501 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10502 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10503 .code
10504 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10505 .endd
10506 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10507
10508 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10509 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10510 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10511 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10512 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10513 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10514 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10515 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10516 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10517 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10518 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10519 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10520 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10521 this can be used.
10522
10523
10524 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10525 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10526 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10527 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10528 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10529 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10530 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10531 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10532 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10533 case-independent.
10534
10535 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10536 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10537 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10538 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10539 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10540 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10541 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10542 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10543 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10544 case-independent.
10545
10546
10547 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10548 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10549 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10550 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10551 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10552 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10553 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10554 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10555 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10556 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10557 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10558 For example,
10559 .code
10560 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10561 .endd
10562 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10563 backslashes is also required.
10564
10565 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10566 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10567 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10568 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10569 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10570 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10571
10572 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10573 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10574 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10575 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10576 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10577 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10578 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10579 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10580
10581 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10582 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10583 See &*match_local_part*&.
10584
10585 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10586 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10587 See &*match_local_part*&.
10588
10589 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10590 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10591 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10592 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10593 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10594 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10595 .code
10596 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10597 .endd
10598 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10599
10600 .ilist
10601 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10602 .next
10603 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10604 .next
10605 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10606 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10607 in a single test such as
10608 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10609 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10610 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10611 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10612 .code
10613 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10614 .endd
10615 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10616 .next
10617 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10618 .next
10619 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10620 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10621 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10622 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10623 masks. For example:
10624 .code
10625 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10626 .endd
10627 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10628 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10629 address mask, for example:
10630 .code
10631 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10632 .endd
10633 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10634 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10635 .code
10636 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10637 .endd
10638 .endlist ilist
10639
10640 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10641 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10642
10643 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10644
10645 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10646 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10647 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10648 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10649 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10650 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10651 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10652 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10653 example is:
10654 .code
10655 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10656 .endd
10657 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10658 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10659 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10660 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10661 .code
10662 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10663 .endd
10664 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10665 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10666 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10667 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10668 caselessly.
10669
10670 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10671 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10672
10673 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10674 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10675 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10676 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10677
10678 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10679 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10680 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10681 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10682 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10683 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10684 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10685 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10686 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10687 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10688 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10689 .code
10690 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10691 .endd
10692 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10693 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10694
10695 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10696 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10697 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10698 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10699 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10700 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10701 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10702
10703 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10704 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10705 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10706 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10707 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10708 .code
10709 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10710 .endd
10711 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10712 .code
10713 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10714 .endd
10715 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10716 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10717 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10718 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10719 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10720 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10721 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10722 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10723
10724
10725 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10726 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10727 .cindex "Cyrus"
10728 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10729 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10730 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10731 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10732 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10733 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10734
10735 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10736 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10737 building Exim. For example:
10738 .code
10739 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10740 .endd
10741 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10742 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10743 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10744 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10745
10746 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10747 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10748 configuration, you might have this:
10749 .code
10750 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10751 .endd
10752 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10753 .code
10754 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10755 .endd
10756 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10757 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10758 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10759 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10760 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10761 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10762
10763
10764 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10765 .cindex "Radius"
10766 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10767 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10768 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10769 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10770 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10771 support.
10772
10773 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10774 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10775 this library, you need to set
10776 .code
10777 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10778 .endd
10779 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10780 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10781 .code
10782 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10783 .endd
10784 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10785 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10786 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10787
10788 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10789 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10790 the authentication is successful. For example:
10791 .code
10792 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10793 .endd
10794
10795
10796 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10797 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10798 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10799 .cindex "Cyrus"
10800 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10801 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10802 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10803 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10804 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10805 by a process that is not running as root.
10806
10807 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10808 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10809 building Exim. For example:
10810 .code
10811 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10812 .endd
10813 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10814 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10815 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10816
10817 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10818 two are mandatory. For example:
10819 .code
10820 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10821 .endd
10822 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10823 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10824 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10825 .endlist vlist
10826
10827
10828
10829 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10830 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10831 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10832 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10833 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10834 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10835 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10836
10837
10838 .vlist
10839 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10840 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10841 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10842 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10843 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10844 For example,
10845 .code
10846 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10847 .endd
10848 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10849 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10850 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10851
10852 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10853 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10854 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10855 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10856 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10857 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10858 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10859 parsed but not evaluated.
10860 .endlist
10861 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10862
10863
10864
10865
10866 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10867 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10868 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10869 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10870 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10871
10872 .vlist
10873 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10874 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10875 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10876 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10877 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10878 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10879 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10880 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10881 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10882 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10883 matching condition.
10884
10885 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10886 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10887 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10888 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10889 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10890 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10891 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10892 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10893 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10894 during subsequent delivery.
10895
10896 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10897 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10898 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10899 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10900 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10901 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10902 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10903 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10904 delivery.
10905
10906 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10907 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10908 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10909 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10910 be preserved by coding like this:
10911 .code
10912 warn !verify = sender
10913 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10914 .endd
10915 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10916 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10917 failure.
10918
10919 .vitem &$address_data$&
10920 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10921 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10922 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10923 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10924 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10925 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10926 user filter files.
10927
10928 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10929 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10930 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10931 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10932 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10933 from the child's routing.
10934
10935 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10936 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10937 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10938 address.
10939
10940 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10941 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10942 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10943
10944 .vitem &$address_file$&
10945 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10946 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10947 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10948 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10949 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10950 .code
10951 /home/r2d2/savemail
10952 .endd
10953 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10954 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10955 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10956 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10957 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10958 to the relevant file.
10959
10960 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10961 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10962 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10963 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10964
10965 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10966 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10967 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10968 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10969
10970 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10971 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10972 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10973 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10974 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10975 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10976 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10977 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10978 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10979 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10980 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10981 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10982 command line option.
10983
10984 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
10985 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
10986 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
10987 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
10988 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
10989 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
10990 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
10991 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
10992 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
10993 the ACL's as well.
10994
10995
10996 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10997 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10998 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10999 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11000 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11001 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11002 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11003 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11004 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11005 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11006 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11007
11008 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11009 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11010 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11011 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11012 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11013
11014
11015 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11016 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11017 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11018 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11019 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11020 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11021 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11022 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11023 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11024 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11025 an undefined mechanism.
11026
11027 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11028 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11029 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11030 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11031 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11032 the ACL malware condition.
11033
11034 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11035 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11036 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11037 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11038 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11039 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11040
11041 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11042 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11043 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11044 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11045 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11046 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11047 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11048
11049 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11050 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11051 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11052 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11053 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11054
11055 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11056 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11057 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11058 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11059 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11060
11061 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11062 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11063 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11064 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11065 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11066 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11067 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11068
11069 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11070 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11071 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11072 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11073 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11074 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11075 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11076
11077 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11078 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11079 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11080
11081 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11082 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11083 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11084 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11085 compilations of the same version of the program.
11086
11087 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11088 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11089 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11090 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11091 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11092
11093 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11094 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11095 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11096 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11097 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11098
11099 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11100 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11101 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11102 &$dnslist_value$&
11103 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11104 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11105 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11106 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11107 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11108 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11109 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11110 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11111 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11112
11113 .vitem &$domain$&
11114 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11115 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11116 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11117 case for &$domain$&.
11118
11119 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11120 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11121 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11122 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11123
11124 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11125 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11126 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11127 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11128 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11129 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11130
11131 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11132 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11133 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11134
11135 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11136
11137 .ilist
11138 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11139 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11140 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11141 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11142 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11143 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11144 the &(smtp)& transport.
11145
11146 .next
11147 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11148 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11149 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11150 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11151
11152 .next
11153 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11154 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11155 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11156 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11157 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11158 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11159
11160 .next
11161 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11162 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11163 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11164 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11165 .endlist
11166
11167
11168 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11169 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11170 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11171 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11172 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11173 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11174 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11175 used.
11176
11177 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11178 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11179 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11180 to nothing.
11181
11182 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11183 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11184 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11185
11186 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11187 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11188 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11189
11190 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11191 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11192 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11193
11194 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11195 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11196 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11197 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11198 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11199
11200 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11201 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11202 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11203 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11204 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11205
11206 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11207 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11208 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11209 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11210 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11211
11212 .vitem &$home$&
11213 .vindex "&$home$&"
11214 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11215 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11216 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11217 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11218 by a setting on the transport itself.
11219
11220 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11221 of the environment variable HOME.
11222
11223 .vitem &$host$&
11224 .vindex "&$host$&"
11225 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11226 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11227 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11228 to local and remote transports.
11229
11230 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11231 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11232 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11233 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11234 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11235 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11236 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11237 is connected.
11238
11239 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11240 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11241 client is connected.
11242
11243
11244 .vitem &$host_address$&
11245 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11246 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11247 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11248 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11249
11250 .vitem &$host_data$&
11251 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11252 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11253 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11254 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11255 .code
11256 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11257 message = $host_data
11258 .endd
11259 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11260 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11261 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11262 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11263 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11264 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11265 variables is set to &"1"&.
11266
11267 .ilist
11268 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11269 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11270
11271 .next
11272 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11273 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11274 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11275 .endlist ilist
11276
11277 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11278 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11279 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11280 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11281 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11282 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11283 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11284 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11285 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11286 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11287
11288 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11289 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11290 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11291
11292
11293 .vitem &$inode$&
11294 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11295 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11296 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11297 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11298 a unique name for the file.
11299
11300 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11301 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11302 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11303
11304 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11305 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11306 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11307
11308 .vitem &$item$&
11309 .vindex "&$item$&"
11310 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11311 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11312 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11313 empty.
11314
11315 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11316 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11317 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11318 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11319 lookup.
11320
11321 .vitem &$load_average$&
11322 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11323 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11324 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11325 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11326
11327 .vitem &$local_part$&
11328 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11329 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11330 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11331 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11332 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11333
11334 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11335 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11336 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11337 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11338 once.
11339
11340 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11341 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11342 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11343 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11344 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11345 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11346
11347 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11348 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11349 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11350 &$address_pipe$&).
11351
11352 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11353 local part of the recipient address.
11354
11355 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11356 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11357 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11358
11359 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11360 the addresses
11361 .code
11362 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11363 abc\:xyz@test.example
11364 .endd
11365 the value of &$local_part$& is
11366 .code
11367 abc:xyz
11368 .endd
11369 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11370 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11371 have:
11372 .code
11373 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11374 .endd
11375 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11376 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11377 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11378
11379 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11380 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11381 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11382 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11383 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11384 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11385 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11386
11387 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11388 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11389 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11390 variable expands to nothing.
11391
11392 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11393 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11394 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11395 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11396 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11397
11398 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11399 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11400 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11401 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11402 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11403
11404 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11405 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11406 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11407 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11408
11409 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11410 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11411 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11412
11413 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11414 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11415 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11416 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11417 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11418 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11419 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11420 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11421
11422 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11423 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11424 This contains the expanded value of the
11425 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11426 been read.
11427
11428 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11429 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11430 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11431 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11432 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11433 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11434
11435 .vitem &$log_space$&
11436 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11437 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11438 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11439 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11440 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11441 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11442
11443
11444 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11445 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11446 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11447 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11448 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11449 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11450 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11451 variable is empty.
11452
11453 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11454 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11455 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11456 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11457 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11458
11459 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11460 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11461 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11462 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11463 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11464 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11465 character(s).
11466
11467 .vitem &$message_age$&
11468 .cindex "message" "age of"
11469 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11470 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11471 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11472 delivery attempt.
11473
11474 .vitem &$message_body$&
11475 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11476 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11477 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11478 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11479 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11480 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11481 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11482 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11483 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11484
11485 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11486 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11487 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11488 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11489 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11490
11491 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11492 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11493 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11494 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11495 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11496 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11497 &$message_body$&.
11498
11499 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11500 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11501 .cindex "message body" "size"
11502 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11503 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11504 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11505 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11506 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11507
11508 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11509 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11510 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11511 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11512 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11513 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11514 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11515 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11516
11517 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11518 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11519 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11520 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11521 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11522 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11523
11524 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11525 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11526 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11527 contents of header lines is done.
11528
11529 .vitem &$message_id$&
11530 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11531
11532 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11533 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11534 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11535 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11536 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11537 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11538 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11539 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11540 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11541 from the body is not counted.
11542
11543 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11544 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11545 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11546 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11547 header and the body).
11548
11549 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11550 .code
11551 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11552 condition = \
11553 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11554 .endd
11555 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11556 message has not yet been received.
11557
11558 .vitem &$message_size$&
11559 .cindex "size" "of message"
11560 .cindex "message" "size"
11561 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11562 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11563 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11564 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11565 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11566 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11567 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11568 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11569 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11570
11571 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11572 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11573 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11574 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11575
11576 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11577 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11578 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11579 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11580
11581 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11582 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11583 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11584
11585 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11586 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11587 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11588 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11589 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11590 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11591 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11592 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11593 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11594 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11595
11596 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11597 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11598 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11599
11600 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11601 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11602 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11603 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11604 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11605 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11606 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11607 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11608 the original address.
11609
11610 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11611 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11612 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11613 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11614 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11615
11616 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11617 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11618 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11619
11620 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11621 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11622 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11623 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11624 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11625 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11626 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11627 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11628 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11629
11630 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11631 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11632 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11633 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11634 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11635 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11636 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11637 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11638 user.
11639
11640 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11641 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11642 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11643 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11644
11645 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11646 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11647 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11648 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11649
11650 .vitem &$pid$&
11651 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11652 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11653 This variable contains the current process id.
11654
11655 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11656 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11657 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11658 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11659 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11660 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11661 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11662 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11663 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11664 variable"& error if encountered.
11665
11666 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11667 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11668 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11669 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11670 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11671 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11672 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11673
11674
11675 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11676 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11677 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11678 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11679
11680 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11681 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11682 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11683 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11684
11685 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11686 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11687 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11688 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11689
11690 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11691 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11692 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11693
11694 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11695 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11696 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11697 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11698
11699 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11700 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11701 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11702 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11703 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11704
11705 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11706 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11707 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11708 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11709 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11710 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11711
11712 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11713 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11714 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11715 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11716 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11717
11718 .vitem &$received_count$&
11719 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11720 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11721 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11722 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11723 delivering.
11724
11725 .vitem &$received_for$&
11726 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11727 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11728 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11729 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11730 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11731
11732 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11733 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11734 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11735 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11736 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11737 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11738 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11739 option.
11740
11741 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11742 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11743 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11744 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11745 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11746 time.
11747
11748 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11749 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11750 &(smtp)& transport).
11751
11752 .vitem &$received_port$&
11753 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11754 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11755
11756 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11757 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11758 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11759 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11760 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11761 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11762 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11763 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11764 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11765
11766 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11767 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11768 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11769 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11770 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11771 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11772
11773 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11774 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11775 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11776
11777 .vitem &$received_time$&
11778 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11779 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11780 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11781
11782 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11783 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11784 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11785 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11786 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11787 .display
11788 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11789 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11790 .endd
11791 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11792 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11793 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11794 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11795
11796 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11797 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11798 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11799 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11800
11801 .ilist
11802 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11803 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11804
11805 .next
11806 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11807
11808 .next
11809 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11810 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11811 MAIL).
11812
11813 .next
11814 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11815 .next
11816
11817 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11818 .endlist
11819
11820 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11821 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11822
11823 .vitem &$recipients$&
11824 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11825 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11826 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11827 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11828 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11829 cases:
11830
11831 .olist
11832 In a system filter file.
11833 .next
11834 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11835 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11836 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11837 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11838 .next
11839 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11840 .endlist
11841
11842
11843 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11844 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11845 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11846 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11847 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11848 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11849
11850
11851 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11852 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11853 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11854 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11855
11856
11857 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11858 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11859 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11860 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11861 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11862 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11863 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11864
11865 .vitem &$return_path$&
11866 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11867 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11868 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11869 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11870 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11871 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11872 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11873 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11874 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11875 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11876 envelope sender.
11877
11878 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11879 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11880 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11881
11882 .vitem &$router_name$&
11883 .cindex "router" "name"
11884 .cindex "name" "of router"
11885 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
11886 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
11887
11888 .vitem &$runrc$&
11889 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11890 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11891 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11892 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11893 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11894 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11895 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11896 another.
11897
11898 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11899 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11900 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11901 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11902 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11903 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11904 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11905 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11906
11907 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11908 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11909 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11910 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11911 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11912 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11913
11914 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11915 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11916 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11917 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11918 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11919 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11920 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11921 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11922
11923 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11924 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11925 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11926
11927 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11928 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11929 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11930
11931 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11932 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11933 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11934 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11935 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11936 this:
11937 .display
11938 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11939 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11940 .endd
11941 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11942 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11943 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11944 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11945
11946 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11947 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11948 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11949 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11950 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11951 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11952 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11953 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11954 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11955 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11956 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11957 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11958 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11959
11960 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11961 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11962 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11963 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11964 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11965 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11966
11967 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11968 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11969 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11970 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11971
11972 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11973 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11974 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11975 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11976 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11977 &$authenticated_id$&.
11978
11979 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
11980 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
11981 If &$sender_host_name$& has been populated (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
11982 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
11983 resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
11984 other times, this variable is false.
11985
11986 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
11987 library, by setting:
11988 .code
11989 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
11990 .endd
11991
11992 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
11993 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
11994
11995 Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
11996 with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
11997
11998 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
11999 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12000
12001
12002 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12003 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12004 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12005 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12006 other means, this variable is empty.
12007
12008 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12009 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12010 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12011 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12012 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12013 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12014 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12015
12016 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12017 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12018 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12019 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12020
12021 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12022 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12023 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12024 is set to &"1"&.
12025
12026 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12027 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12028 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12029 following are true:
12030
12031 .ilist
12032 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12033 .next
12034 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12035 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12036 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12037 .next
12038 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12039 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12040 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12041 .next
12042 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12043 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12044 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12045 .next
12046 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12047 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12048 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12049 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12050 .code
12051 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12052 .endd
12053 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12054 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12055 .endlist
12056
12057
12058 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12059 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12060 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12061 number that was used on the remote host.
12062
12063 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12064 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12065 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12066 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12067 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12068 called Exim.
12069
12070 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12071 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12072 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12073 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12074
12075 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12076 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12077 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12078 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12079 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12080 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12081 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12082 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12083 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12084 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12085 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12086 the parentheses.
12087
12088 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12089 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12090 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12091 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12092 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12093
12094 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12095 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12096 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12097 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12098 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12099
12100 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12101 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12102 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12103 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12104 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12105 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12106 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12107
12108 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12109 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12110 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12111 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12112 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12113
12114 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12115 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12116 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12117 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12118 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12119 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12120
12121 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12122 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12123 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12124 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12125 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12126 .code
12127 MAIL FROM:<>
12128 MAIL FROM: <>
12129 .endd
12130 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12131 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12132 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12133 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12134
12135 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12136 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12137 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12138 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12139 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12140 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12141 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12142
12143 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12144 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12145 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12146 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12147 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12148 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12149 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12150 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12151 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12152 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12153 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12154
12155 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12156 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12157 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12158 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12159 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12160 message is junk mail.
12161
12162 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12163 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12164 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12165 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12166
12167
12168 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12169 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12170 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12171
12172 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12173 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12174 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12175 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12176 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12177 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12178
12179 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12180 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12181 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12182 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12183 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12184 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12185 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12186 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12187 .code
12188 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12189 .endd
12190 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12191
12192
12193 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12194 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12195 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12196 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12197 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12198 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12199
12200 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12201 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12202 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12203 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12204 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12205 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12206 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12207 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12208
12209 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12210 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12211 the outbound.
12212
12213 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12214 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12215 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12216 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12217 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12218 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12219
12220 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12221 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12222 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12223 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12224
12225 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12226 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12227 the outbound.
12228
12229 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12230 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12231 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12232 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12233 and &"0"& otherwise.
12234
12235 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12236 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12237 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12238 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12239 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12240 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12241 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12242 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12243 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12244
12245 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12246 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12247 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12248
12249 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12250 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12251 This variable is
12252 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12253 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12254 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12255 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12256
12257 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12258 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12259 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12260 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12261 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12262 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12263 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12264
12265 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12266 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12267 the outbound.
12268
12269 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12270 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12271 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12272 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12273 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12274 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12275
12276 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12277 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12278 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12279 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12280 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12281 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12282 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12283 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12284 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12285 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12286 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12287
12288 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12289 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12290 the outbound.
12291
12292 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12293 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12294 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12295 During outbound
12296 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12297 the transport.
12298
12299 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12300 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12301 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12302 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12303
12304 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12305 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12306 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12307
12308 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12309 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12310 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12311
12312 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12313 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12314 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12315 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12316 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12317 values for those that are behind (west).
12318
12319 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12320 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12321 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12322 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12323
12324 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12325 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12326 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12327 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12328 flag.
12329
12330 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12331 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12332 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12333 -0500.
12334
12335 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12336 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12337 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12338 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12339
12340 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12341 .cindex "transport" "name"
12342 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12343 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12344 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12345
12346 .vitem &$value$&
12347 .vindex "&$value$&"
12348 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12349 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12350 &*reduce*& expansion.
12351
12352 .vitem &$version_number$&
12353 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12354 The version number of Exim.
12355
12356 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12357 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12358 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12359 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12360
12361 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12362 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12363 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12364 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12365 .endlist
12366 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12367
12368
12369
12370 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12371 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12372
12373 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12374 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12375 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12376 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12377 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12378 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12379 the line
12380 .code
12381 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12382 .endd
12383 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12384
12385
12386 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12387 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12388 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12389 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12390 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12391 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12392 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12393 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12394 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12395
12396 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12397 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12398 should usually be something like
12399 .code
12400 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12401 .endd
12402 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12403 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12404 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12405 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12406 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12407 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12408 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12409 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12410 two ways:
12411
12412 .ilist
12413 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12414 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12415 a startup when Exim is entered.
12416 .next
12417 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12418 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12419 .endlist
12420
12421 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12422 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12423
12424
12425 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12426 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12427 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12428 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12429 forms:
12430 .code
12431 ${perl{foo}}
12432 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12433 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12434 .endd
12435 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12436 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12437 with an error message of the form
12438 .code
12439 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12440 .endd
12441 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12442 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12443 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12444 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12445 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12446 that was passed to &%die%&.
12447
12448
12449 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12450 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12451 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12452 the Perl code
12453 .code
12454 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12455 .endd
12456 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12457 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12458 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12459
12460 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12461 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12462 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12463 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12464
12465 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12466 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12467 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12468 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12469 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12470 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12471 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12472
12473
12474 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12475 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12476 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12477 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12478 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12479 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12480 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12481 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12482 avoided, but the output is lost.
12483
12484 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12485 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12486 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12487 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12488 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12489 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12490 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12491 .code
12492 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12493 .endd
12494 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12495 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12496 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12497 as the first subroutine argument.
12498 .ecindex IIDperl
12499
12500
12501 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12502 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12503
12504 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12505 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12506 "Starting the daemon"
12507 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12508 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12509 .cindex "network interface"
12510 .cindex "interface" "network"
12511 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12512 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12513 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12514 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12515 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12516 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12517 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12518 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12519 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12520 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12521 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12522
12523 .olist
12524 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12525 and ports to listen on.
12526 .next
12527 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12528 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12529 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12530 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12531 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12532 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12533 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12534 as an error situation.
12535 .next
12536 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12537 for the outgoing connection.
12538 .endlist
12539
12540
12541 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12542 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12543 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12544 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12545 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12546
12547 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12548 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12549 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12550 chapter describes how they operate.
12551
12552 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12553 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12554
12555
12556
12557 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12558 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12559 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12560 following options:
12561
12562 .ilist
12563 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12564 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12565 .next
12566 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12567 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12568 .endlist
12569
12570 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12571 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12572 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12573 colons. For example:
12574 .code
12575 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12576 192.168.23.65 ; \
12577 ::1 ; \
12578 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12579 .endd
12580 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12581 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12582
12583 .olist
12584 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12585 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12586 .code
12587 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12588 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12589 .endd
12590 .next
12591 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12592 with a colon separator, for example:
12593 .code
12594 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12595 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12596 .endd
12597 .endlist
12598
12599 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12600 default setting contains just one port:
12601 .code
12602 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12603 .endd
12604 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12605 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12606 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12607 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12608 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12609
12610
12611
12612 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12613 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12614 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12615 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12616 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12617 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12618 .code
12619 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12620 .endd
12621 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12622 .code
12623 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12624 .endd
12625 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12626
12627
12628
12629 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12630 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12631 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12632 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12633 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12634 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12635 exim.
12636
12637 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12638 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12639 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12640 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12641 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12642 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12643 .code
12644 -oX 1225
12645 .endd
12646 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12647 whereas
12648 .code
12649 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12650 .endd
12651 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12652 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12653 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12654
12655
12656
12657 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12658 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12659 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12660 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12661 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12662 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12663 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12664 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12665 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12666 common use of this option is expected to be
12667 .code
12668 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12669 .endd
12670 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12671 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12672 this way when a daemon is started.
12673
12674 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12675 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12676 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12677 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12678 connections via the daemon.)
12679
12680
12681
12682
12683 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12684 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12685 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12686 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12687 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12688 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12689 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12690 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12691 .code
12692 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12693 .endd
12694 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12695 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12696 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12697 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12698 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12699 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12700 .code
12701 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12702 .endd
12703 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12704 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12705 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12706 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12707 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12708
12709 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12710 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12711 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12712 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12713 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12714 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12715 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12716 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12717 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12718 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12719 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12720 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12721
12722 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12723 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12724 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12725 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12726 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12727
12728
12729
12730 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12731 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12732 .code
12733 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12734 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12735 .endd
12736 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12737 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12738 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12739 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12740
12741 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12742 .code
12743 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12744 .endd
12745 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12746 .code
12747 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12748 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12749 .endd
12750 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12751 IPv4 loopback address only:
12752 .code
12753 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12754 .endd
12755 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12756 .code
12757 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
12758 .endd
12759 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12760
12761
12762
12763 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12764 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12765 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12766 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12767 treated as local.
12768
12769 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12770 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12771 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12772 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12773
12774 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12775 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12776 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12777 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12778 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12779 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12780 used for listening. Consider this example:
12781 .code
12782 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12783 192.168.53.235 ; \
12784 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12785
12786 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12787 .endd
12788 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12789 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12790 Exim is routing.
12791
12792 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12793 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12794 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12795 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12796 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12797 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12798 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12799 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12800
12801
12802
12803 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12804 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12805 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12806 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12807 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12808 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12809 details.
12810
12811
12812
12813
12814 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12815 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12816
12817 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12818 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12819 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12820 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12821
12822 .ilist
12823 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12824 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12825 .next
12826 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12827 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12828 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12829 .next
12830 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12831 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12832 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12833 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12834 settings.
12835 .endlist
12836
12837 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12838 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12839 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12840 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12841 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12842 listed in more than one group.
12843
12844 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12845 .table2
12846 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12847 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12848 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12849 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12850 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12851 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12852 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12853 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12854 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12855 .endtable
12856
12857
12858 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12859 .table2
12860 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12861 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12862 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12863 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12864 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12865 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12866 .endtable
12867
12868
12869
12870 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12871 .table2
12872 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12873 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12874 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12875 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12876 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12877 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12878 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12879 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12880 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12881 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12882 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12883 .endtable
12884
12885
12886
12887 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12888 .table2
12889 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12890 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12891 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12892 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12893 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12894 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12895 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12896 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12897 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12898 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12899 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12900 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12901 .endtable
12902
12903
12904
12905 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12906 .table2
12907 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12908 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12909 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12910 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12911 .endtable
12912
12913
12914
12915 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12916 .table2
12917 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12918 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12919 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12920 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12921 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12922 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12923 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12924 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12925 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12926 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12927 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12928 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12929 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12930 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12931 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12932 .endtable
12933
12934
12935
12936 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12937 .table2
12938 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12939 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12940 .endtable
12941
12942
12943
12944 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12945 .table2
12946 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12947 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12948 .endtable
12949
12950
12951
12952 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12953 .table2
12954 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12955 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12956 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12957 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12958 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12959 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12960 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12961 .endtable
12962
12963
12964
12965 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12966 .table2
12967 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12968 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12969 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12970 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12971 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12972 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12973 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12974 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12975 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12976 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12977 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12978 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12979 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12980 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12981 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12982 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12983 connection"
12984 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12985 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12986 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12987 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12988 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12989 .endtable
12990
12991
12992
12993 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12994 .table2
12995 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12996 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12997 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12998 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12999 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13000 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13001 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13002 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13003 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13004 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13005 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13006 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13007 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13008 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13009 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13010 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13011 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13012 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13013 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13014 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13015 words""&"
13016 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13017 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13018 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13019 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13020 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13021 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13022 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13023 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13024 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13025 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13026 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13027 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13028 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13029 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13030 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13031 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13032 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13033 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13034 .endtable
13035
13036
13037
13038 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13039 .table2
13040 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13041 item"
13042 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13043 item"
13044 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13045 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13046 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13047 .endtable
13048
13049
13050
13051 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13052 .table2
13053 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13054 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13055 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13056 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13057 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13058 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13059 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13060 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13061 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13062 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13063 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13064 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13065 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13066 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13067 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13068 .endtable
13069
13070
13071
13072 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13073 .table2
13074 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13075 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13076 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13077 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13078 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13079 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13080 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13081 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13082 .endtable
13083
13084
13085
13086 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13087 .table2
13088 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13089 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13090 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13091 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13092 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13093 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13094 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13095 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13096 .endtable
13097
13098
13099
13100
13101 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13102 .table2
13103 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13104 .endtable
13105
13106
13107
13108
13109
13110 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13111 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13112
13113 .table2
13114 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13115 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13116 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13117 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13118 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13119 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13120 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13121 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13122 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13123 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13124 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13125 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13126 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13127 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13128 connection"
13129 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13130 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13131 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13132 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13133 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13134 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13135 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13136 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13137 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13138 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13139 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13140 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13141 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13142 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13143 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13144 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13145 .endtable
13146
13147
13148
13149 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13150 .table2
13151 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13152 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13153 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13154 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13155 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13156 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13157 .endtable
13158
13159
13160
13161 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13162 .table2
13163 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13164 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13165 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13166 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13167 words""&"
13168 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13169 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13170 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13171 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13172 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13173 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13174 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13175 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13176 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13177 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13178 .endtable
13179
13180
13181
13182 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13183 .table2
13184 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13185 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13186 directory"
13187 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13188 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13189 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13190 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13191 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13192 .endtable
13193
13194
13195
13196 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13197 .table2
13198 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13199 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13200 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13201 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13202 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13203 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13204 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13205 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13206 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13207 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13208 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13209 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13210 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13211 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13212 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13213 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13214 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13215 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13216 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13217 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13218 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13219 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13220 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13221 .endtable
13222
13223
13224
13225 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13226 .table2
13227 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13228 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13229 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13230 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13231 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13232 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13233 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13234 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13235 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13236 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13237 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13238 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13239 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13240 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13241 .endtable
13242
13243
13244
13245 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13246 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13247 &dagger;.
13248
13249 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13250 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13251 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13252 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13253 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13254 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13255 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13256 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13257 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13258
13259 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13260 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13261 It now defaults to true.
13262 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13263 .display
13264 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13265 .endd
13266
13267 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13268 .code
13269 log_selector = +8bitmime
13270 .endd
13271
13272 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13273 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13274 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13275 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13276 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13277 further details.
13278
13279 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13280 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13281 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13282 SMTP messages.
13283
13284 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13285 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13286 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13287 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13288 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13289
13290 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13291 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13292 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13293 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13294 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13295
13296 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13297 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13298 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13299 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13300
13301 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13302 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13303 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13304 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13305 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13306
13307 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13308 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13309 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13310 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13311
13312 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13313 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13314 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13315 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13316
13317 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13318 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13319 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13320 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13321 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13322
13323
13324 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13325 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13326 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13327 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13328
13329 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13330 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13331 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13332 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13333 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13334
13335 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13336 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13337 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13338 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13339 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13340
13341 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13342 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13343 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13344 further details.
13345
13346 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13347 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13348 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13349 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13350
13351 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13352 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13353 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13354 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13355
13356 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13357 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13358 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13359 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13360
13361 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13362 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13363 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13364 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13365
13366 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13367 .cindex "admin user"
13368 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13369 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13370 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13371 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13372 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13373 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13374 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13375
13376 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13377 .cindex "domain literal"
13378 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13379 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13380 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13381 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13382
13383 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13384 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13385 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13386 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13387 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13388 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13389 the local host's IP addresses.
13390
13391
13392 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13393 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13394 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13395 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13396 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13397 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13398 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13399 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13400 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13401
13402 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13403 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13404 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13405 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13406 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13407 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13408 experiment if they wish.
13409
13410 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13411 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13412 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13413 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13414 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13415 suitable setting is:
13416 .code
13417 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13418 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13419 .endd
13420 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13421 .code
13422 dns_check_names_pattern =
13423 .endd
13424 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13425
13426
13427 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13428 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13429 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13430 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13431 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13432 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13433 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13434 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13435 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13436 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13437 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13438
13439 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13440 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13441 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13442 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13443 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13444 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13445
13446 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13447 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13448 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13449 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13450 .code
13451 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13452 .endd
13453 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13454 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13455 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13456 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13457
13458
13459 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13460 .cindex "thawing messages"
13461 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13462 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13463 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13464 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13465 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13466 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13467
13468 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13469 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13470 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13471
13472
13473 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13474 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13475 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13476 .code
13477 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13478 .endd
13479 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13480 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13481
13482
13483 .option bi_command main string unset
13484 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13485 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13486 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13487 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13488 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13489
13490
13491 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13492 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13493 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13494 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13495 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13496 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13497
13498
13499 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13500 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13501 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13502 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13503
13504 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13505 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13506 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13507 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13508 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13509 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13510 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13511 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13512 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13513 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13514
13515 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13516 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13517 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13518 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13519
13520
13521 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13522 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13523 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13524 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13525 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13526 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13527 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13528 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13529 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13530
13531 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13532 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13533 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13534 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13535 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13536 messages.
13537
13538 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13539 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13540 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13541 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13542 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13543 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13544 connection. A typical setting might be:
13545 .code
13546 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13547 .endd
13548 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13549 .code
13550 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13551 .endd
13552 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13553 address.
13554
13555 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13556 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13557 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13558 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13559 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13560 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13561
13562
13563 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13564 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13565 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13566 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13567
13568
13569 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13570 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13571 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13572 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13573
13574
13575 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13576 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13577 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13578 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13579
13580
13581 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13582 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13583 callout verification. The default value is
13584 .code
13585 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13586 .endd
13587 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13588
13589
13590 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13591 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13592
13593
13594 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13595 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13596
13597 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13598 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13599 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13600 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13601 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13602 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13603 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13604 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13605 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13606 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13607
13608
13609 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13610 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13611
13612
13613 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13614 .cindex "checking disk space"
13615 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13616 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13617 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13618 message is accepted.
13619
13620 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13621 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13622 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13623 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13624 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13625 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13626 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13627 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13628
13629
13630 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13631 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13632 .code
13633 check_spool_space = 10M
13634 check_spool_inodes = 100
13635 .endd
13636 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13637 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13638 transit.
13639
13640 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13641 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13642 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13643
13644 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13645 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13646 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13647 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13648 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13649 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13650
13651 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13652 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13653
13654 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13655 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13656 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13657
13658 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13659 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13660 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13661 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13662 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13663 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13664
13665 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13666 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13667 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13668 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13669 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13670 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13671 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13672
13673 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13674 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13675
13676 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13677 .cindex "warning of delay"
13678 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13679 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13680 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13681 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13682 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13683 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13684 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13685 with
13686 .code
13687 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13688 .endd
13689 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13690 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13691 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13692 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13693 .code
13694 delay_warning = 6h
13695 .endd
13696 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13697 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13698 .code
13699 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13700 .endd
13701 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
13702 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
13703 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
13704
13705 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13706 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13707 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13708 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13709 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13710 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13711 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13712 not sent. The default is:
13713 .code
13714 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13715 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13716 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13717 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13718 } {no}{yes}}
13719 .endd
13720 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13721 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13722 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13723 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13724
13725 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13726 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13727 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13728 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13729 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13730 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13731 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13732 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13733
13734 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13735 .cindex "load average"
13736 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13737 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13738 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13739 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13740 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13741
13742
13743 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13744 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13745 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13746 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13747 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13748 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13749 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13750 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13751
13752 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13753 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13754 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13755 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13756 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13757 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13758 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13759 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13760
13761 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13762 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13763 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13764 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13765
13766
13767 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13768 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13769 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13770 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13771 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13772 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13773 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13774
13775
13776 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13777 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13778 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13779 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13780 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13781 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13782 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13783 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13784 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13785 by a setting such as this:
13786 .code
13787 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13788 .endd
13789 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13790 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13791 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13792 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13793 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13794 options are applied after this global option.
13795
13796 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13797 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13798 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13799 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13800 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13801 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13802 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13803 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13804 value of this option. The default pattern is
13805 .code
13806 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13807 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13808 .endd
13809 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13810 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13811 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13812 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13813 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13814 empty string.
13815
13816 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13817 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13818 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13819
13820 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13821 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13822 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13823 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13824
13825
13826 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
13827 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13828 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13829 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13830 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
13831 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
13832
13833 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
13834
13835
13836 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13837 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13838 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13839 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13840 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13841 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13842 domain matches this list.
13843
13844 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13845 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13846 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13847
13848
13849 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13850 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13851 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13852 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13853 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13854 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13855 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13856 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13857 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13858 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13859 to set in them.
13860
13861
13862 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13863 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13864
13865
13866 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13867 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13868 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13869 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13870 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13871 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13872 on.
13873
13874 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13875
13876
13877 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13878 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13879 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13880 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13881
13882 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13883 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13884 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13885 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13886 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13887 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13888 .code
13889 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13890 .endd
13891 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13892 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13893
13894 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13895 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13896 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13897 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13898 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13899 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13900 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13901 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13902 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13903
13904
13905 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13906 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13907 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13908 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13909 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13910 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13911 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13912 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13913 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13914
13915 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13916 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13917 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13918 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13919 are examined. For example:
13920 .code
13921 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13922 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13923 postmaster@mydomain.example
13924 .endd
13925 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13926 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13927 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13928 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13929 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13930 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13931 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13932
13933
13934 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13935 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13936 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13937 .display
13938 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13939 .endd
13940 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13941 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13942 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13943 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13944 overrides the default.
13945
13946 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13947 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13948 and warning messages. For example:
13949 .code
13950 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13951 .endd
13952 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13953 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13954 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13955 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13956 not used.
13957
13958
13959 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13960 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13961 .cindex "Exim group"
13962 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13963 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13964 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13965 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13966 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13967 security issues.
13968
13969
13970 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13971 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13972 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13973 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13974 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13975 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13976 other place.
13977 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13978 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13979 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13980 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13981
13982
13983 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13984 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13985 .cindex "Exim user"
13986 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13987 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13988 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13989 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13990
13991 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13992 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13993 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13994 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13995
13996
13997 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13998 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13999 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14000 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14001
14002
14003 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14004 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14005
14006 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
14007 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14008 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14009 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14010 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14011 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14012 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14013 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14014 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14015 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14016 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14017 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14018 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14019 addresses.
14020
14021
14022 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14023 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14024 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14025 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14026 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14027 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14028 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14029 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14030 retries.
14031
14032 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14033 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14034 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14035 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14036
14037
14038
14039 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14040 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14041 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14042 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14043 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14044 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14045 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14046 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14047 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14048 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14049 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14050 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14051 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14052 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14053 logging that you require.
14054
14055
14056 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14057 .cindex "HP-UX"
14058 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14059 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14060 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14061 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14062 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14063 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14064 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14065 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14066
14067 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14068 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14069 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14070 user's name.
14071
14072 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14073 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14074 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14075 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14076 .code
14077 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14078 gecos_name = $1
14079 .endd
14080
14081 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14082 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14083
14084
14085 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14086 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14087 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14088 implementations of TLS.
14089
14090
14091 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14092 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14093 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14094
14095 See
14096 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14097 for documentation.
14098
14099
14100
14101 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14102 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14103 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14104 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14105 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14106 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14107
14108
14109
14110 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14111 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14112 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14113 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14114 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14115 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14116 sections are rejected.
14117
14118
14119 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14120 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14121 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14122 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14123 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14124 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14125 zero means &"no limit"&.
14126
14127
14128
14129
14130 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14131 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14132 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14133 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14134 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14135 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14136 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14137 if you want to do semantic checking.
14138 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14139 set.
14140
14141
14142 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14143 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14144 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14145 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14146 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14147 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14148 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14149 .code
14150 helo_allow_chars = _
14151 .endd
14152 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14153
14154
14155 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14156 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14157 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14158 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14159 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14160 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14161 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14162 do.
14163
14164
14165 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14166 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14167 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14168 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14169 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14170 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14171 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14172 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14173 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14174 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14175 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14176 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14177
14178 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14179 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14180 EHLO command either:
14181
14182 .ilist
14183 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14184 .next
14185 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14186 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14187 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14188 calling host address, or
14189 .next
14190 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
14191 available) yields the calling host address.
14192 .endlist
14193
14194 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14195 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14196 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14197
14198 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14199 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14200 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14201 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14202 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14203 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14204 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14205 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14206 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14207 error.
14208
14209 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14210 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14211 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14212 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14213 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14214 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14215 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14216 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14217 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14218
14219 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14220 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14221 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14222 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14223 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14224
14225 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14226 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14227 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14228 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14229
14230
14231 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14232 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14233 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14234 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14235 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14236 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14237 default configuration file contains
14238 .code
14239 host_lookup = *
14240 .endd
14241 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14242 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14243
14244 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14245 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14246 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14247
14248 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14249 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14250 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14251 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14252 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14253 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14254
14255
14256 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14257 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14258 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14259 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14260 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14261 if you want.
14262
14263 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14264 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14265 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14266 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14267
14268
14269
14270 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14271 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14272 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14273 as soon as the connection is made.
14274 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14275 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14276 connections immediately.
14277
14278 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14279 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14280 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14281 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14282 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14283
14284
14285 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14286 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14287 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14288 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14289 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14290 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14291 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14292 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14293 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14294 .code
14295 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14296 .endd
14297 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14298
14299
14300
14301 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14302 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14303 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14304 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14305 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14306 records
14307 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14308 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14309
14310 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14311 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14312 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14313 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14314 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14315 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14316 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14317
14318
14319 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14320 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14321 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14322 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14323 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14324
14325
14326
14327 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14328 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14329 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14330 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14331 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14332 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14333
14334 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14335 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14336 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14337 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14338 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14339 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14340 for frozen messages. For example,
14341 .code
14342 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14343 .endd
14344 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14345 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14346 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14347 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14348 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14349 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14350
14351
14352 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14353 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14354 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14355 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14356 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14357 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14358 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14359 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14360 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14361 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14362
14363
14364 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14365 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14366
14367
14368 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14369 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14370 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14371 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14372 logged.
14373
14374
14375 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14376 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14377 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14378 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14379 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14380 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14381 and constrained to be a directory.
14382
14383
14384 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14385 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14386 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14387 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14388 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14389 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14390 and constrained to be a file.
14391
14392
14393 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14394 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14395 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14396 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14397 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14398
14399
14400 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14401 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14402 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14403 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14404 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14405 identity to be proven.
14406
14407
14408 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14409 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14410 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14411 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14412 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14413
14414
14415 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14416 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14417 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14418 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14419 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14420 with LDAP support.
14421
14422
14423 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14424 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14425 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14426 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14427 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14428 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14429 to hard/demand.
14430
14431
14432 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14433 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14434 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14435 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14436 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14437 of SSL-on-connect.
14438 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14439 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14440
14441
14442 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14443 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14444 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14445 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14446 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14447 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14448 has been built with LDAP support.
14449
14450
14451
14452 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14453 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14454 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14455 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14456 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14457 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14458 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14459
14460 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14461 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14462 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14463
14464 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14465 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14466 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14467 and the default qualify domain.
14468
14469 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14470 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14471 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14472 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14473
14474 .cindex "envelope sender"
14475 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14476 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14477 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14478
14479 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14480 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14481 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14482
14483
14484
14485
14486 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14487 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14488 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14489 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14490 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14491 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14492 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14493 example, if
14494 .code
14495 local_from_prefix = *-
14496 .endd
14497 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14498 .code
14499 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14500 .endd
14501 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14502 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14503 qualify domain.
14504
14505
14506 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14507 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14508
14509
14510 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14511 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14512 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14513 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14514 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14515 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14516 &%local_interfaces%& is
14517 .code
14518 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14519 .endd
14520 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14521 .code
14522 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14523 .endd
14524
14525 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14526 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14527 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14528 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14529 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14530 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14531 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14532 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14533
14534
14535
14536 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14537 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14538 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14539 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14540 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14541 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14542 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14543 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14544
14545
14546
14547
14548 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14549 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14550 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14551 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14552 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14553 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14554 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14555 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14556 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14557 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14558 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14559 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14560 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14561 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14562 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14563
14564
14565
14566 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14567 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14568 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14569 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14570 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14571 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14572 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14573 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14574 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14575 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14576 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14577 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14578 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14579 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14580
14581
14582 .option log_selector main string unset
14583 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14584 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14585 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14586 minus characters. For example:
14587 .code
14588 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14589 .endd
14590 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14591 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14592
14593
14594 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14595 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14596 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14597 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14598 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14599 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14600 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14601 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14602 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14603 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14604 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14605 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14606 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14607
14608
14609 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14610 .cindex "too many open files"
14611 .cindex "open files, too many"
14612 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14613 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14614 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14615 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14616 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14617 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14618 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14619 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14620 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14621 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14622 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14623 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14624
14625
14626 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14627 .cindex "length of login name"
14628 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14629 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14630 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14631 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14632 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14633 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14634
14635
14636 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14637 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14638 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14639 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14640 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14641 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14642 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14643 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14644
14645
14646 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14647 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14648 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14649 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14650 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14651 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14652 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14653
14654
14655 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14656 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14657 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14658 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14659 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14660 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14661 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14662 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14663 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14664 empty string, the option is ignored.
14665
14666
14667 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14668 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14669 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14670 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14671 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14672 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14673 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14674 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14675 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14676 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14677 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14678 colons will become hyphens.
14679
14680
14681 .option message_logs main boolean true
14682 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14683 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14684 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14685 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14686 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14687 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14688 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14689 which is not affected by this option.
14690
14691
14692 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14693 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14694 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14695 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14696 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14697 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14698 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14699 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14700 optionally followed by K or M.
14701
14702 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14703 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14704 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14705 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14706 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14707
14708 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14709 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14710 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14711 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14712 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14713 message that an individual transport can process.
14714
14715 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14716 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14717 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14718 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14719 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14720 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14721 some problems may result.
14722
14723 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14724 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14725 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14726
14727
14728 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14729 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14730 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14731 .code
14732 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14733 .endd
14734 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14735 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14736 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14737 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14738 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14739
14740
14741 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14742 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14743 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14744 contains a full description of this facility.
14745
14746
14747
14748 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14749 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14750 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14751 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14752 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14753
14754
14755 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14756 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14757 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14758 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14759 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14760 safety precaution.
14761
14762 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14763 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14764 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14765 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14766 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14767
14768 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14769 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14770 example is
14771 .code
14772 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14773 .endd
14774 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14775 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14776 transport driver.
14777
14778
14779 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
14780 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14781 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14782 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14783 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14784
14785 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14786 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14787 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14788 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14789 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14790 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14791 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14792
14793 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14794 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14795 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14796 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14797 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14798
14799 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
14800 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14801 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14802 some now infamous attacks.
14803
14804 An example:
14805 .code
14806 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14807 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14808 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14809 .endd
14810
14811 Possible options may include:
14812 .ilist
14813 &`all`&
14814 .next
14815 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14816 .next
14817 &`cipher_server_preference`&
14818 .next
14819 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14820 .next
14821 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
14822 .next
14823 &`legacy_server_connect`&
14824 .next
14825 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14826 .next
14827 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14828 .next
14829 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14830 .next
14831 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14832 .next
14833 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14834 .next
14835 &`no_compression`&
14836 .next
14837 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14838 .next
14839 &`no_sslv2`&
14840 .next
14841 &`no_sslv3`&
14842 .next
14843 &`no_ticket`&
14844 .next
14845 &`no_tlsv1`&
14846 .next
14847 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
14848 .next
14849 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
14850 .next
14851 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
14852 .next
14853 &`single_dh_use`&
14854 .next
14855 &`single_ecdh_use`&
14856 .next
14857 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14858 .next
14859 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14860 .next
14861 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14862 .next
14863 &`tls_d5_bug`&
14864 .next
14865 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
14866 .endlist
14867
14868 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
14869 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
14870 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
14871 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
14872 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
14873 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
14874
14875
14876 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14877 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14878 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14879 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14880 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14881
14882
14883 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14884 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14885 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14886 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14887 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14888 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14889 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14890 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14891 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14892 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14893 an ACL.
14894
14895 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14896 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14897 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14898 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14899 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14900 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14901 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14902
14903
14904 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14905 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14906 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14907
14908
14909 .option perl_startup main string unset
14910 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14911 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14912
14913
14914 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14915 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14916 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14917 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14918 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14919 PostgreSQL support.
14920
14921
14922 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14923 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14924 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14925 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14926 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14927 to the host name:
14928 .code
14929 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14930 .endd
14931 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14932 spool directory.
14933 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14934 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14935 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14936
14937
14938 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14939 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14940 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14941 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14942 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14943 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14944 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14945 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14946 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14947
14948
14949 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14950 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14951 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14952 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14953 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14954 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14955 volume of mail. Use with care!
14956
14957
14958 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14959 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14960 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14961 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14962 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14963 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14964 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14965 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14966 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14967 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14968
14969 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14970 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14971 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14972 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14973 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14974 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14975
14976
14977 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14978 .cindex "printing characters"
14979 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14980 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14981 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14982 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14983 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14984 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14985 characters.
14986
14987 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14988 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14989 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14990 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14991 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14992 standards.
14993
14994
14995 .option process_log_path main string unset
14996 .cindex "process log path"
14997 .cindex "log" "process log"
14998 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14999 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15000 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15001 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15002 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15003 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15004 different spool directories.
15005
15006
15007 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15008 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15009 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15010 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15011 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15012 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15013 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15014
15015
15016 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15017 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15018 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15019 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15020 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15021 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15022 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15023 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15024 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15025
15026 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15027 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15028 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15029 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15030 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15031 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15032 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15033
15034
15035 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15036 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15037 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15038
15039
15040
15041 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15042 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15043 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15044 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15045 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15046 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15047 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15048 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15049
15050
15051 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15052 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15053 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15054 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15055 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15056
15057
15058 .option queue_only main boolean false
15059 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15060 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15061 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15062 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15063 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15064 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15065
15066 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15067 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15068 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15069 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15070
15071
15072 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15073 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15074 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15075 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15076 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15077 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15078 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15079 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15080 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15081 .code
15082 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15083 .endd
15084 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15085 &_/some/file_& exists.
15086
15087
15088 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15089 .cindex "load average"
15090 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15091 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15092 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15093 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15094 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15095 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15096 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15097 false.
15098
15099 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15100 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15101 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15102 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15103
15104
15105 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15106 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15107 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15108 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15109 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15110 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15111 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15112 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15113 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15114 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15115 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15116 re-evaluated for each message.
15117
15118
15119 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15120 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15121 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15122 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15123 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15124 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15125
15126
15127 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15128 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15129 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15130 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15131 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15132 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15133 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15134 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15135 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15136 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15137 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15138 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15139 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15140
15141
15142
15143 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15144 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15145 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15146 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15147 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15148 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15149 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15150 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15151 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15152
15153 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15154 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15155 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15156 the daemon's command line.
15157
15158 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15159 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15160 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15161 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15162 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15163 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15164 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15165 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15166 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15167 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15168 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15169 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15170 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15171 &%queue_domains%&.
15172
15173
15174 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15175 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15176 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15177 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15178 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15179 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15180 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15181
15182 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15183 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15184 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15185 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15186 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15187 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15188 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15189 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15190 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15191 header lines. The default setting is:
15192
15193 .code
15194 received_header_text = Received: \
15195 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15196 {${if def:sender_ident \
15197 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15198 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15199 by $primary_hostname \
15200 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15201 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15202 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15203 ${if def:sender_address \
15204 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15205 id $message_exim_id\
15206 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15207 .endd
15208
15209 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15210 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15211 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15212 header lines such as the following:
15213 .code
15214 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15215 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15216 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15217 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15218 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15219 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15220 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15221 .endd
15222 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15223 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15224 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15225 message was accepted.
15226
15227
15228 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15229 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15230 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15231 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15232 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15233 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15234 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15235 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15236
15237
15238 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15239 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15240 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15241 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15242 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15243 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15244 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15245 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15246 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15247 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15248 option was not set.
15249
15250
15251 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15252 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15253 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15254 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15255 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15256 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15257 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15258 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15259 done.
15260
15261 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15262 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15263 RCPT commands in a single message.
15264
15265
15266 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15267 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15268 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15269 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15270 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15271 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15272 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15273
15274
15275 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15276 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15277 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15278 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15279 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15280 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15281 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15282 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15283 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15284 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15285 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15286 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15287 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15288 tagged with its process id.
15289
15290 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15291 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15292 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15293 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15294 is received.
15295
15296 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15297 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15298 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15299 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15300 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15301 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15302 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15303 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15304 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15305 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15306 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15307
15308 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15309 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15310 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15311 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15312
15313
15314 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15315 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15316 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15317 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15318 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15319 .code
15320 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15321 .endd
15322 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15323 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15324
15325
15326 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15327 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15328 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15329 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15330 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15331 past failures.
15332
15333
15334 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15335 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15336 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15337 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15338 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15339 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15340 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15341 the default value.
15342
15343
15344 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15345 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15346 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15347 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15348 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15349 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15350 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15351 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15352 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15353 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15354
15355
15356 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15357 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15358
15359
15360 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15361 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15362 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15363 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15364 in the list.
15365
15366 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15367 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15368 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15369 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15370 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15371
15372
15373 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15374 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15375 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15376 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15377 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15378 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15379 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15380 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15381 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15382 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15383
15384
15385 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15386 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15387 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15388 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15389 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15390 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15391 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15392 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15393 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15394 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15395 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15396
15397
15398
15399 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15400 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15401 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15402 .cindex "inetd"
15403 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15404 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15405 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15406 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15407 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15408 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15409
15410 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15411 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15412 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15413 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15414
15415
15416 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15417 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15418 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15419 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15420 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15421 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15422 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15423 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15424
15425 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15426 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15427 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15428 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15429 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15430 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15431 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15432 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15433
15434
15435 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15436 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15437 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15438 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15439 live with.
15440
15441
15442 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15443 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15444 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15445 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15446 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15447 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15448 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15449 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15450 . the option name to split.
15451
15452 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15453 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15454 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15455 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15456 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15457 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15458 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15459 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15460 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15461 seen).
15462
15463
15464 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15465 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15466 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15467 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15468 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15469 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15470 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15471 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15472 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15473 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15474 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15475
15476 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15477 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15478 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15479 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15480 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15481 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15482
15483
15484
15485 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15486 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15487 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15488 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15489 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15490 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15491 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15492 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15493 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15494 to all messages received in the same connection.
15495
15496 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15497 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15498 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15499 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15500
15501
15502 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15503
15504 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15505 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15506 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15507 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15508 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15509 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15510 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15511 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15512 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15513 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15514 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15515 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15516 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15517
15518
15519 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15520 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15521 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15522 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15523 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15524 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15525 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15526 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15527 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15528 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15529 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15530 individual host.
15531
15532 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15533 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15534 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15535 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15536
15537
15538 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15539 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15540 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15541 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15542 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15543 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15544 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15545 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15546 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15547
15548 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15549 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15550 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15551 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15552
15553 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15554 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15555 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15556 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15557 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15558 For example:
15559 .code
15560 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15561 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15562 .endd
15563
15564 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15565 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15566 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15567 &%helo_data%& value.
15568
15569 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15570 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15571 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15572 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15573 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15574 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15575 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15576 .code
15577 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15578 $version_number $tod_full
15579 .endd
15580 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15581 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15582 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15583 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15584 multiline response).
15585
15586
15587 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15588 .cindex "checking disk space"
15589 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15590 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15591 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15592 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15593 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15594 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15595 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15596
15597
15598 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15599 .cindex "connection backlog"
15600 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15601 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15602 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15603 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15604 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15605 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15606 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15607 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15608 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15609 attacks by SYN flooding.
15610
15611
15612 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15613 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15614 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15615 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15616 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15617 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15618 fewer, but they still exist.
15619
15620 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15621 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15622 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15623 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15624 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15625 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15626 does detect many instances.
15627
15628 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15629 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15630 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15631 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15632
15633
15634
15635 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15636 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15637 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15638 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15639 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15640 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15641 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15642 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15643 example:
15644 .code
15645 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15646 $sender_host_address
15647 .endd
15648 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15649 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15650 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15651 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15652 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15653 the command.
15654
15655
15656 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15657 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15658 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15659 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15660 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15661
15662
15663 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15664 .cindex "load average"
15665 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15666 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15667 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15668 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15669 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15670 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15671
15672
15673
15674 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15675 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15676 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15677 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15678 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15679 .code
15680 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15681 .endd
15682 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15683 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15684 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15685 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15686 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15687
15688 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15689 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15690 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15691 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15692 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15693 not count towards the limit.
15694
15695
15696
15697 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15698 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15699 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15700 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15701 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15702 that subvert web
15703 clients
15704 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15705 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15706
15707
15708
15709 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15710 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15711 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15712 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15713 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15714 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15715 recipients.
15716
15717 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15718 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15719 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15720 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15721
15722 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15723 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15724 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15725 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15726 values:
15727
15728 .ilist
15729 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15730 .next
15731 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15732 fractional parts are allowed here.
15733 .next
15734 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15735 .next
15736 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15737 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15738 .endlist
15739
15740 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15741 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15742 .code
15743 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15744 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15745 .endd
15746 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15747 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15748 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15749 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15750
15751
15752 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15753 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15754
15755
15756 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15757 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15758
15759
15760 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15761 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15762 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15763 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15764 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15765 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15766 the message is abandoned.
15767 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15768 .code
15769 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15770 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15771 .endd
15772 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15773 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15774
15775
15776 .oindex "&%-os%&"
15777 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15778 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15779 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15780 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15781 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15782
15783
15784 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15785 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15786 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15787
15788
15789 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15790 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15791 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15792 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15793 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15794 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15795 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15796 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15797 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15798 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15799 .code
15800 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15801 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15802 .endd
15803
15804 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15805 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15806 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15807 The default value is
15808 .code
15809 127.0.0.1 783
15810 .endd
15811 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15812
15813
15814
15815 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15816 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15817 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15818 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15819 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15820 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15821 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15822 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15823 arrival of the message.
15824
15825 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15826 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15827 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15828 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15829 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15830
15831 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15832 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15833 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15834 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15835 automatically deleted.
15836
15837 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15838 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15839 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15840 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15841 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15842 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15843 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15844 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15845 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15846
15847
15848 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15849 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15850 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15851 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15852 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15853 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15854 &$primary_hostname$&.
15855
15856 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15857 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15858 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15859 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15860 as failures in the configuration file.
15861
15862 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15863 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15864
15865 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15866 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15867 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15868 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15869
15870 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15871 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15872 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15873 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15874 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15875 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15876
15877 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15878 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15879 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15880 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15881 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15882 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15883 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15884
15885
15886 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15887 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15888 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15889 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15890 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15891 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15892 domain causes a syntax error.
15893 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15894 syntax checking.
15895
15896
15897 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15898 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15899 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15900 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15901 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15902 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15903 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15904 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15905 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15906 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15907 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15908 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15909
15910
15911 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15912 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15913 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15914 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15915 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15916 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15917 details of Exim's logging.
15918
15919
15920
15921 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15922 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15923 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15924 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15925 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15926
15927
15928
15929 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15930 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15931 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15932 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15933 details of Exim's logging.
15934
15935
15936 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15937 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15938 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15939 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15940 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15941 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15942 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15943 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15944 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15945 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15946 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15947
15948
15949 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15950 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15951 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15952 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15953 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15954 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15955
15956
15957 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15958 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15959 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15960 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15961 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15962
15963 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15964 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15965 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15966 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15967 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15968
15969 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15970 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15971 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15972 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15973 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15974 contains the pipe command.
15975
15976
15977 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15978 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15979 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15980 is used in a system filter.
15981
15982
15983 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15984 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15985 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15986 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15987 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15988 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15989 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15990 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15991 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15992 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15993
15994 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15995 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15996 transport option overrides.
15997
15998
15999 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16000 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16001 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16002 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16003 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16004 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16005 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16006 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16007 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16008 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16009 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16010 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16011 TCP_NODELAY.
16012
16013
16014 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16015 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16016 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16017 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16018 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16019 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16020 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16021 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16022 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16023 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16024
16025 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16026 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16027 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16028
16029
16030 .option timezone main string unset
16031 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16032 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16033 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16034 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16035 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16036 .code
16037 timezone = UTC
16038 .endd
16039 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16040 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16041 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16042 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16043 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16044 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16045
16046
16047 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16048 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16049 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16050 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16051 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16052 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16053 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16054 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16055
16056
16057 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16058 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16059 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16060 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16061 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16062 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16063 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16064
16065 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16066 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16067 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16068 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16069
16070 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16071 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16072 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16073 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16074
16075 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16076 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16077 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16078 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16079 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16080
16081 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16082
16083
16084 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16085 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16086 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16087 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16088 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16089 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16090
16091 The value must be at least 1024.
16092
16093 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16094 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16095 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16096
16097 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16098 number.
16099
16100 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16101 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16102 larger prime than requested.
16103
16104
16105 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16106 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16107 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16108 to be used by Exim.
16109
16110 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16111 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16112 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16113 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16114 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16115 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16116 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16117
16118 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16119 loaded by Exim.
16120
16121 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16122 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16123 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16124 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16125
16126 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16127 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16128 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16129 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16130
16131 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16132 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16133 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16134 "ike23".
16135
16136 The available primes are:
16137 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16138 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16139 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16140
16141 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16142 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16143
16144 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16145 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16146 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16147 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16148 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16149 userbase.
16150
16151 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16152 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16153 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16154 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16155 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16156 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16157 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16158
16159
16160 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16161 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16162 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16163 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16164 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16165
16166
16167
16168 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16169 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16170 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16171 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16172 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16173 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16174 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16175
16176 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16177
16178
16179 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16180 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16181 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16182 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16183 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16184 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16185 TLS session.
16186
16187
16188 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16189 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16190 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16191 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16192 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16193 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16194 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16195 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16196 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16197 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16198 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16199
16200
16201 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16202 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16203 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16204 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16205
16206
16207 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
16208 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16209 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16210 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
16211 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
16212 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
16213 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
16214 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
16215 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
16216
16217 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16218 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16219 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16220 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16221 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16222 use OpenSSL with a directory.
16223
16224 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16225
16226 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16227 being unset.
16228
16229
16230 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16231 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16232 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16233 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16234 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16235 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16236 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16237 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16238
16239 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16240 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16241 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16242 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16243 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16244 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16245 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16246
16247 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16248 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16249 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16250 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16251 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16252 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16253 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16254 certificate"&.
16255
16256 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16257 certificates.
16258
16259
16260 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16261 .cindex "trusted groups"
16262 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16263 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16264 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16265 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16266 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16267 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16268 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16269 are trusted.
16270
16271 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16272 .cindex "trusted users"
16273 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16274 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16275 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16276 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16277 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16278 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16279 Exim user are trusted.
16280
16281 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16282 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16283 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16284 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16285 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16286 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16287 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16288 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16289 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16290 &%-F%& option.
16291
16292 .option unknown_username main string unset
16293 See &%unknown_login%&.
16294
16295 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16296 .cindex "trusted users"
16297 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16298 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16299 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16300 .cindex "envelope sender"
16301 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16302 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16303 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16304 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16305 is used) is ignored.
16306
16307 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16308 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16309 .code
16310 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16311 .endd
16312 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16313 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16314 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16315 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16316 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16317 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16318 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16319 followed by a hyphen
16320 by a setting like this:
16321 .code
16322 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16323 .endd
16324 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16325 restriction, you can use
16326 .code
16327 untrusted_set_sender = *
16328 .endd
16329 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16330 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16331 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16332 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16333 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16334 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16335 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16336 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16337
16338 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16339 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16340 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16341 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16342 sender address.
16343
16344
16345 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16346 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16347 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16348 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16349 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16350 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16351 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16352 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16353 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16354 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16355 .code
16356 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16357 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16358 .endd
16359 The pattern can be seen by running
16360 .code
16361 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16362 .endd
16363 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16364 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16365 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16366 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16367 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16368 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16369
16370
16371 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16372 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16373
16374
16375 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16376 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16377 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16378 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16379 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16380 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16381 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16382 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16383
16384
16385 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16386 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16387 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16388 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16389 .ecindex IIDconfima
16390 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16391
16392
16393
16394
16395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16396 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16397
16398 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16399 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16400 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16401 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16402 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16403
16404 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16405 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16406 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16407 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16408 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16409
16410
16411
16412 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16413 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16414 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16415 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16416 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16417 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16418 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16419
16420 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16421 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16422 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16423 routers, and the eventual transport.
16424
16425 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16426 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16427 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16428 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16429 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16430
16431 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16432 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16433 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16434 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16435 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16436
16437 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16438 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16439 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16440 .code
16441 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16442 .endd
16443 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16444 .code
16445 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16446 .endd
16447 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16448 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16449
16450 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16451 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16452 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16453 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16454 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16455 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16456 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16457
16458
16459
16460 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16461 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
16462 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16463 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16464 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16465 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16466 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16467 routing.
16468
16469
16470
16471 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16472 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16473 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16474 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16475 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16476 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16477 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16478 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16479 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16480 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16481 you could put:
16482 .code
16483 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16484 .endd
16485 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16486 and
16487 .code
16488 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16489 .endd
16490 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16491 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16492 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16493 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16494
16495
16496 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16497 .cindex "case of local parts"
16498 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16499 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16500 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16501 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16502 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16503 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16504 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16505 more details.
16506
16507 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16508 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16509 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16510 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16511 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16512 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16513 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16514 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16515 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16516
16517 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16518 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16519 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16520 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16521
16522
16523
16524 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16525 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16526 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16527 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16528 .vindex "&$home$&"
16529 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16530 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16531 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16532 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16533 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16534 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16535 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16536 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16537 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16538 the router is skipped.
16539
16540 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16541 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16542 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16543 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16544 setting to achieve this. For example:
16545 .code
16546 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16547 .endd
16548 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16549 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16550 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16551
16552
16553
16554 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16555 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16556 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16557 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16558 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16559 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16560 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16561 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16562
16563 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16564 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16565
16566 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16567 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16568
16569 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16570 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16571 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16572 .code
16573 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16574 .endd
16575 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16576 .code
16577 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16578 .endd
16579
16580 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16581 .code
16582 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16583 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16584 condition = foobar
16585 .endd
16586
16587 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16588 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16589 be specified using &%condition%&.
16590
16591
16592 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16593 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16594 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16595 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
16596 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16597 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16598 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16599 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16600 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16601 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16602 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16603 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16604 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16605 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
16606
16607
16608
16609 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16610 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16611 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16612 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16613 transport option of the same name.
16614
16615
16616 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16617 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16618 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16619 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16620 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16621 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16622 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16623 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16624
16625
16626
16627 .option driver routers string unset
16628 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16629 to be used.
16630
16631
16632
16633 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16634 .cindex "envelope sender"
16635 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16636 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16637 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16638 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16639 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16640 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16641 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16642
16643 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16644 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16645 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16646 setting.
16647
16648 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16649 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16650 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16651 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16652
16653 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16654 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16655 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16656 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16657 settings:
16658 .code
16659 errors_to =
16660 errors_to = ""
16661 .endd
16662 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16663 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16664 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16665 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16666 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16667
16668 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16669 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16670 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16671 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16672 setting &%return_path%&.
16673
16674 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16675 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16676 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16677
16678
16679
16680 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16681 .cindex "address" "testing"
16682 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16683 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16684 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16685 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16686 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16687 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16688 on for the system alias file.
16689 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16690 are evaluated.
16691
16692 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16693 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16694 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16695
16696
16697
16698 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16699 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16700 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16701 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16702
16703
16704
16705 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16706 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16707 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16708
16709
16710
16711 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16712 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16713 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16714
16715
16716
16717 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16718 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16719 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16720 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16721 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16722 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16723 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16724 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16725 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16726
16727 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16728 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16729 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16730 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16731 transport for further details.
16732
16733
16734 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16735 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16736 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16737 .cindex "transport" "local"
16738 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16739 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16740 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16741 process.
16742 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16743 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16744 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16745 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16746 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16747
16748
16749
16750 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
16751 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16752 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16753 This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
16754 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
16755 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
16756 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16757 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16758 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16759 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16760 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16761 &"see"& the added header lines.
16762
16763 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16764 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
16765 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
16766 failures are treated as configuration errors.
16767
16768 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
16769 for a router; all listed headers are added.
16770
16771 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16772 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16773
16774 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
16775 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
16776 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16777 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16778 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16779 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16780 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16781 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16782 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16783 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16784
16785
16786
16787 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
16788 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
16789 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16790 This option specifies a list of text headers, colon-separated,
16791 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
16792 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
16793 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16794 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16795 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16796 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16797 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16798 &"see"& the original header lines.
16799
16800 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16801 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
16802 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16803 errors.
16804
16805 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
16806 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
16807
16808 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16809 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16810
16811 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16812 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16813 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16814 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16815
16816
16817 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16818 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16819 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16820 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16821 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16822 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16823 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16824 like
16825 .code
16826 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16827 .endd
16828 by setting
16829 .code
16830 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16831 .endd
16832 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16833 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16834 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16835 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16836 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16837 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16838
16839 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16840 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16841 .code
16842 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16843 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16844 .endd
16845 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16846 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16847
16848 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16849 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16850 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16851 domain that is being routed.
16852
16853 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16854 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16855 checked.
16856
16857 .option initgroups routers boolean false
16858 .cindex "additional groups"
16859 .cindex "groups" "additional"
16860 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16861 .cindex "transport" "local"
16862 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16863 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16864 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16865 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16866 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16867
16868
16869
16870 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16871 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16872 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16873 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16874 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16875 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16876 evaluated.
16877
16878 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16879 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16880 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16881 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16882 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16883 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16884 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16885 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16886 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16887
16888 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16889 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16890 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16891 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16892 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16893 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16894 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16895 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16896 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16897 the relevant transport.
16898
16899 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16900 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16901 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16902 callout.
16903
16904 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16905 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16906 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16907 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16908 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16909 .code
16910 real_localuser:
16911 driver = accept
16912 local_part_prefix = real-
16913 check_local_user
16914 transport = local_delivery
16915 .endd
16916 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16917 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16918 .code
16919 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16920 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16921 .endd
16922
16923 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16924 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16925 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16926 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16927
16928
16929 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16930 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16931
16932
16933
16934 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16935 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16936 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16937 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16938 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16939 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16940 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16941 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16942 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16943 &%username-foo%&.
16944
16945
16946 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16947 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16948
16949
16950
16951 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16952 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16953 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16954 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16955 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16956 are evaluated, and
16957 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16958 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16959 example:
16960 .code
16961 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16962 .endd
16963 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16964 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16965 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16966 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16967 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16968 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16969 each virtual domain:
16970 .code
16971 postmaster:
16972 driver = redirect
16973 local_parts = postmaster
16974 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16975 .endd
16976
16977
16978 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16979 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16980 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16981 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16982 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16983 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16984 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16985 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16986 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16987 redirect addresses.
16988
16989
16990
16991 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16992 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16993 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16994 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16995 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16996 delivery to be deferred.
16997
16998 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16999 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17000 .oindex "&%self%&"
17001 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17002 means of the setting
17003 .code
17004 self = pass
17005 .endd
17006 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17007 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17008 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17009
17010 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17011 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17012 controls what happens next.
17013
17014
17015 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17016 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17017 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17018 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17019 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17020 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17021 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17022 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17023
17024 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17025 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17026 applies to all of them.
17027
17028
17029
17030 .option pass_router routers string unset
17031 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17032 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17033 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17034 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17035 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17036 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17037 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17038 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17039 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17040 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17041
17042
17043
17044 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17045 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17046 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17047 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17048 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17049 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17050
17051 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17052 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17053 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17054 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17055
17056
17057
17058 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17059 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17060 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17061 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17062 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17063 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17064 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17065
17066 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17067 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17068 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17069 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17070
17071 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17072 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17073 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17074 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17075 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17076
17077 .cindex "NFS"
17078 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17079 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17080 unavailable.
17081
17082 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17083 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17084 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17085 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17086 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17087 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17088 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17089 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17090
17091 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17092 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17093 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17094 operates as follows:
17095
17096 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17097 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17098 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17099 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17100 used. For example:
17101 .code
17102 require_files = mail:/some/file
17103 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17104 .endd
17105 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17106 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17107
17108 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17109 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17110 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17111 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17112
17113 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17114 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17115 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17116 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17117 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17118
17119 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17120 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17121 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17122 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17123 check again in that process.
17124
17125 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17126 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17127 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17128 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17129 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17130 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17131 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17132 .code
17133 require_files = +/some/file
17134 .endd
17135 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17136 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17137 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17138
17139
17140
17141 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17142 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17143 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17144 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17145 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17146 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17147 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17148 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17149 latter kind.
17150
17151 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17152 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17153 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17154 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17155 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17156 same name.
17157
17158 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17159 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17160 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17161
17162
17163
17164 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17165 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17166 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17167 .vindex "&$home$&"
17168 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17169 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17170 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17171 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17172 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17173 cause the router to defer.
17174
17175 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17176 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17177 place.
17178 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17179 are evaluated.)
17180 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17181 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17182
17183 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17184 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17185 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17186 of these values that is set:
17187
17188 .ilist
17189 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17190 .next
17191 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17192 .next
17193 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17194 .next
17195 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17196 .endlist
17197
17198 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17199 router, but not for the transport.
17200
17201
17202
17203 .option self routers string freeze
17204 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17205 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17206 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17207 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17208 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17209 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17210 of remote hosts.
17211 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17212 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17213 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17214 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17215 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17216
17217 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17218 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17219 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17220 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17221 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17222 cases:
17223
17224 .vlist
17225 .vitem &%defer%&
17226 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17227
17228 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17229 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17230 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17231 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17232
17233 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17234 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17235 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17236 rewritten.
17237
17238 .vitem &%pass%&
17239 .oindex "&%more%&"
17240 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17241 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17242 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17243 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17244 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17245 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17246 combination
17247 .code
17248 self = pass
17249 no_more
17250 .endd
17251 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17252 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17253 be passed to the next router.
17254
17255 .vitem &%fail%&
17256 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17257
17258 .vitem &%send%&
17259 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17260 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17261 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17262 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17263 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17264 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17265 .endlist
17266
17267
17268
17269 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17270 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17271 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17272 address matches something on the list.
17273 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17274 are evaluated.
17275
17276 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17277 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17278 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17279 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17280 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17281 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17282 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17283 matters.
17284
17285
17286 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17287 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17288 .cindex "packet radio"
17289 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17290 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17291 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17292 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17293 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17294 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17295 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17296 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17297
17298 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17299 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17300 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17301 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17302 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17303 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17304 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17305 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17306 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17307 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17308 .code
17309 translate_ip_address = \
17310 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17311 {$value}fail}}
17312 .endd
17313 The file would contain lines like
17314 .code
17315 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17316 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17317 .endd
17318 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17319 are doing.
17320
17321
17322
17323 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17324 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17325 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17326 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17327 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17328 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17329 delivery is deferred.
17330
17331 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17332 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17333 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17334
17335
17336
17337 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17338 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17339 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17340 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17341 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17342 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17343 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17344 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17345 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17346 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17347 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17348 environment.
17349
17350
17351
17352
17353 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17354 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17355 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17356 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17357 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17358 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17359 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17360 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17361 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17362 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17363
17364 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17365 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17366 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17367 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17368 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17369
17370 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17371 environment.
17372
17373
17374
17375
17376 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17377 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17378 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17379 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17380 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17381 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17382 delivery to be deferred.
17383
17384 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17385 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17386 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17387 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17388 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17389 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17390
17391 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17392 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17393 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17394 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17395 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17396 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17397 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17398 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17399
17400 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17401 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17402 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17403 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17404 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17405 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17406 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17407 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17408 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17409 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17410
17411 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17412 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17413 subsequent routers.
17414
17415
17416 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17417 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17418 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17419 .cindex "transport" "local"
17420 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17421 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17422 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17423 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17424 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17425 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17426 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17427 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17428 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17429 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17430 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17431 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17432
17433
17434
17435 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17436 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17437 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17438
17439
17440 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17441 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17442 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
17443 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17444 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
17445 delivering in cutthrough mode or
17446 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17447 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17448 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17449 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17450
17451 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17452 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17453 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17454 user or group.
17455
17456
17457 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17458 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17459 addresses,
17460 delivering in cutthrough mode
17461 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17462 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17463 are evaluated.
17464
17465
17466 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17467 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17468 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17469 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17470 are evaluated.
17471 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17472 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17473
17474
17475
17476
17477
17478
17479 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17481
17482 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17483 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17484 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17485 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17486 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17487 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17488 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17489 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17490 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17491 .code
17492 localusers:
17493 driver = accept
17494 domains = mydomain.example
17495 check_local_user
17496 transport = local_delivery
17497 .endd
17498 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17499 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17500 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17501 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17502
17503
17504
17505
17506
17507
17508 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17510
17511 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17512 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17513 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17514 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17515 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17516 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17517
17518 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17519 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17520 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17521 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17522 records.
17523
17524 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17525 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17526 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17527 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17528 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17529 generic option, the router declines.
17530
17531 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17532 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17533 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17534
17535 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17536 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17537 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17538 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17539 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17540 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17541
17542
17543 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17544 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17545 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17546 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17547 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17548 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17549
17550 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17551 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17552 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17553 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17554 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17555 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17556 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17557 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17558 case routing fails.
17559
17560
17561 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17562 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17563 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17564 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17565 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17566
17567 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17568 .ilist
17569 The domain does not exist in DNS
17570 .next
17571 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17572 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17573 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17574 .next
17575 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17576 .next
17577 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17578 .next
17579 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17580 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17581 .next
17582 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17583 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17584 .next
17585 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17586 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17587 .next
17588 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17589 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17590 .endlist
17591
17592
17593
17594
17595 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17596 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17597 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17598
17599 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17600 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17601 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17602 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17603 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17604 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17605 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17606
17607
17608 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17609 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17610 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17611 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17612 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17613 required. For example,
17614 .code
17615 check_srv = smtp
17616 .endd
17617 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17618 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17619 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17620 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17621 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17622 normal way.
17623
17624 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17625 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17626 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17627 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17628 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17629 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17630
17631 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17632 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17633 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17634 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17635 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17636 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17637 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17638 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17639
17640 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17641 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17642
17643
17644
17645 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17646 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17647 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17648 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17649 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17650 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17651 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17652 setting:
17653 .code
17654 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17655 .endd
17656 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17657 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17658 the address record.
17659
17660
17661 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17662 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17663 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17664 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17665
17666
17667
17668
17669 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17670 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17671 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17672 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17673 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17674 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17675 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17676 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17677 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17678 &'resolv.conf'&.
17679
17680
17681
17682 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17683 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17684 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17685 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17686 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17687 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17688 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17689 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17690 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17691 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17692 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17693
17694 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17695 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17696 sense.
17697
17698 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17699 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17700 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17701 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17702 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17703 header rewriting.
17704
17705
17706 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17707 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17708 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17709 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17710 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17711 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17712 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17713 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17714
17715 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17716 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17717 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17718 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17719 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17720 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17721 without processing them independently,
17722 provided the following conditions are met:
17723
17724 .ilist
17725 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17726 &%headers_remove%&.
17727 .next
17728 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17729 the domain.
17730 .endlist
17731
17732
17733
17734
17735 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17736 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17737 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17738 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17739 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17740 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17741 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17742 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17743 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17744 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17745
17746 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17747 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17748 local wildcard.
17749
17750
17751
17752 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17753 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17754 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17755 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17756
17757
17758
17759
17760 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17761 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17762 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17763 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17764 if
17765 .code
17766 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17767 .endd
17768 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17769 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17770 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17771 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17772 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17773 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17774
17775
17776 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17777 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17778 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17779 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17780 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17781
17782 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17783 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17784 such as that implied by
17785 .code
17786 domains = @mx_any
17787 .endd
17788 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17789 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17790 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17791 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17792
17793
17794
17795
17796
17797
17798
17799
17800
17801 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17802 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17803
17804 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17805 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17806 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17807 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17808 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17809 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17810 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17811 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17812 router handles the address
17813 .code
17814 root@[192.168.1.1]
17815 .endd
17816 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17817 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17818 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17819 .code
17820 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17821 .endd
17822 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17823 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17824
17825 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17826 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17827 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17828 &%self%& option determines what happens.
17829
17830 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17831 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17832 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17833 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17834
17835
17836
17837 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17838 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17839
17840 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17841 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17842 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17843 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17844 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17845 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17846 must set
17847 .code
17848 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17849 .endd
17850 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17851
17852 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17853 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17854 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17855 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17856 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17857 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17858 must not be specified for it.
17859
17860 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17861 .option hosts iplookup string unset
17862 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17863 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17864 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17865 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17866 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17867
17868
17869 .option optional iplookup boolean false
17870 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17871 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17872 delivery to the address is deferred.
17873
17874
17875 .option port iplookup integer 0
17876 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17877 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17878 call.
17879
17880
17881 .option protocol iplookup string udp
17882 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17883 protocols is to be used.
17884
17885
17886 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17887 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17888 default value is:
17889 .code
17890 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17891 .endd
17892 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17893 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17894
17895
17896 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17897 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17898 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17899 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17900 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17901 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17902 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17903 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17904
17905
17906 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17907 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17908 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17909 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17910 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17911 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17912 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17913 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17914 following could be used:
17915 .code
17916 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17917 reroute = $local_part@$1
17918 .endd
17919
17920 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17921 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17922 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17923 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17924
17925
17926
17927
17928 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17929 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17930
17931 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17932 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17933 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17934 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17935 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17936 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17937 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17938 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17939 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17940 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17941
17942 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17943 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17944 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17945 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17946 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17947 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17948 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17949
17950 .vindex "&$host$&"
17951 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17952 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17953 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17954 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17955 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17956 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17957 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17958 text string.
17959
17960 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17961 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17962 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17963 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17964 below, following the list of private options.
17965
17966
17967 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17968
17969 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17970 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17971
17972 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17973 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17974
17975 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17976 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17977 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17978 of the following values:
17979 .code
17980 decline
17981 defer
17982 fail
17983 freeze
17984 ignore
17985 pass
17986 .endd
17987 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17988 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17989 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17990 &%pass_router%&),
17991 .oindex "&%more%&"
17992 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17993 router only if &%more%& is true.
17994
17995 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17996 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17997 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17998 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17999
18000 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18001 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18002 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18003
18004
18005 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18006 .cindex "randomized host list"
18007 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18008 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18009 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18010 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18011 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18012 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18013 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18014 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18015
18016 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18017 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18018 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18019 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18020 .code
18021 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18022 .endd
18023 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18024 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18025 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18026 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18027 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18028
18029
18030 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18031 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18032 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18033 example:
18034 .code
18035 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18036 .endd
18037 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18038 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18039 deferred.
18040
18041
18042 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18043 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18044 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18045 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18046
18047
18048 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18049 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18050 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18051 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18052 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18053 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18054 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18055 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18056
18057 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18058 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18059 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18060 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18061 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18062 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18063 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18064 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18065
18066
18067
18068
18069 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18070 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18071 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18072 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18073 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18074 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18075 .display
18076 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18077 .endd
18078 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18079 no options:
18080 .code
18081 route_list = \
18082 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18083 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18084 .endd
18085 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18086 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18087 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18088 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18089 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18090 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18091 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18092 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18093 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18094 in a &%route_list%&).
18095
18096 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18097 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18098 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18099 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18100
18101
18102
18103 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18104 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18105 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18106 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18107 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18108 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18109 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18110 like this:
18111 .code
18112 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18113 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18114 .endd
18115 This data can be accessed by setting
18116 .code
18117 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18118 .endd
18119 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18120 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18121 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18122 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18123 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18124
18125
18126
18127
18128 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18129 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18130 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18131 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18132 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18133 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18134 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18135
18136 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18137 variables are set during its expansion:
18138
18139 .ilist
18140 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18141 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18142 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18143 .code
18144 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18145 .endd
18146 .next
18147 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18148 .next
18149 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18150
18151 .next
18152 .vindex "&$value$&"
18153 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18154 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18155 .code
18156 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18157 .endd
18158 .endlist
18159
18160 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18161 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18162
18163
18164
18165 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18166 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18167 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18168 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18169 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18170 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18171
18172 .ilist
18173 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18174 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18175 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18176 .code
18177 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18178 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18179 .endd
18180 .next
18181 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18182 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18183 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18184 number follows. For example:
18185 .code
18186 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18187 .endd
18188 .endlist
18189
18190 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18191 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18192 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18193 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18194 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18195 transport.
18196
18197 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18198 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18199 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18200 records in the DNS. For example:
18201 .code
18202 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18203 .endd
18204 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18205 example:
18206 .code
18207 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18208 .endd
18209 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18210 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18211 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18212 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18213 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18214 happens is controlled by the
18215 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18216 &%self%& option of the router.
18217
18218 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18219 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18220 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18221 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18222 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18223 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18224 defined by MX preferences.
18225
18226 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18227 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18228 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18229
18230 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18231 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18232 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18233 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18234
18235 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18236 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18237 router.
18238
18239 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18240 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18241 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18242
18243 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18244 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18245
18246
18247
18248 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18249 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18250 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18251 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18252 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18253 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18254 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18255
18256 .ilist
18257 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18258 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18259 .next
18260 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18261 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18262 .next
18263 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18264 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18265 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18266 .next
18267 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18268 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18269 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18270 .endlist
18271
18272 For example:
18273 .code
18274 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18275 domain2 host4:host5
18276 .endd
18277 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18278 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18279 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18280 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18281 call.
18282
18283 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18284 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18285 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18286 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18287 function called.
18288
18289
18290
18291 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18292 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18293
18294 .vindex "&$host$&"
18295 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18296 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18297
18298
18299
18300 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18301 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18302 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18303
18304 .ilist
18305 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18306 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18307 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18308 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18309 .code
18310 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18311 .endd
18312 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18313 your first router something like this:
18314 .code
18315 smart_route:
18316 driver = manualroute
18317 domains = !+local_domains
18318 transport = remote_smtp
18319 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18320 .endd
18321 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18322 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18323 they are tried in order
18324 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18325 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18326 .code
18327 smart_route:
18328 driver = manualroute
18329 transport = remote_smtp
18330 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18331 .endd
18332 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18333 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18334 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18335 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18336 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18337 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18338 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18339 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18340
18341 .next
18342 .cindex "mail hub example"
18343 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18344 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18345 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18346 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18347 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18348 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18349 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18350 lookup is easier to manage.
18351
18352 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18353 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18354 example:
18355 .code
18356 hub_route:
18357 driver = manualroute
18358 transport = remote_smtp
18359 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18360 .endd
18361 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18362 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18363 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18364 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18365 domain can be used to find the host:
18366 .code
18367 through_firewall:
18368 driver = manualroute
18369 transport = remote_smtp
18370 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18371 .endd
18372 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18373 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18374 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18375 next router.
18376
18377 .next
18378 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18379 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18380 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18381 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18382 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18383 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18384 .code
18385 save_in_file:
18386 driver = manualroute
18387 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18388 route_list = saved.domain.example
18389 .endd
18390 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18391 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18392 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18393 .code
18394 save_in_file:
18395 driver = manualroute
18396 route_list = \
18397 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18398 *.saved.domain2.example \
18399 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18400 batch_pipe
18401 .endd
18402 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18403 .vindex "&$host$&"
18404 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18405 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18406 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18407 the address if the lookup fails.
18408
18409 .next
18410 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18411 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18412 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18413 one way it can be done:
18414 .code
18415 # Transport
18416 uucp:
18417 driver = pipe
18418 user = nobody
18419 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18420 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18421 return_fail_output = true
18422
18423 # Router
18424 uucphost:
18425 transport = uucp
18426 driver = manualroute
18427 route_data = \
18428 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18429 .endd
18430 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18431 .code
18432 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18433 .endd
18434 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18435 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18436 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18437 .endlist
18438 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18439 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18440
18441
18442
18443
18444
18445
18446
18447
18448 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18449 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18450
18451 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18452 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18453 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18454 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18455 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18456 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18457 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18458 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18459 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18460 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18461 options:
18462 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18463
18464 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18465 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18466 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18467 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18468 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18469
18470
18471 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18472 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18473 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18474 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18475 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18476 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18477
18478
18479 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18480 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18481 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18482 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18483 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18484 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18485 not set, a value for the gid also.
18486
18487 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18488 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18489 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18490 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18491 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18492 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18493 gid.
18494
18495
18496 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18497 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18498 before running the command.
18499
18500
18501 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18502 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18503 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18504 timeout.
18505
18506
18507 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18508 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18509 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18510 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18511 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18512
18513 .ilist
18514 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18515 below).
18516 .next
18517 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18518 &%no_more%& is set.
18519 .next
18520 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18521 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18522 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18523 included in the SMTP response.
18524 .next
18525 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18526 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18527 included in any SMTP response.
18528 .next
18529 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18530 .next
18531 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18532 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18533 .next
18534 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18535 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18536 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18537 .endlist
18538
18539 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18540 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18541 the page):
18542 .code
18543 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18544 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18545 .endd
18546 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18547 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18548 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18549 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18550
18551 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18552 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18553 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18554 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18555 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18556
18557 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18558 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18559 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18560 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18561 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18562
18563 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18564 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18565 variable. For example, this return line
18566 .code
18567 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18568 .endd
18569 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18570 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18571 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18572 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18573
18574
18575
18576
18577 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18578 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18579
18580 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18581 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18582 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18583 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18584 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18585 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18586 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18587 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18588 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18589 redirected in several different ways:
18590
18591 .ilist
18592 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18593 independently.
18594 .next
18595 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18596 .next
18597 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18598 .next
18599 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18600 .next
18601 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18602 .next
18603 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18604 .next
18605 It can be discarded.
18606 .endlist
18607
18608 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18609 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18610 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18611 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18612
18613
18614
18615 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18616 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18617 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18618 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18619 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18620 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18621 .code
18622 system_aliases:
18623 driver = redirect
18624 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18625 .endd
18626 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18627 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18628 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18629 cause delivery to be deferred.
18630
18631 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18632 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18633 .code
18634 userforward:
18635 driver = redirect
18636 check_local_user
18637 file = $home/.forward
18638 no_verify
18639 .endd
18640 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18641 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18642 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18643 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18644 comments.
18645
18646
18647
18648 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18649 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18650 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18651 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18652
18653 .ilist
18654 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18655 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18656 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18657 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18658 .next
18659 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18660 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18661 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18662 saves some resources.
18663 .endlist
18664
18665
18666
18667
18668
18669
18670 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18671 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18672 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18673 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18674 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18675
18676 .ilist
18677 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18678 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18679 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18680 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18681 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18682 document is intended for use by end users.
18683 .next
18684 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18685 described in the next section.
18686 .endlist
18687
18688 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18689 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18690 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18691 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18692 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18693
18694
18695
18696 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18697 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18698 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18699 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18700 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18701 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18702 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18703 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18704 commas or newlines.
18705 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18706 quotes.
18707
18708 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18709 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18710 next newline character is ignored.
18711
18712 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18713 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18714 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18715 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18716 removed.
18717
18718 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18719 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18720 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18721 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18722 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18723 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18724 setting:
18725 .code
18726 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18727 .endd
18728
18729
18730 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18731 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18732 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18733 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18734 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18735 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18736 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18737 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18738 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18739 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18740 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18741
18742 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18743 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18744 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18745 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18746 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18747 .code
18748 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18749 .endd
18750 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
18751 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18752 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18753 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18754 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18755 synonymously.
18756
18757 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
18758 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18759 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18760 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18761 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18762
18763 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18764 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18765 contains:
18766 .code
18767 Sam.Reman: spqr
18768 .endd
18769 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18770 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18771 this forward file:
18772 .code
18773 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18774 .endd
18775 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18776 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18777 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18778 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18779 should really contain
18780 .code
18781 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18782 .endd
18783 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18784 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18785 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18786
18787
18788
18789 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18790 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18791 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18792
18793 .ilist
18794 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18795 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18796 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18797 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18798 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18799 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18800 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18801
18802 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18803 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18804 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18805 in double quotes, for example:
18806 .code
18807 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18808 .endd
18809 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18810 quote just the command. An item such as
18811 .code
18812 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18813 .endd
18814 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18815
18816 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
18817 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
18818 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
18819 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
18820 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
18821 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
18822 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
18823 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
18824 an &%accept%& router.
18825
18826 .next
18827 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18828 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18829 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18830 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18831 .code
18832 /home/world/minbari
18833 .endd
18834 is treated as a file name, but
18835 .code
18836 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18837 .endd
18838 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18839 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18840 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18841 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18842
18843 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18844 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18845
18846 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18847 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18848 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18849 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18850
18851 .next
18852 .cindex "included address list"
18853 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18854 If an item is of the form
18855 .code
18856 :include:<path name>
18857 .endd
18858 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18859 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18860 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18861 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18862 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18863 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18864 .code
18865 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18866 .endd
18867 It must be given as
18868 .code
18869 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18870 .endd
18871 .next
18872 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18873 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18874 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18875 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18876 .cindex "black hole"
18877 .cindex "abandoning mail"
18878 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18879 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18880 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18881
18882 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18883 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18884 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18885 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18886 &_/dev/null_&.
18887
18888 .next
18889 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18890 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18891 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18892 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18893 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18894 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18895 redirection items of the form
18896 .code
18897 :defer:
18898 :fail:
18899 .endd
18900 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18901 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18902 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18903 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18904 .code
18905 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18906 .endd
18907 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18908 of a
18909 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18910 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18911 default.
18912 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18913 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18914 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18915
18916 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18917 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18918 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18919 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18920 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18921 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18922 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18923 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18924 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18925 ignored.
18926
18927 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18928 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18929 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18930 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18931
18932 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18933 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18934 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18935 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18936 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18937
18938 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18939 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18940 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18941 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18942 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18943 rules still apply.
18944
18945 .next
18946 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18947 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18948 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18949 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18950 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18951 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18952 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18953 .endlist
18954
18955
18956 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18957 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18958 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18959 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18960 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18961 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18962 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18963 aliasing scheme of the type
18964 .code
18965 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18966 localpart1: pipe
18967 localpart2: pipe
18968 .endd
18969 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18970 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18971 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18972 such as
18973 .code
18974 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18975 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18976 .endd
18977 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18978 the pipes are distinct.
18979
18980
18981
18982 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18983 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18984 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18985 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18986 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18987 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18988 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18989 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18990 can be used to avoid this.
18991
18992
18993 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18994 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18995 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18996 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18997 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18998 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18999 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19000
19001
19002
19003 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19004
19005 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19006 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19007
19008
19009 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19010 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19011 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19012
19013
19014 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19015 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19016 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19017 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19018
19019
19020 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19021 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19022 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19023 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19024 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19025 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19026 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19027
19028 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19029 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19030
19031
19032 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19033 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19034 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19035 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19036 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19037
19038
19039
19040 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19041 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19042 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19043 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19044 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19045 let ordinary users do.
19046
19047
19048
19049 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19050 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19051 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19052 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19053 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19054 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19055
19056 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19057 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19058 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19059 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19060 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19061 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19062 .code
19063 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19064 .endd
19065 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19066 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19067 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19068 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19069 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19070 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19071 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19072 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19073
19074
19075 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19076 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19077 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19078 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19079 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19080 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19081 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19082 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19083
19084
19085
19086 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19087 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19088 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19089 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19090 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19091 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19092
19093
19094 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19095 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19096 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19097 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19098 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19099 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19100
19101 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19102 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19103 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19104 .code
19105 data = #Exim filter\n\
19106 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19107 .endd
19108 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19109 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19110 choice into a newline.
19111
19112
19113 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19114 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19115 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19116 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19117 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19118
19119
19120 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19121 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19122 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19123 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19124 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19125 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19126 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19127 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19128
19129 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19130 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19131 runs a check on the containing directory,
19132 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19133 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19134 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19135 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19136 not, the router declines.
19137
19138
19139 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19140 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19141 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19142 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19143 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19144 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19145 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19146
19147
19148 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19149 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19150 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19151 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19152 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19153
19154
19155 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19156 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19157 redirection list.
19158
19159
19160 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19161 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19162 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19163
19164
19165
19166
19167 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19168 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19169 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19170 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19171 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19172 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19173 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19174 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19175 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19176
19177
19178 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19179 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19180 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19181 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19182 functions.
19183
19184 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19185 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19186 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19187 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19188
19189 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19190 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19191 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19192 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19193 &_.forward_& files).
19194
19195
19196 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19197 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19198 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19199
19200
19201 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19202 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19203 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19204 of the embedded Perl support.
19205
19206
19207 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19208 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19209 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19210
19211
19212 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19213 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19214 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19215
19216
19217 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19218 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19219 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19220 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19221 &%one_time%& is set.
19222
19223
19224 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19225 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19226 to make use of &%run%& items.
19227
19228
19229 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19230 If this option is true, items of the form
19231 .code
19232 :include:<path name>
19233 .endd
19234 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19235
19236
19237 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19238 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19239 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19240 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19241 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19242
19243
19244 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19245 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19246 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19247
19248
19249 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19250 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19251 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19252 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19253 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19254
19255
19256
19257
19258 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19259 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19260 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19261 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19262 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19263 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19264 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19265
19266
19267 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19268 .cindex "EACCES"
19269 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19270 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19271 file did not exist.
19272
19273
19274 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19275 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19276 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19277 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19278 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19279
19280 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19281 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19282 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19283 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19284 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19285 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19286 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19287 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19288
19289
19290
19291 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19292 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19293 redirection list must start with this directory.
19294
19295
19296 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19297 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19298 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19299
19300
19301 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19302 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19303 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19304 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19305 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19306 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19307 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19308 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19309 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19310 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19311 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19312 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19313 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19314 before they subscribed.
19315
19316 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19317 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19318 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19319 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19320 attempt.
19321
19322 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19323 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19324 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19325 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19326
19327 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19328 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19329 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19330
19331 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19332 &%one_time%&.
19333
19334 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19335 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19336 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19337 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19338 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19339 expansion.
19340
19341
19342 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19343 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19344 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19345 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19346 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19347 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19348 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19349 See &%check_owner%& above.
19350
19351
19352 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19353 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19354 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19355 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19356
19357
19358 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19359 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19360 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19361 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19362 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19363 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19364 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19365
19366
19367 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19368 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19369 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19370 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19371 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19372 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19373 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19374 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19375
19376 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19377 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19378 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19379 addresses.
19380
19381 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19382 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19383 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19384 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19385 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19386 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19387 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19388 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19389 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19390 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19391
19392
19393 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19394 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19395 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19396 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19397 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19398 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19399
19400
19401 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19402 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19403 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19404 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19405 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19406 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19407
19408
19409 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19410 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19411 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19412 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19413 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19414
19415
19416 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19417 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19418 :subaddress part of an address.
19419
19420 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19421 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19422 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19423 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19424
19425
19426 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19427 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19428 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19429 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19430 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19431 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19432 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19433
19434
19435
19436 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19437 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19438 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19439 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19440 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19441 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19442 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19443 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19444 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19445 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19446 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19447 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19448 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19449 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19450 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19451 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19452
19453 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19454 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19455 the following routers.
19456
19457 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19458 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19459 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19460 so it is passed to the following routers.
19461
19462 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19463 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19464 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19465 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19466
19467 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19468 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19469 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19470 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19471 .code
19472 userforward:
19473 driver = redirect
19474 allow_filter
19475 check_local_user
19476 file = $home/.forward
19477 file_transport = address_file
19478 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19479 reply_transport = address_reply
19480 no_verify
19481 skip_syntax_errors
19482 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19483 syntax_errors_text = \
19484 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19485 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19486 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19487 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19488 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19489 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19490 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19491 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19492 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19493 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19494 .endd
19495 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19496 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19497 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19498 .code
19499 real_localuser:
19500 driver = accept
19501 check_local_user
19502 local_part_prefix = real-
19503 transport = local_delivery
19504 .endd
19505 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19506 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19507 .code
19508 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19509 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19510 .endd
19511
19512
19513 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19514 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19515
19516
19517 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19518 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19519 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19520 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19521
19522
19523
19524
19525
19526
19527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19529
19530 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19531 "Environment for local transports"
19532 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19533 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19534 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19535 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19536 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19537 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19538 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19539
19540 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19541 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19542 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19543 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19544
19545 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19546 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19547 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19548 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19549 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19550
19551
19552
19553 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19554 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19555 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19556 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19557 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19558 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19559 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19560 time.
19561
19562 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19563 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19564 .code
19565 my_transport:
19566 driver = pipe
19567 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19568 .endd
19569 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19570 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19571 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19572 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19573
19574
19575
19576
19577 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19578 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19579 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19580 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19581 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19582 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19583 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19584 group (set by the transport). For example:
19585 .code
19586 # Routers ...
19587 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19588 local_users:
19589 driver = accept
19590 check_local_user
19591 transport = group_delivery
19592
19593 # Transports ...
19594 # This transport overrides the group
19595 group_delivery:
19596 driver = appendfile
19597 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19598 group = mail
19599 .endd
19600 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19601 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19602 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19603 set.
19604
19605 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19606 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19607 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19608 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19609 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19610 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19611
19612 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19613 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19614 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19615 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19616 original gid is also used.
19617
19618 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19619 following that is set is used:
19620
19621 .ilist
19622 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19623 .next
19624 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19625 .next
19626 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19627 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19628 .next
19629 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19630 .next
19631 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19632 the uid is the creator's uid;
19633 .next
19634 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19635 .endlist
19636
19637 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19638 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19639 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19640 The first of the following that is set is used:
19641
19642 .ilist
19643 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19644 .next
19645 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19646 .next
19647 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19648 .next
19649 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19650 .next
19651 The Exim uid.
19652 .endlist
19653
19654 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19655 &%never_users%& list.
19656
19657
19658
19659
19660
19661 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19662 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19663 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19664 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19665 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19666 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19667 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19668 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19669 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19670 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19671
19672 .ilist
19673 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19674 .next
19675 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19676 .next
19677 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19678 .next
19679 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19680 .endlist
19681
19682 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19683
19684 .ilist
19685 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19686 .next
19687 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19688 .endlist
19689
19690
19691 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19692 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19693 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19694
19695
19696
19697 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19698 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19699 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19700 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19701 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19702 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19703 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19704 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19705 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19706 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19707 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19708 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19709 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19710 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19711
19712
19713
19714
19715
19716
19717
19718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19720
19721 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19722 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19723 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19724 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19725 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19726
19727
19728 .option body_only transports boolean false
19729 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19730 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19731 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19732 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19733 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19734 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19735 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19736 automatically suppress them.
19737
19738
19739 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19740 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19741 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19742 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19743 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19744 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19745
19746
19747 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
19748 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19749 deliveries by the transport or for any
19750 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19751 what you are doing.
19752
19753
19754 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19755 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19756 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19757 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19758 transport is run.
19759 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19760 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19761 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19762 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19763 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19764 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19765 one.
19766 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
19767 transport and the router that called it.
19768
19769 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19770 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19771 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19772 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19773 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19774 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19775 safely be resent to other recipients.
19776
19777
19778 .option driver transports string unset
19779 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19780 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19781
19782
19783 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19784 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19785 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19786 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19787 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19788 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19789 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19790 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19791 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19792 resent to other recipients.
19793
19794
19795 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19796 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19797 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19798 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19799 &%user%& (see below).
19800
19801
19802 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
19803 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19804 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19805 This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
19806 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
19807 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19808 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19809 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19810 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19811 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19812
19813 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19814 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
19815
19816
19817 .option headers_only transports boolean false
19818 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19819 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19820 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19821 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19822 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19823 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19824 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19825
19826
19827 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
19828 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19829 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19830 This option specifies a list of header names, colon-separated;
19831 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19832 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19833 routers.
19834 Each list item is separately expanded.
19835 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19836 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19837 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19838
19839 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19840 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19841
19842
19843
19844 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19845 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19846 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19847 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19848 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19849 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19850 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19851 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19852 example,
19853 .code
19854 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19855 x@y w@z
19856 .endd
19857 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19858 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19859 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19860 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19861 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19862 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19863 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19864 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19865 change envelope recipients at this time.
19866
19867
19868 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19869 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19870 .vindex "&$home$&"
19871 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19872 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19873 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19874 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19875 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19876 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19877 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19878 deferred.
19879
19880
19881 .option initgroups transports boolean false
19882 .cindex "additional groups"
19883 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19884 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19885 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19886 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19887 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19888
19889
19890 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19891 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19892 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19893 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19894 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19895 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19896 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19897 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19898 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19899 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19900 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19901 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19902 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19903 delivered.
19904
19905
19906
19907 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19908 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19909 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19910 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
19911 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
19912 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19913 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19914 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19915 that contains
19916 .code
19917 local_part_prefix = *-
19918 .endd
19919 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19920 is delivered with
19921 .code
19922 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19923 .endd
19924 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19925 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19926 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19927 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19928 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19929
19930
19931 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19932 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19933 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19934 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19935 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19936 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19937 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19938 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19939 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19940
19941 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19942 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19943 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19944 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19945
19946 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19947 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19948 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19949
19950
19951 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19952 .cindex "envelope sender"
19953 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19954 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19955 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19956 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19957 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19958 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19959 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19960 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19961 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19962
19963 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19964 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19965
19966 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19967 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19968 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19969 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19970 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19971 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19972 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19973
19974 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19975 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19976 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19977 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19978 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19979
19980
19981
19982 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19983 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19984 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19985 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19986 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19987 have easy access to it.
19988
19989 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19990 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19991 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19992 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19993 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19994 recipients.
19995
19996
19997 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19998 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19999
20000
20001 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20002 .cindex "shadow transport"
20003 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20004 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20005 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20006
20007 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20008 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20009 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20010 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20011 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20012 cause a log line to be written.
20013
20014 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20015 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20016 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20017 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20018 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20019 of the form
20020 .code
20021 ST=<shadow transport name>
20022 .endd
20023 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20024 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20025 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20026 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20027 headers that some sites insist on.
20028
20029
20030 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20031 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20032 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20033 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20034 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20035 individual users or via a system filter.
20036
20037 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20038 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20039 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20040 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20041 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20042
20043 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20044 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20045 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20046 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20047 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20048 &(pipe)& transports.
20049
20050 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20051 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20052 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20053 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20054 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20055
20056 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20057 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20058 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20059 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20060
20061 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20062 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20063 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20064 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20065 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20066 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20067
20068 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20069 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20070 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20071 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20072 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20073 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20074 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20075 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20076
20077 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20078 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20079 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20080 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20081 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20082 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20083 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20084 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20085 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20086 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20087
20088 .vindex "&$host$&"
20089 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20090 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20091 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20092 which the message is being sent. For example:
20093 .code
20094 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20095 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20096 .endd
20097
20098 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20099 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20100 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20101 .ilist
20102 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20103 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20104 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20105 example:
20106 .code
20107 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20108 .endd
20109 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20110 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20111 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20112 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20113 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20114 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20115 .next
20116 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20117 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20118 arguments. Consider this example:
20119 .code
20120 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20121 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20122 .endd
20123 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20124 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20125 .code
20126 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20127 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20128 .endd
20129 .endlist
20130
20131 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20132 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20133 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20134 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20135 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20136 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20137 bounced from a transport filter.
20138
20139 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20140 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20141 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20142
20143
20144 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20145 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20146 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20147 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20148 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20149 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20150 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20151 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20152 becomes a temporary error.
20153
20154
20155 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20156 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20157 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20158 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20159 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20160 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20161 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20162 option is not set.
20163
20164 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20165 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20166 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20167
20168 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20169 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20170 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20171 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20172 retry data.
20173 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20174 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20175 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20176
20177
20178
20179
20180
20181
20182 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20183 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20184
20185 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20186 "Address batching"
20187 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20188 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20189 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20190 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20191 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20192 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20193 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20194
20195 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20196 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20197 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20198 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20199 local transport, for example:
20200
20201 .ilist
20202 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20203 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20204 recipients saves space.
20205 .next
20206 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20207 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20208 .next
20209 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20210 to a scanner program or
20211 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20212 acceptable.
20213 .endlist
20214
20215 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20216 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20217 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20218
20219 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20220 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20221 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20222 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20223 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20224 to certain conditions:
20225
20226 .ilist
20227 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20228 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20229 batching is possible.
20230 .next
20231 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20232 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20233 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20234 .next
20235 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20236 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20237 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20238 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20239 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20240 from taking place.
20241 .next
20242 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20243 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20244 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20245 be the same.
20246 .endlist
20247
20248 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20249 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20250 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20251 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20252 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20253 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20254 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20255 .code
20256 check_string = "."
20257 escape_string = ".."
20258 .endd
20259 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20260 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20261 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20262
20263 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20264 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20265 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20266 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20267 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20268 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20269
20270 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20271 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20272 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20273 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20274 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20275 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20276 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20277 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20278 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20279
20280
20281
20282
20283 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20284 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20285
20286 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20287 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20288 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20289 .cindex "directory creation"
20290 .cindex "creating directories"
20291 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20292 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20293 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20294 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20295 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20296 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20297 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20298 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20299 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20300 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20301
20302 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20303 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20304 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20305 included.
20306
20307 .cindex "quota" "system"
20308 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20309 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20310 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20311
20312 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20313 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20314 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20315 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20316
20317 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20318 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20319 private options.
20320
20321 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20322 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20323 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20324 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20325 option).
20326
20327
20328
20329 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20330 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20331 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20332 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20333 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20334
20335 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20336 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20337 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20338 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20339 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20340 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20341 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20342 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20343 operation. There are two cases:
20344
20345 .ilist
20346 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20347 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20348 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20349 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20350 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20351 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20352 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20353 .next
20354 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20355 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20356 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20357 .endlist
20358
20359
20360 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20361 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20362 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20363 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20364 form:
20365 .code
20366 save folder23
20367 .endd
20368 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20369 .code
20370 require "fileinto";
20371 fileinto "folder23";
20372 .endd
20373 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20374 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20375 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20376 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20377 way of handling this requirement:
20378 .code
20379 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20380 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20381 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20382 {$address_file} \
20383 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20384 }} \
20385 }
20386 .endd
20387 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20388 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20389 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20390
20391 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20392 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20393 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20394 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20395 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20396 path to the transport.
20397
20398 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20399 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20400
20401
20402
20403
20404 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20405 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20406
20407
20408
20409 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20410 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20411 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20412 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20413 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20414 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20415 delivery is deferred.
20416
20417
20418 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20419 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20420 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20421 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20422 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20423 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20424 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20425 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20426
20427
20428 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20429 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20430 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20431 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20432 file.
20433
20434
20435 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20436 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20437
20438
20439 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20440 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20441 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20442 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20443 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20444
20445
20446 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20447 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20448 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20449 process is running.
20450
20451
20452 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20453 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20454 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20455 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20456 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20457 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20458 contains is significant.
20459
20460 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20461 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20462 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20463 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20464 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20465
20466 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20467 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20468 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20469 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20470 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20471 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20472 .code
20473 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20474 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20475 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20476 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20477 .endd
20478 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20479 .cindex "directory creation"
20480 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20481 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20482 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20483
20484 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20485 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20486 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20487 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20488 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20489
20490
20491
20492 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20493 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20494 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20495 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20496 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20497 beneath.
20498
20499 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20500 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20501 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20502 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20503 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20504 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20505 &%file_must_exist%&.
20506
20507
20508 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20509 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20510 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20511 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20512
20513 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20514 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20515 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20516 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20517 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20518
20519
20520 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20521 .cindex "base62"
20522 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20523 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20524 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20525 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20526 .code
20527 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20528 .endd
20529 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20530 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20531 option.
20532
20533
20534 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20535 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20536 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20537
20538
20539 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20540 See &%check_string%& above.
20541
20542
20543 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20544 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20545 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20546 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20547 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20548 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20549 &%file%&.
20550
20551 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20552 .cindex "locking files"
20553 .cindex "lock files"
20554 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20555 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20556
20557 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20558 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20559 examples:
20560 .code
20561 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20562 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20563 file = $home/inbox
20564 .endd
20565 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20566 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20567 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20568 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20569 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20570 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20571
20572
20573
20574 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20575 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20576 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20577 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20578 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20579 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20580 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20581 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20582 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20583 this added to it:
20584 .code
20585 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20586 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20587 .endd
20588 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20589 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20590 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20591 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20592 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20593 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20594 delivery is deferred.
20595
20596
20597 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20598 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20599 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20600 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20601
20602
20603 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20604 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20605 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20606 .cindex "locking files"
20607 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20608 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20609 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20610 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20611 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20612 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20613 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20614 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20615
20616 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20617 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20618 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20619 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20620
20621 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20622 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20623 retries is
20624 .code
20625 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20626 .endd
20627 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20628 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20629 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20630
20631 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20632 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20633 .code
20634 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20635 .endd
20636
20637 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20638 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20639 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20640 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20641
20642
20643 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20644 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20645 for details of locking.
20646
20647
20648 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20649 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20650 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20651
20652
20653 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20654 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20655 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20656
20657
20658 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20659 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20660 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20661 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20662 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20663
20664
20665 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20666 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20667 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20668 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20669 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20670 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20671 external source that maintains the data.
20672
20673
20674 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20675 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20676 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20677 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20678 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20679 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20680 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20681 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20682
20683
20684
20685 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20686 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20687 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20688 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20689 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20690 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20691 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20692 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20693 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20694 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20695
20696
20697 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20698 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20699 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20700 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20701 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20702 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20703 calculation. The default value is:
20704 .code
20705 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20706 .endd
20707 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20708 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20709 &_Trash_&
20710 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20711 .code
20712 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20713 .endd
20714 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20715 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20716 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20717 directly into that directory.
20718
20719
20720 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20721 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20722 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20723
20724
20725 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20726 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20727 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20728
20729
20730 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20731 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20732 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20733 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20734 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20735 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20736 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20737 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20738
20739 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20740 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20741 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20742 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20743 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20744 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20745 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20746 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20747 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20748 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20749
20750
20751 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20752 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20753 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20754 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20755 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20756 below for further details.
20757
20758
20759 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20760 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20761 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20762
20763
20764 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20765 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20766 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20767
20768
20769 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20770 .cindex "locking files"
20771 .cindex "file" "locking"
20772 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
20773 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20774 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20775 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20776 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20777 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20778 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20779
20780 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20781 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20782 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20783 combination:
20784 .code
20785 mbx_format = true
20786 message_prefix =
20787 message_suffix =
20788 .endd
20789 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20790 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20791 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20792 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20793 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20794 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20795 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20796 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20797
20798 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20799 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20800 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20801 append messages to it.
20802
20803
20804 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20805 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20806 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20807 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20808 in which case it is:
20809 .code
20810 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20811 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20812 .endd
20813 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20814 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20815
20816 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20817 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20818 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20819 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20820 setting
20821 .code
20822 message_suffix =
20823 .endd
20824 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20825 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20826
20827 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20828 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20829 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20830 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20831 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20832 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20833 value, and this option is ignored.
20834
20835
20836 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20837 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20838 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20839 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20840 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20841
20842
20843 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20844 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20845 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20846 on users about incoming mail.
20847
20848
20849 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20850 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20851 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20852 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20853 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20854 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20855 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20856 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20857 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20858
20859 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20860 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20861 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20862
20863 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20864 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20865 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20866 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20867 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20868 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20869
20870 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20871 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20872 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20873 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20874 be handled.
20875
20876 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20877
20878 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20879 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20880 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20881 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20882 system quota failures.
20883
20884 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20885 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20886 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20887 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20888 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20889 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20890 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20891 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20892 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20893 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20894
20895
20896 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20897 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20898 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20899 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20900 delivery directory.
20901
20902
20903 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20904 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20905 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20906 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20907 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20908 &"no quota"&.
20909
20910
20911 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20912 See &%quota%& above.
20913
20914
20915 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20916 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20917 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20918 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20919 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20920 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20921 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20922
20923 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20924 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20925 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20926 the file length to the file name. For example:
20927 .code
20928 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20929 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20930 .endd
20931 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20932 number of lines in the message.
20933
20934 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20935 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20936 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20937
20938 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20939
20940
20941 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20942 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20943 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20944 .code
20945 quota_warn_message = "\
20946 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20947 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20948 This message is automatically created \
20949 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20950 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20951 a warning threshold that is\n\
20952 set by the system administrator.\n"
20953 .endd
20954
20955
20956 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20957 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20958 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20959 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20960 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20961 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20962 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20963 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20964 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20965 sign. For example:
20966 .code
20967 quota = 10M
20968 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20969 .endd
20970 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20971 percent sign is ignored.
20972
20973 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20974 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20975 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20976 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20977 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20978 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20979 .code
20980 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20981 .endd
20982 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20983 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20984 option.
20985
20986 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20987 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20988 percentage.
20989
20990
20991 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20992 .cindex "envelope sender"
20993 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20994 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20995 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20996 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20997 for details of batch SMTP.
20998
20999
21000 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21001 .cindex "carriage return"
21002 .cindex "linefeed"
21003 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21004 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21005 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21006 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21007
21008 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21009 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21010 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21011 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21012 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21013 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21014
21015
21016 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21017 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21018 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21019 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21020 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21021 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21022
21023
21024 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21025 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21026 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21027 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21028 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21029
21030 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21031 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21032 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21033 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21034
21035 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21036 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21037 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21038 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21039 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21040 error.
21041
21042 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21043 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21044
21045
21046 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21047 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21048 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21049 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21050 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21051 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21052 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21053
21054 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21055 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21056 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21057 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21058 file corruption.
21059
21060 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21061 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21062 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21063
21064
21065 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21066 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21067 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21068 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21069 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21070 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21071 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21072 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21073 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21074
21075 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21076 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21077 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21078 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21079
21080
21081
21082
21083 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21084 .cindex "appending to a file"
21085 .cindex "file" "appending"
21086 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21087
21088 .ilist
21089 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21090 return is given.
21091
21092 .next
21093 .cindex "directory creation"
21094 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21095 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21096 &%directory_mode%& option.
21097
21098 .next
21099 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21100 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21101 transport.
21102
21103 .next
21104 .cindex "file" "locking"
21105 .cindex "locking files"
21106 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21107 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21108 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21109
21110 .olist
21111 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21112 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21113 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21114 .next
21115 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21116 .next
21117 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21118 Unlink the hitching post name.
21119 .next
21120 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21121 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21122 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21123 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21124 .next
21125 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21126 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21127 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21128 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21129 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21130 it before trying again.
21131 .endlist olist
21132
21133 .next
21134 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21135 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21136 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21137
21138 .next
21139 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21140 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21141 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21142 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21143 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21144 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21145 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21146 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21147 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21148 checked.
21149
21150 .next
21151 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21152 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21153 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21154 delivery is deferred.
21155
21156 .next
21157 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21158 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21159 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21160 permissions.
21161
21162 .next
21163 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21164 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21165 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21166
21167 .next
21168 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21169 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21170 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21171
21172 .next
21173 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21174 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21175 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21176 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21177 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21178 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21179 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21180 that prevents link following.
21181
21182 .next
21183 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21184 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21185 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21186 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21187 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21188
21189 .next
21190 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21191
21192 .next
21193 .cindex "file" "locking"
21194 .cindex "locking files"
21195 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21196 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21197 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21198 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21199 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21200 .code
21201 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21202 .endd
21203 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21204 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21205 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21206
21207 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21208 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21209 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21210
21211 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21212 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21213 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21214 delivery is deferred.
21215
21216 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21217 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21218 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21219 immediately. It retries up to
21220 .code
21221 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21222 .endd
21223 times (rounded up).
21224 .endlist
21225
21226 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21227 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21228
21229
21230 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21231 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21232 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21233 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21234 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21235 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21236 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21237 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21238 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21239 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21240
21241 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21242 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21243 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21244 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21245 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21246 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21247 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21248
21249 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21250 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21251 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21252 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21253
21254
21255 .cindex "maildir format"
21256 .cindex "mailstore format"
21257 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21258 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21259 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21260 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21261 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21262
21263 .cindex "directory creation"
21264 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21265 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21266 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21267 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21268 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21269 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21270 deferred.
21271
21272
21273
21274 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21275 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21276 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21277 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21278 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21279 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21280 &_new_& subdirectory.
21281
21282 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21283 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21284 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21285 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21286 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21287 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21288 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21289
21290 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21291 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21292 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21293 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21294 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21295 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21296 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21297 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21298
21299 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21300 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21301 folders. Consider this example:
21302 .code
21303 maildir_format = true
21304 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21305 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21306 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21307 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21308 .endd
21309 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21310 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21311 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21312 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21313 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21314 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21315
21316 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21317 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21318 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21319 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21320 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21321
21322 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21323 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21324 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21325
21326 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21327 .cindex "maildir++"
21328 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21329 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21330 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21331 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21332 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21333 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21334 amount of space used.
21335
21336 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21337 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21338 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21339 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21340 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21341 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21342
21343
21344
21345
21346 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21347 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21348 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21349 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21350 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21351 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21352
21353
21354 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21355 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21356 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21357 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21358 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21359 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21360 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21361 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21362 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21363 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21364 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21365 backwards compatibility).
21366
21367 For one common implementation, you might set:
21368 .code
21369 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21370 .endd
21371 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21372
21373 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21374 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21375 &[stat()]& each message file.
21376
21377
21378 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21379 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21380 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21381 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21382 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21383 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21384 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21385 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21386 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21387
21388 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21389 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21390 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21391 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21392 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21393 need to know the quota.
21394
21395 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21396 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21397
21398 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21399 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21400 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21401 details.
21402
21403
21404 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21405 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21406 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21407 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21408 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21409 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21410 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21411 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21412
21413 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21414 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21415 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21416 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21417 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21418 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21419
21420 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21421 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21422 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21423 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21424 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21425 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21426
21427 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21428 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21429 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21430 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21431
21432
21433 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21434 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21435 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21436 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21437 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21438 .code
21439 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21440 .endd
21441 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21442 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21443 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21444 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21445 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21446
21447
21448
21449
21450
21451
21452 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21453 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21454
21455 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21456 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21457 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21458 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21459 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21460 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21461 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21462 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21463
21464 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21465 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21466 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21467 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21468 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21469
21470
21471 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21472 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21473 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21474 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21475 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21476
21477 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21478 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21479 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21480 transport is run as a consequence of a
21481 &%mail%&
21482 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21483 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21484 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21485 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21486 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21487 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21488
21489 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21490 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21491 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21492 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21493
21494 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21495 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21496 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21497 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21498 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21499 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21500 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21501
21502 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21503 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21504 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21505 the transport defers.
21506 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21507 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21508
21509 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21510 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21511 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21512 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21513
21514 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21515 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21516 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21517 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21518 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21519 problems. They are just discarded.
21520
21521
21522
21523 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21524 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21525
21526 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21527 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21528 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21529
21530
21531 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21532 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21533 when the message is specified by the transport.
21534
21535
21536 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21537 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21538 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21539 string comes first.
21540
21541
21542 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21543 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21544 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21545
21546
21547 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21548 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21549 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21550
21551
21552 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21553 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21554 specified by the transport.
21555
21556
21557 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21558 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21559 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21560 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21561
21562
21563 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21564 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21565 the message is specified by the transport.
21566
21567
21568 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21569 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21570 used.
21571
21572
21573 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21574 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21575 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21576 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21577 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21578
21579
21580
21581 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21582 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21583 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21584 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21585
21586 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21587 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21588 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21589 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21590 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21591 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21592 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21593 infinity.
21594
21595 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21596 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21597 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21598 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21599 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21600
21601 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21602 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21603 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21604 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21605 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21606 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21607
21608
21609 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21610 See &%once%& above.
21611
21612
21613 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21614 See &%once%& above.
21615 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21616
21617
21618 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21619 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21620 specified by the transport.
21621
21622
21623 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21624 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21625 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21626 configuration option.
21627
21628
21629 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21630 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21631 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21632 automatic responses. For example:
21633 .code
21634 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21635 .endd
21636 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21637 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21638 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21639 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21640 small.
21641
21642
21643
21644 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21645 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21646 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21647 the text comes first.
21648
21649
21650 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
21651 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21652 when the message is specified by the transport.
21653 .ecindex IIDauttra1
21654 .ecindex IIDauttra2
21655
21656
21657
21658
21659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21660 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21661
21662 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21663 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21664 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21665 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21666 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21667 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21668 specified command
21669 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21670 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21671 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21672 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21673 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21674 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21675 .code
21676 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
21677 .endd
21678 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21679 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21680 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21681 as follows:
21682
21683 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21684 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21685
21686
21687 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21688 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21689 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21690 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21691 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21692
21693
21694 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21695 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21696 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21697 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21698 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21699 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21700 LMTP protocol.
21701
21702 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21703 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21704 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21705 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21706 in its response to the LHLO command.
21707
21708 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21709 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21710 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21711 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21712
21713
21714 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21715 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21716 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21717 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21718 LMTP transport:
21719 .code
21720 lmtp:
21721 driver = lmtp
21722 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21723 batch_max = 20
21724 user = exim
21725 .endd
21726 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21727 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21728
21729
21730
21731 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21733
21734 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21735 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21736 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21737 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21738 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21739 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21740 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21741 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21742 following ways:
21743
21744 .ilist
21745 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21746 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21747 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21748 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21749 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21750 .next
21751 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21752 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21753 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21754 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21755 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21756 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21757 that are routed to the transport.
21758 .next
21759 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21760 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21761 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21762 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
21763 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
21764 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
21765 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
21766 .endlist
21767
21768
21769 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21770 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21771 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21772
21773 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21774 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21775 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21776 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21777 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21778 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21779 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21780
21781
21782 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21783 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21784 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21785 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21786 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21787
21788
21789
21790
21791 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21792 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21793 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21794 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21795 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21796 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21797 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21798 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21799 &"local delivery failed"&.
21800
21801 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21802 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21803 will be sent as normal.
21804
21805 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21806 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21807 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21808 apply in this case.
21809
21810 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21811 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21812 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21813 a non-existent command may be the problem.
21814
21815 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21816 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21817 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21818 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21819 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21820 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21821 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21822 &%temp_errors%&.
21823
21824
21825
21826 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21827 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21828 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21829 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21830 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21831 run.
21832
21833 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21834 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21835 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21836 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21837
21838 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21839 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21840 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21841 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21842 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21843 .code
21844 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21845 .endd
21846 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21847 arguments. You have to write
21848 .code
21849 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21850 .endd
21851 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21852 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21853 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21854 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21855 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21856 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21857 example:
21858 .code
21859 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21860 .endd
21861
21862 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21863 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21864 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21865 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21866 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21867 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21868 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21869 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21870 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21871 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21872
21873 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
21874 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
21875 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
21876 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
21877 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
21878 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
21879 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
21880 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
21881
21882 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21883 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21884 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21885 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21886 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21887 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21888 control what is done with it.
21889
21890 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21891 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21892 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21893 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21894 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21895 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21896 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21897 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21898 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21899 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21900 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21901
21902
21903
21904 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21905 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21906 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21907 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21908 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21909 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21910 environment.
21911 .display
21912 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21913 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21914 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21915 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21916 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21917 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21918 &`LOGNAME `& see below
21919 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21920 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21921 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21922 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21923 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21924 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21925 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21926 &`USER `& see below
21927 .endd
21928 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21929 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21930 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21931 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21932 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21933 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21934 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21935
21936 .cindex "HOST"
21937 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21938 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21939 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21940 the router.
21941
21942 .cindex "HOME"
21943 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21944 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21945 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21946 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21947
21948
21949 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21950 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21951
21952
21953
21954 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21955 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21956 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21957 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21958 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21959 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21960 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21961 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21962 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21963 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21964 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21965 example, if
21966 .code
21967 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21968 .endd
21969 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21970 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21971 &%use_shell%& is set.
21972
21973
21974 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21975 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21976
21977
21978 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21979 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21980 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21981
21982
21983 .option check_string pipe string unset
21984 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21985 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21986 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21987 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21988 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21989 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21990 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21991 ignored.
21992
21993
21994 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21995 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21996 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21997 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21998 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21999 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22000 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22001
22002
22003 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22004 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22005 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22006 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22007 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22008 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22009 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22010
22011
22012 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22013 See &%check_string%& above.
22014
22015
22016 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22017 .cindex "exec failure"
22018 .cindex "failure of exec"
22019 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22020 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22021 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22022 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22023 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22024
22025
22026 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22027 .cindex "signal exit"
22028 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22029 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22030 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22031 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22032
22033
22034 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22035 .cindex "force command"
22036 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22037 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22038 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22039 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22040 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22041 command. For example:
22042 .code
22043 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22044 force_command
22045 .endd
22046
22047 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22048 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22049 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22050
22051 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22052 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22053 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22054 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22055 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22056 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22057
22058 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22059 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22060
22061 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22062 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22063 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22064 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22065 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22066
22067
22068 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22069 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22070 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22071 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22072 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22073 Only one of them may be set.
22074
22075
22076
22077 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22078 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22079 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22080 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22081
22082
22083
22084 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22085 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22086 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22087 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22088 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22089 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22090 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22091 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22092
22093
22094 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22095 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22096 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22097 .code
22098 message_prefix = \
22099 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22100 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22101 .endd
22102 .cindex "Cyrus"
22103 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22104 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22105 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22106 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22107 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22108 setting
22109 .code
22110 message_prefix =
22111 .endd
22112 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22113 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22114
22115
22116 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22117 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22118 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22119 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22120 .code
22121 message_suffix =
22122 .endd
22123 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22124 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22125
22126
22127 .option path pipe string "see below"
22128 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22129 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22130 .code
22131 /bin:/usr/bin
22132 .endd
22133 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22134 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22135 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22136
22137
22138 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22139 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22140 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22141 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22142 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22143 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22144 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22145 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22146 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22147
22148
22149 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22150 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22151 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22152 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22153 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22154 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22155 accept the message is used.
22156
22157
22158 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22159 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22160 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22161 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22162 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22163 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22164
22165
22166 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22167 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22168 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22169 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22170 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22171 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22172 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22173
22174
22175
22176 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22177 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22178 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22179 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22180 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22181 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22182 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22183 of them may be set.
22184
22185
22186
22187 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22188 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22189 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22190 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22191 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22192 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22193 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22194 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22195 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22196 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22197 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22198 and 73, respectively.
22199
22200
22201 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22202 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22203 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22204 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22205 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22206 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22207 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22208
22209 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22210 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22211 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22212 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22213 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22214 delivery to be deferred.
22215
22216 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22217 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22218
22219
22220 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22221 .cindex "envelope sender"
22222 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22223 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22224 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22225 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22226 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22227
22228 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22229 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22230 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22231 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22232 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22233 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22234 class database.
22235
22236
22237 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22238 .cindex "carriage return"
22239 .cindex "linefeed"
22240 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22241 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22242 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22243 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22244
22245 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22246 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22247 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22248 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22249 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22250
22251
22252 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22253 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22254 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22255 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22256 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22257 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22258 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22259 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22260 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22261 its &%-c%& option.
22262
22263
22264
22265 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22266 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22267 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22268 .cindex "external local delivery"
22269 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22270 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22271 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22272 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22273 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22274 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22275 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22276 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22277 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22278 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22279 .code
22280 # transport
22281 procmail_pipe:
22282 driver = pipe
22283 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22284 return_path_add
22285 delivery_date_add
22286 envelope_to_add
22287 check_string = "From "
22288 escape_string = ">From "
22289 umask = 077
22290 user = $local_part
22291 group = mail
22292
22293 # router
22294 procmail:
22295 driver = accept
22296 check_local_user
22297 transport = procmail_pipe
22298 .endd
22299 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22300 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22301 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22302 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22303 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22304 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22305
22306 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22307 .code
22308 IFS=" "
22309 .endd
22310 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22311 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22312
22313 .cindex "Cyrus"
22314 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22315 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22316 .code
22317 # transport
22318 local_delivery_cyrus:
22319 driver = pipe
22320 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22321 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22322 user = cyrus
22323 group = mail
22324 return_output
22325 log_output
22326 message_prefix =
22327 message_suffix =
22328
22329 # router
22330 local_user_cyrus:
22331 driver = accept
22332 check_local_user
22333 local_part_suffix = .*
22334 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22335 .endd
22336 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22337 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22338 sender.
22339 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22340 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22341
22342
22343 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22344 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22345
22346 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22347 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22348 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22349 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22350 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22351 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22352 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22353 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22354
22355
22356 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22357 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22358 two ways:
22359
22360 .ilist
22361 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22362 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22363 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22364 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22365 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22366 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22367 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22368 .next
22369 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22370 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22371 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22372 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22373 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22374 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22375 process.
22376 .endlist
22377
22378
22379 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22380 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22381 no further messages are sent over that connection.
22382
22383
22384
22385 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22386 .vindex "&$host$&"
22387 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22388 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22389 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22390 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22391 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22392 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22393 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22394 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22395
22396
22397 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22398 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22399 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22400 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22401 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
22402 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22403 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22404 are the values that were set when the message was received.
22405 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22406 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22407 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22408 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22409 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22410 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22411
22412 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22413 and will be removed in a future release.
22414
22415
22416 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22417 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22418 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22419
22420
22421 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22422 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22423 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22424 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22425 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22426 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22427 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22428 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22429
22430 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22431 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22432 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22433 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22434 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22435 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22436 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22437 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22438 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22439
22440
22441 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22442 .cindex "Cyrus"
22443 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22444 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22445 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22446 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22447 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22448 ignored.
22449
22450 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22451 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22452 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22453 particular connection.
22454
22455 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22456 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22457 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22458 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22459
22460 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22461 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22462 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22463 .code
22464 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22465 .endd
22466 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22467 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22468
22469 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22470 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22471 value.
22472
22473
22474 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22475 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22476 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22477 authenticated as a client.
22478
22479
22480 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22481 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22482 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22483 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22484
22485
22486 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22487 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22488 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22489 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22490 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22491 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22492 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22493
22494
22495 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22496 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22497 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22498 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22499 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22500 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22501 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22502 option.
22503
22504
22505 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22506 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22507 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22508 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22509
22510
22511 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22512 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22513 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22514 cutoff times.
22515
22516 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22517 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22518 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22519 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22520 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22521 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22522
22523 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22524 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22525 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22526 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22527 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22528 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22529 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22530 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22531 to them.
22532
22533
22534 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22535 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22536 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22537 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22538 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22539
22540
22541 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22542 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22543 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22544 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22545 details.
22546
22547
22548 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22549 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22550 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22551 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22552 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22553 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22554 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22555
22556 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22557 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22558 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22559 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22560 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22561
22562
22563 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22564 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22565 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22566 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22567 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22568 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22569 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22570 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22571
22572 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22573 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22574 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22575 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22576 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22577 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22578
22579 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22580 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22581 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22582 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22583 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22584
22585 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22586 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22587 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22588 copy of the message is sent.
22589
22590 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22591 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22592 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22593 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22594 fails"& facility.
22595
22596
22597 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22598 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22599 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22600 zero.
22601
22602 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22603 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22604 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22605 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22606 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22607 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22608
22609 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22610 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22611 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22612 implementations of TLS.
22613
22614 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22615 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22616 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22617 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22618 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22619 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22620 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22621 option is:
22622 .code
22623 $primary_hostname
22624 .endd
22625 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22626 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22627 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22628 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22629 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22630 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22631 interface address, you could use this:
22632 .code
22633 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22634 {$primary_hostname}}
22635 .endd
22636 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22637 callouts.
22638
22639 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22640 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22641 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22642 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22643 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22644 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22645
22646 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22647 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22648 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22649 &%hosts_override%& is set.
22650
22651 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22652 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22653 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22654 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22655 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22656 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22657 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22658
22659 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22660 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22661 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22662 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22663 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22664 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22665 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22666 address are used.
22667
22668 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22669 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22670
22671
22672 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22673 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22674 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22675 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22676 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22677 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22678 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22679 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22680 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22681 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22682
22683
22684 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22685 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22686 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22687 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22688
22689
22690 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22691 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22692 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22693 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22694
22695 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
22696 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22697 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
22698 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
22699 to any host that matches this list.
22700 Note that the default is to not use TLS.
22701
22702
22703 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22704 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22705 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22706 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22707 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22708 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22709 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22710 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22711
22712
22713 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22714 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22715 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22716 why it exists.
22717
22718
22719
22720 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22721 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22722 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22723 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22724 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22725 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22726 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22727 explanation of when this might be needed.
22728
22729
22730 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22731 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22732 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22733 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22734 &%fallback_hosts%&.
22735
22736
22737 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22738 .cindex "randomized host list"
22739 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22740 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22741 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22742 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22743 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22744 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22745 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22746 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22747
22748 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22749 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22750 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22751 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
22752 .code
22753 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22754 .endd
22755 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22756 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22757 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22758
22759 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22760 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22761 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22762 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22763 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22764 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22765 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22766 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22767 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22768
22769
22770 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22771 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22772 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22773 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22774 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22775 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22776
22777 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22778 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22779 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22780 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22781 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22782 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22783 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22784
22785 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22786 .cindex "bind IP address"
22787 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
22788 .vindex "&$host$&"
22789 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22790 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22791 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22792 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22793 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22794 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22795 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22796 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22797 unknown.
22798
22799 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22800 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22801 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22802 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22803 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22804 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22805 .code
22806 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22807 .endd
22808 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22809 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22810 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22811 interface to use if the host has more than one.
22812
22813
22814 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
22815 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22816 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22817 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22818 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22819 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22820 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22821 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22822 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22823 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22824 unreachable hosts.
22825
22826
22827 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22828 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22829 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22830 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22831 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22832
22833 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22834 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22835 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22836 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22837 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22838 permits this.
22839
22840
22841 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22842 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22843 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22844 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22845 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22846 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22847 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22848 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22849
22850
22851 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22852 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22853 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22854 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22855 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22856 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22857 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22858 variable that contains an outgoing port.
22859
22860 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22861 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22862 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22863 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22864 is deferred.
22865
22866
22867
22868 .option protocol smtp string smtp
22869 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22870 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22871 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22872 .vindex "&$port$&"
22873 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22874 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22875 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22876 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22877 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22878
22879 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22880 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22881 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22882 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22883
22884
22885 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22886 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22887 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22888 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22889 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22890 addresses is not affected.
22891
22892 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22893 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22894 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22895 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22896 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22897 hosts.
22898
22899
22900 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22901 .cindex "serializing connections"
22902 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22903 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22904 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22905 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22906 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22907 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22908 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22909
22910 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22911 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22912 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22913 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22914 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22915 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22916
22917 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22918 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22919 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22920 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22921 are used for ETRN serialization.
22922
22923
22924 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22925 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22926 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22927 .cindex "size" "of message"
22928 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22929 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22930 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22931 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22932 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22933 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22934 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22935 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22936
22937 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22938 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22939
22940
22941 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22942 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22943 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22944 .vindex "&$host$&"
22945 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22946 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22947 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22948 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22949 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22950 details of TLS.
22951
22952 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22953 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22954 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22955 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22956 client.
22957
22958
22959 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22960 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22961 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22962 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22963 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22964
22965
22966 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
22967 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
22968 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
22969 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
22970 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
22971 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
22972 will fail.
22973
22974 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
22975
22976
22977 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22978 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22979 .vindex "&$host$&"
22980 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22981 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22982 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22983 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22984 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22985 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22986 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22987 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22988
22989
22990 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22991 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22992 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22993 .vindex "&$host$&"
22994 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22995 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22996 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22997 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22998 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22999 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23000 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23001 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23002 ciphers is a preference order.
23003
23004
23005
23006 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23007 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23008 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23009 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23010 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23011 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23012 certificate and private key for the session.
23013
23014 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23015
23016 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23017 TLS extensions.
23018
23019
23020
23021
23022 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23023 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23024 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23025 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23026 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23027 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23028 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23029 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23030 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23031 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23032 in clear.
23033
23034
23035 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!! unset
23036 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23037 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23038 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23039 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23040 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23041
23042
23043 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
23044 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23045 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23046 .vindex "&$host$&"
23047 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23048 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
23049 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23050 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
23051 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
23052 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
23053 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
23054 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23055 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23056
23057 For back-compatability,
23058 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23059 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23060
23061
23062 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!! unset
23063 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23064 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23065 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23066 certificate verification must succeed.
23067 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23068 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23069 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23070
23071
23072
23073
23074 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23075 "SECTvalhosmax"
23076 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23077 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23078 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23079 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23080 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23081
23082
23083 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23084 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23085 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23086 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23087 retrying.
23088
23089 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23090 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23091 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23092
23093 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23094 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23095 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23096 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23097 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23098
23099 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23100 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23101 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23102 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23103 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23104 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23105 see below for an exception).
23106
23107 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23108 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23109 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23110 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23111 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23112
23113 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23114 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23115 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23116 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23117 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23118 reached their retry times.
23119
23120 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23121 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23122 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23123 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23124 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23125 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23126 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23127 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23128 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23129 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23130 reached.
23131
23132 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23133 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23134 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23135 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23136 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23137 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23138
23139 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23140 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23141 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23142 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23143 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23144 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23145
23146
23147
23148
23149
23150 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23151 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23152
23153 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23154 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23155 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23156 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23157 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23158 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23159
23160 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23161 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23162 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23163 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23164 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23165 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23166 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23167
23168 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23169 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23170 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23171 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23172
23173
23174 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23175 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23176 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23177 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23178
23179 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23180 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23181 facility; you do not have to use it.
23182
23183 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23184 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23185 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23186 address to which it applies.
23187
23188 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23189 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23190 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23191 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23192 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23193 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23194 rules.
23195
23196 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23197 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23198 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23199 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23200
23201
23202 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23203 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23204 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23205 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23206 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23207 discouraged.
23208
23209 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23210 illustrated by these examples:
23211
23212 .ilist
23213 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23214 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23215 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23216 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23217 .next
23218 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23219 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23220 .endlist
23221
23222
23223
23224 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23225 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23226 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23227 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23228 message's processing.
23229
23230 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23231 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23232 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23233 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23234 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23235 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23236 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23237 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23238 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23239
23240 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23241 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23242 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23243 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23244 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23245 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23246 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23247 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23248 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23249 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23250
23251 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23252 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23253 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23254 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23255 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23256 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23257
23258 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23259 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23260 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23261
23262 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23263 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23264 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23265 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23266 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23267 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23268 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23269 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23270 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23271
23272 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23273 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23274 transport time.
23275
23276
23277
23278
23279 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23280 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23281 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23282 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23283 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23284 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23285 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23286 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23287 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23288 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23289 .code
23290 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23291 .endd
23292 might produce the output
23293 .code
23294 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23295 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23296 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23297 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23298 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23299 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23300 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23301 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23302 .endd
23303 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23304 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23305 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23306 set for a particular transport.
23307
23308
23309 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23310 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23311 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
23312 rules in the form
23313 .display
23314 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
23315 .endd
23316 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
23317 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
23318 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
23319 any colons must be doubled, of course).
23320
23321 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
23322 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
23323 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
23324 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
23325 ignored.
23326
23327 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
23328 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
23329 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
23330
23331 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
23332 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
23333 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
23334 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
23335 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
23336 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
23337 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
23338
23339 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23340 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23341 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23342 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23343 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23344 .code
23345 *@* ${lookup ...
23346 .endd
23347 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23348 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23349
23350
23351 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23352 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23353 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23354 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23355 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23356 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23357 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23358 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23359 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23360
23361 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23362 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23363 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23364
23365 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23366 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23367 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23368 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23369 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23370 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23371 of pattern they are set as follows:
23372
23373 .ilist
23374 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23375 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23376 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23377 pattern
23378 .code
23379 *queen@*.fict.example
23380 .endd
23381 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23382 .code
23383 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23384 $1 = hearts-
23385 $2 = wonderland
23386 .endd
23387 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23388 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23389
23390 .next
23391 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23392 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23393 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23394 rewriting rule of the form
23395 .display
23396 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23397 .endd
23398 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23399 .code
23400 $1 = foo
23401 $2 = bar
23402 $3 = baz.example
23403 .endd
23404 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23405 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23406 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23407 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23408 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23409 .endlist
23410
23411
23412 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23413 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23414 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23415 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23416 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23417 .code
23418 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23419 .endd
23420 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23421 &'From:'& headers.
23422
23423 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23424 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23425 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23426 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23427 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23428 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23429 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23430 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23431 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23432 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23433 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23434 entry written to the panic log.
23435
23436
23437
23438 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23439 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23440
23441 .ilist
23442 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23443 c, f, h, r, s, t.
23444 .next
23445 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23446 .next
23447 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23448 .endlist
23449
23450 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23451 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23452
23453
23454
23455 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23456 "SECID154"
23457 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23458 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23459 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23460 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23461 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23462 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23463 .display
23464 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23465 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23466 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23467 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23468 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23469 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23470 &`h`& rewrite all headers
23471 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23472 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23473 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23474 .endd
23475 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23476 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23477 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23478
23479 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23480 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23481
23482
23483 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23484 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23485 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23486 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23487 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23488 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23489 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23490 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23491 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23492
23493 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23494 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23495 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23496 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23497 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23498 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23499 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23500 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23501
23502
23503 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23504 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23505 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23506 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23507
23508 .ilist
23509 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23510 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23511 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23512 .next
23513 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23514 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23515 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23516 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23517 .next
23518 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23519 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23520 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23521 .next
23522 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23523 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23524 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23525 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23526 .code
23527 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23528 .endd
23529 into
23530 .code
23531 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23532 .endd
23533 .cindex "RFC 2047"
23534 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23535 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23536 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23537 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
23538 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23539 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23540 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23541 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23542
23543 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23544 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23545 .endlist
23546
23547
23548 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23549 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23550 .code
23551 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23552 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23553 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23554 .endd
23555 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23556 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23557 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23558 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23559 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23560 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23561 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23562 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23563
23564 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23565 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23566 .code
23567 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23568 .endd
23569 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23570 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23571
23572 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23573 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23574 messages that originate outside the local host:
23575 .code
23576 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23577 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23578 .endd
23579 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23580 space.
23581
23582 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23583 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23584 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23585 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23586 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23587 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23588 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23589 components. For example, the rule
23590 .code
23591 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23592 .endd
23593 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23594 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23595 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23596 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23597 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23598 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23599 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23600 .ecindex IIDaddrew
23601
23602
23603
23604
23605
23606 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23608
23609 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23610 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23611 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23612 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23613 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23614 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23615 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23616 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23617 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23618 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23619 address, domain and error.
23620
23621 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23622 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23623 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23624 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23625 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23626 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23627 log selector is set, the message
23628 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23629 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23630 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23631 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23632
23633 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23634 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23635 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23636 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23637 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23638 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23639 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23640 domain are maintained independently.
23641
23642 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23643 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23644 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23645 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23646 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23647 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23648 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23649 the local address is reached.
23650
23651 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23652 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23653 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23654 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23655 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23656
23657 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23658 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23659 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23660 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23661 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23662 messages that it should now be retaining.
23663
23664
23665
23666 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23667 .cindex "retry" "rules"
23668 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23669 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23670 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23671 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23672 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23673 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23674 message's sender, respectively.
23675
23676
23677 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23678 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23679 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23680 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23681 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23682 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23683 example,
23684 .code
23685 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23686 .endd
23687 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23688 whereas
23689 .code
23690 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23691 .endd
23692 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23693 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23694 part.
23695
23696 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23697 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
23698 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23699 expressions work in address lists.
23700 .display
23701 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23702 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23703 .endd
23704
23705
23706 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23707 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23708 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23709 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23710 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23711 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23712 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23713 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23714 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23715
23716 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23717 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23718 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23719 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23720 local transports).
23721
23722 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23723 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23724 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23725 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23726 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23727 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23728 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23729 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23730 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23731 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23732 commands.
23733
23734
23735
23736 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23737 "SECID160"
23738 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23739 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23740 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23741 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23742 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23743 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23744 .code
23745 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23746 MX 6 p.q.r.example
23747 MX 7 m.n.o.example
23748 .endd
23749 and the retry rules are
23750 .code
23751 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23752 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23753 .endd
23754 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23755 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23756 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23757 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23758 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23759 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23760
23761 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23762 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23763 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23764 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23765
23766 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23767 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23768 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23769 .code
23770 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23771 .endd
23772 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23773 textual form of the IP address.
23774
23775 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23776 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23777 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23778 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23779
23780 .vlist
23781 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
23782 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23783 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23784
23785 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
23786 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23787 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23788
23789 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23790 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23791
23792 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23793 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23794 .endlist
23795
23796 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23797 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23798 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23799 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23800 retry rule of this form:
23801 .code
23802 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23803 .endd
23804 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23805 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23806
23807 .vlist
23808 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
23809 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23810 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23811 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23812
23813 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
23814 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23815
23816 .vitem &%refused_A%&
23817 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23818
23819 .vitem &%refused%&
23820 A connection was refused.
23821
23822 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23823 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23824
23825 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23826 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23827
23828 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23829 A connection attempt timed out.
23830
23831 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23832 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23833 obtained from an MX record.
23834
23835 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
23836 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23837 obtained from an MX record.
23838
23839 .vitem &%timeout%&
23840 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23841
23842 .vitem &%tls_required%&
23843 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23844 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23845 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23846
23847 .vitem &%quota%&
23848 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23849 transport.
23850
23851 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23852 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23853 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23854 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23855 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23856 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23857 for four days.
23858 .endlist
23859
23860 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23861 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23862 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23863 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23864 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23865 heuristic rules:
23866
23867 .ilist
23868 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23869 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23870 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23871 .next
23872 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23873 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23874 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23875 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23876 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23877 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23878 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23879 .next
23880 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23881 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23882 .endlist
23883
23884 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23885 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23886 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23887 error).
23888
23889
23890
23891 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23892 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23893 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23894 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23895 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23896 form:
23897 .display
23898 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23899 .endd
23900 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23901 .code
23902 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23903 .endd
23904 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23905 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23906 For example:
23907 .code
23908 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23909 .endd
23910 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23911 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23912 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23913 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23914 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23915
23916 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23917 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
23918 .code
23919 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23920 .endd
23921 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23922 list is never matched.
23923
23924
23925
23926
23927
23928 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23929 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23930 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23931 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23932 .display
23933 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23934 .endd
23935 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23936 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23937 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23938 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23939 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23940
23941 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23942 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23943 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23944 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23945 The available algorithms are:
23946
23947 .ilist
23948 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23949 the interval.
23950 .next
23951 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23952 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23953 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23954 .next
23955 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23956 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23957 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23958 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23959 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23960 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23961 queue processing times.
23962 .endlist
23963
23964 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23965 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23966 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23967 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23968 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23969 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23970 interval is found. The main configuration variable
23971 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23972 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23973 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23974 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23975 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23976
23977 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23978 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23979 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23980 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23981 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23982 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23983 time.
23984
23985 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23986 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23987 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23988 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23989 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23990 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23991 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23992 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23993 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23994 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23995 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23996 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23997
23998 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23999 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24000 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24001 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24002 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24003 deliveries that have been deferred.
24004
24005
24006 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24007 Here are some example retry rules:
24008 .code
24009 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24010 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24011 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24012 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24013 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24014 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24015 .endd
24016 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24017 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24018 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24019 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24020 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24021 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24022 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24023 days.
24024
24025 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24026 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24027 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24028 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24029 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24030
24031 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24032 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24033 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24034 were not obtained from an MX record.
24035
24036 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24037 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24038 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24039 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24040 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24041
24042
24043
24044 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24045 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24046 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24047 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24048 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24049 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24050 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24051 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24052 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24053 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24054 failing for the first time.
24055
24056 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24057 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24058 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24059 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24060
24061 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24062 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24063 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24064
24065
24066
24067
24068 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24069 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24070 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24071 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24072 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24073 default retry rule:
24074 .code
24075 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24076 .endd
24077 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24078 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24079 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24080
24081 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24082 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24083 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24084 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24085 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24086
24087 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24088 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24089 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24090
24091 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24092 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24093 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24094 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24095 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24096 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24097 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24098 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24099
24100 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24101 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24102 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24103 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24104 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24105 notice.
24106
24107 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24108 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24109 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24110 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24111 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24112 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24113 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24114 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24115 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24116 true.
24117
24118 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24119 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24120 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24121 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24122 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24123 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24124 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24125 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24126 reached.
24127
24128 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24129 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24130 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24131 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24132 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24133 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24134 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24135 time out the address.
24136
24137 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24138 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24139 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24140 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24141 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24142 considered immediately.
24143 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24144 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24145
24146
24147
24148
24149
24150
24151 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24152 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24153
24154 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24155 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24156 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24157 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24158 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24159 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24160 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24161 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24162 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24163 other.
24164
24165 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24166 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24167
24168 .ilist
24169 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24170 the client's EHLO command.
24171 .next
24172 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24173 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24174 .next
24175 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24176 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24177 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24178 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24179 with the AUTH command.
24180 .next
24181 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24182 .next
24183 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24184 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24185 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24186 connection.
24187 .next
24188 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24189 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24190 unauthenticated connection.
24191 .endlist
24192
24193 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24194 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24195 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24196 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24197 .display
24198 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24199 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24200 &`Connected to server.example.`&
24201 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
24202 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24203 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24204 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24205 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24206 &`250-PIPELINING`&
24207 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
24208 &`250 HELP`&
24209 .endd
24210 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24211 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24212 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24213 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24214 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24215 included by setting
24216 .code
24217 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
24218 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24219 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
24220 AUTH_GSASL=yes
24221 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24222 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
24223 AUTH_SPA=yes
24224 .endd
24225 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24226 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24227 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24228 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24229 work via a socket interface.
24230 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24231 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24232 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24233 supporting setting a server keytab.
24234 The sixth can be configured to support
24235 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24236 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24237 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24238
24239 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24240 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24241 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24242 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24243 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24244 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24245 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24246
24247 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24248 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24249 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24250 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24251 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24252 both sets of options, is required. For example:
24253 .code
24254 cram:
24255 driver = cram_md5
24256 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24257 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24258 client_name = ph10
24259 client_secret = secret2
24260 .endd
24261 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24262 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24263
24264 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24265 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24266 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24267 in Exim.
24268
24269 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24270 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24271 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24272 authenticating data.
24273
24274 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24275 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24276 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24277 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24278 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24279 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24280 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24281 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24282 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24283 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24284 choose to honour.
24285
24286 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24287 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24288 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24289 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24290
24291
24292
24293 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24294 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24295 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24296
24297 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24298 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24299 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24300 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24301 encrypted by a setting such as:
24302 .code
24303 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
24304 .endd
24305
24306
24307 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24308 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
24309 result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
24310 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
24311
24312
24313 .option driver authenticators string unset
24314 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
24315 authenticators is to be used.
24316
24317
24318 .option public_name authenticators string unset
24319 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
24320 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
24321 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
24322 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
24323 defaults to the driver's instance name.
24324
24325
24326 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24327 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
24328 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
24329 mechanism is not advertised.
24330 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
24331 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
24332 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
24333
24334
24335 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24336 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
24337 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
24338 for details.
24339
24340 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
24341 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
24342
24343 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
24344 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
24345 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
24346 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24347 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24348 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24349 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24350 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24351 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24352 the error text.
24353
24354
24355 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24356 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24357 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24358 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24359 out the values of variables.
24360 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24361 output, and Exim carries on processing.
24362
24363
24364 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24365 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24366 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24367 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24368 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24369 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24370 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24371 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24372 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24373
24374
24375 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24376 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24377 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24378 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24379 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24380 remembered for later use.
24381 How it is used is described in the following section.
24382
24383
24384
24385
24386
24387 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24388 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24389 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24390 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24391 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24392 message:
24393
24394 .ilist
24395 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24396 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24397 .next
24398 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24399 .next
24400 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24401 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24402 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24403 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24404 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24405 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24406 given for the MAIL command.
24407 .next
24408 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24409 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24410 authenticated.
24411 .next
24412 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24413 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24414 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24415 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24416 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24417 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24418 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24419 message.
24420 .endlist
24421
24422
24423 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24424 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24425 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24426 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24427
24428 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24429 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24430 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24431 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24432 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24433 ACL is run.
24434
24435
24436
24437 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24438 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24439 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24440 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24441 conditions:
24442
24443 .ilist
24444 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24445 .next
24446 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24447 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24448 .endlist
24449
24450 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24451 the mechanisms are advertised.
24452
24453 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24454 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24455 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24456 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24457 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24458 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24459 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24460 .code
24461 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24462 .endd
24463 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24464
24465 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24466 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24467 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24468 such as:
24469 .code
24470 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24471 .endd
24472 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24473 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24474 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24475
24476 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24477 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24478 command. This is the case if
24479
24480 .ilist
24481 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24482 .next
24483 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24484 .next
24485 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24486 server authenticators.
24487 .endlist
24488
24489
24490 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24491 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24492 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24493
24494 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24495 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24496 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24497 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24498 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24499 rejected with a 504 error.
24500
24501 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24502 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24503 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24504 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24505 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24506 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24507 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24508 no successful authentication.
24509
24510
24511
24512
24513 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24514 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24515 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24516 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24517 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24518 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24519 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24520 script:
24521 .code
24522 use MIME::Base64;
24523 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24524 .endd
24525 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24526 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24527 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24528 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24529 command line to run this script on such data might be
24530 .code
24531 encode '\0user\0password'
24532 .endd
24533 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24534 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24535 whose code value is zero.
24536
24537 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24538 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24539 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24540 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24541
24542 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24543 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24544 example, a command such as
24545 .code
24546 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24547 .endd
24548 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24549
24550 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24551 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24552 .code
24553 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24554 .endd
24555 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24556 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24557 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24558 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24559
24560
24561
24562 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24563 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24564 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24565 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24566 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24567 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24568
24569 .ilist
24570 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24571 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24572 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24573 of the authenticator.
24574 .next
24575 .vindex "&$host$&"
24576 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24577 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24578 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24579 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24580 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24581 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24582 delivery to be deferred.
24583 .next
24584 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24585 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24586 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24587 usual way.
24588 .next
24589 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24590 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24591 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24592 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24593 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24594 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24595 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24596 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24597 deliver the message unauthenticated.
24598 .endlist
24599
24600 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24601 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24602 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24603 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24604 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24605 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24606 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24607 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24608 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24609 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24610 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24611 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
24612 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
24613
24614
24615
24616
24617
24618
24619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24620 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24621
24622 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24623 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24624 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24625 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24626 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24627 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24628 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24629 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24630 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24631 connections as you do for login accounts.
24632
24633 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24634 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24635 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24636
24637 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24638 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24639 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24640
24641 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24642 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24643 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24644 given.
24645
24646 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24647 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24648 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24649 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24650 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24651 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24652 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24653
24654 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24655 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24656 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24657 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24658 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24659 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24660 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24661
24662 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24663 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24664 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24665 string expansions that also use them for other things.
24666
24667 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24668 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24669 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24670
24671 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24672 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24673 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24674 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24675 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24676 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24677 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24678 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24679 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24680 string as the error text
24681
24682 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24683 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24684 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24685
24686
24687
24688 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24689 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24690 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24691 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24692 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24693 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24694 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24695 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24696
24697 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24698 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24699 configured as follows:
24700 .code
24701 fixed_plain:
24702 driver = plaintext
24703 public_name = PLAIN
24704 server_prompts = :
24705 server_condition = \
24706 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24707 server_set_id = $auth2
24708 .endd
24709 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24710 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24711 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24712 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24713
24714 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24715 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24716 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24717 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24718 .code
24719 250-AUTH PLAIN
24720 .endd
24721 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24722 .code
24723 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24724 .endd
24725 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24726 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24727 .code
24728 AUTH PLAIN
24729 .endd
24730 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24731 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24732
24733 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24734 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24735 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24736 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24737 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24738
24739 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24740 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24741 authenticating clients it could make sense.
24742
24743 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24744 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24745 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24746 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24747 This is an incorrect example:
24748 .code
24749 server_condition = \
24750 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24751 .endd
24752 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24753 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24754 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24755 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24756 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24757 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24758 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24759 .code
24760 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24761 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24762 .endd
24763 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24764 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24765 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24766 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24767 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24768
24769
24770 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24771 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24772 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24773 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24774 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24775 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24776 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24777 .code
24778 fixed_login:
24779 driver = plaintext
24780 public_name = LOGIN
24781 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24782 server_condition = \
24783 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24784 server_set_id = $auth1
24785 .endd
24786 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24787 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24788 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24789 strings are used to obtain two data items.
24790
24791 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24792 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24793 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24794 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24795 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24796 .code
24797 login:
24798 driver = plaintext
24799 public_name = LOGIN
24800 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24801 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24802 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
24803 ldapauth{\
24804 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24805 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24806 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24807 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24808 .endd
24809 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24810 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24811 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24812 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24813 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24814 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24815 uninterpreted string.
24816
24817
24818 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24819 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24820 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24821 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24822 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24823 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
24824
24825
24826
24827
24828 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24829 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24830 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24831
24832 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24833 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24834 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24835 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24836 usual.
24837
24838 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24839 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24840 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24841 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24842 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24843 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24844 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24845 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24846 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24847 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24848 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24849 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24850
24851 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24852 splitting takes priority and happens first.
24853
24854 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24855 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24856 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24857 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24858 the string.
24859
24860 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24861 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24862 .code
24863 fixed_plain:
24864 driver = plaintext
24865 public_name = PLAIN
24866 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24867 .endd
24868 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24869 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24870 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24871 .code
24872 fixed_login:
24873 driver = plaintext
24874 public_name = LOGIN
24875 client_send = : username : mysecret
24876 .endd
24877 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24878 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24879 prompts.
24880 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24881 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24882
24883
24884
24885
24886 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24887 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24888
24889 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24890 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24891 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24892 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24893 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24894 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24895 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24896 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24897 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24898 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24899 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24900 available in plain text at either end.
24901
24902
24903 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24904 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24905 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24906 authenticator as a server:
24907
24908 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24909 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24910 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24911 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24912 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24913 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24914 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24915 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24916 returned to the client.
24917
24918 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24919 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24920 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24921 numeric variables for other things.
24922
24923 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24924 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24925 user name, authentication fails.
24926 .code
24927 fixed_cram:
24928 driver = cram_md5
24929 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24930 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24931 server_set_id = $auth1
24932 .endd
24933 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24934 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24935 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24936 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24937 .code
24938 lookup_cram:
24939 driver = cram_md5
24940 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24941 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24942 {$value}fail}
24943 server_set_id = $auth1
24944 .endd
24945 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24946 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24947
24948 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24949 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24950 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24951 realm, with:
24952 .code
24953 cyrusless_crammd5:
24954 driver = cram_md5
24955 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24956 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24957 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24958 server_set_id = $auth1
24959 .endd
24960
24961 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24962 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24963 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24964
24965
24966
24967 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24968 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24969 computing the response to the server's challenge.
24970
24971
24972 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24973 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24974 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24975
24976
24977 .vindex "&$host$&"
24978 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24979 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24980 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24981 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24982 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24983 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24984 send the message to the current server.
24985
24986 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24987 strings, is:
24988 .code
24989 fixed_cram:
24990 driver = cram_md5
24991 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24992 client_name = ph10
24993 client_secret = secret
24994 .endd
24995 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
24996 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
24997
24998
24999
25000 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25002
25003 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25004 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25005 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25006 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25007 .cindex "Kerberos"
25008 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25009 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25010
25011 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25012 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25013 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25014 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25015 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25016
25017 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25018 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25019 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25020 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25021
25022 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25023 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25024 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25025 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25026 depending on the driver you are using.
25027
25028 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25029 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25030 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25031 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25032 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25033 implementation.
25034
25035 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25036 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25037 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25038 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25039 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25040 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25041 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25042 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25043
25044
25045 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25046 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25047 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25048 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25049 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25050 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25051 things.
25052
25053
25054 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25055 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25056 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25057 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25058
25059
25060 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25061 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25062 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25063 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25064 example:
25065 .code
25066 sasl:
25067 driver = cyrus_sasl
25068 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25069 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25070 server_set_id = $auth1
25071 .endd
25072
25073 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25074 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25075
25076
25077 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25078 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25079
25080
25081 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25082 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25083 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25084 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25085 .code
25086 sasl_cram_md5:
25087 driver = cyrus_sasl
25088 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25089 server_set_id = $auth1
25090
25091 sasl_plain:
25092 driver = cyrus_sasl
25093 public_name = PLAIN
25094 server_set_id = $auth2
25095 .endd
25096 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25097 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25098 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25099 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25100 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25101
25102
25103
25104
25105 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25106 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25107 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25108 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25109 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25110 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25111 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25112 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25113 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25114 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25115
25116 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25117
25118 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25119 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25120 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25121 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25122 .code
25123 dovecot_plain:
25124 driver = dovecot
25125 public_name = PLAIN
25126 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25127 server_set_id = $auth2
25128
25129 dovecot_ntlm:
25130 driver = dovecot
25131 public_name = NTLM
25132 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25133 server_set_id = $auth1
25134 .endd
25135 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25136 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25137 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25138 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25139 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25140 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25141 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25142 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25143
25144
25145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25146 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25147 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25148 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25149 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25150 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25151 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25152 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25153 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25154 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25155 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25156 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25157 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25158 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25159 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25160 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25161 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25162 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25163 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25164 without code changes in Exim.
25165
25166
25167 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25168 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25169 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25170 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25171 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25172 context.
25173
25174 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25175 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25176 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25177
25178 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25179 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25180 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25181
25182 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25183 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25184 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25185
25186
25187 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25188 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25189 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25190 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25191
25192
25193 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25194 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25195 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25196 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25197 example:
25198 .code
25199 sasl:
25200 driver = gsasl
25201 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25202 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25203 server_set_id = $auth1
25204 .endd
25205
25206
25207 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25208 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25209 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25210 the password itself.
25211
25212 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25213 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25214 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25215 if available, else the empty string.
25216 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25217 else the empty string.
25218
25219 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25220
25221 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25222 option to be simply "true".
25223
25224
25225 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25226 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25227 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25228
25229
25230 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25231 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25232 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25233 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25234
25235
25236 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25237 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25238 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25239 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25240
25241
25242 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25243 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25244 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25245
25246
25247 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25248 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25249 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25250 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25251
25252 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25253 meanings for these variables:
25254
25255 .ilist
25256 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25257 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25258 .next
25259 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25260 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25261 .next
25262 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
25263 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25264 .endlist
25265
25266 On a per-mechanism basis:
25267
25268 .ilist
25269 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25270 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25271 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25272 .next
25273 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25274 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25275 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25276 .next
25277 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25278 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25279 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25280 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25281 .endlist
25282
25283 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25284 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
25285 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25286
25287
25288 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25289 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25290 .code
25291 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25292 driver = gsasl
25293 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25294 server_realm = imap.example.org
25295 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25296 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25297 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25298 server_condition = yes
25299 .endd
25300
25301
25302 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25303 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25304
25305 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
25306 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
25307 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
25308 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25309 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
25310 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
25311 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
25312 reliably.
25313
25314 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
25315 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
25316 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
25317 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25318
25319 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
25320 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
25321 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
25322 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
25323
25324 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
25325 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
25326 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
25327 from the keytab.
25328
25329
25330 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
25331 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
25332 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
25333 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
25334
25335 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
25336 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
25337 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
25338 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
25339
25340 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25341 .ilist
25342 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25343 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
25344 .next
25345 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25346 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25347 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25348 GSS Display Name.
25349 .endlist
25350
25351
25352 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25353 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25354
25355 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25356 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25357 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25358 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25359 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25360 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25361 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
25362 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25363 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25364 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25365 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25366 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25367 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25368 follows:
25369
25370 .ilist
25371 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25372 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25373 .next
25374 The server sends back a challenge.
25375 .next
25376 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25377 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25378 .endlist
25379
25380 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25381
25382
25383
25384 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25385 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25386 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25387
25388 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
25389 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25390 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25391 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25392 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25393 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25394 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25395 for other things. For example:
25396 .code
25397 spa:
25398 driver = spa
25399 public_name = NTLM
25400 server_password = \
25401 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25402 .endd
25403 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25404 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25405
25406
25407
25408
25409
25410 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25411 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25412 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25413
25414
25415
25416 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25417 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25418
25419
25420 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
25421 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25422
25423
25424 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
25425 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25426 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25427 &'msn.com'&:
25428 .code
25429 msn:
25430 driver = spa
25431 public_name = MSN
25432 client_username = msn/msn_username
25433 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25434 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25435 .endd
25436 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
25437 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
25438
25439
25440
25441
25442
25443 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25444 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25445
25446 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25447 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25448 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25449 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25450 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25451 .cindex "OpenSSL"
25452 .cindex "GnuTLS"
25453 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25454 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25455 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25456 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25457 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25458 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25459 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25460 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25461 certificates are used.
25462
25463 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25464 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25465 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25466 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25467 between them is encrypted.
25468
25469 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25470 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25471 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25472 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25473 encryption state.
25474
25475 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25476 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25477 in order to get TLS to work.
25478
25479
25480
25481 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25482 "SECID284"
25483 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25484 .cindex "smtps protocol"
25485 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25486 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25487 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25488 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25489 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25490 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25491 allocated for this purpose.
25492
25493 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25494 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25495 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25496 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25497 .code
25498 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25499 .endd
25500 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25501 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25502 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25503 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25504 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25505 defined elsewhere.
25506
25507 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25508 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25509
25510
25511
25512
25513
25514
25515 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25516 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25517 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25518 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25519 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25520 .code
25521 USE_GNUTLS=yes
25522 .endd
25523 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25524 .code
25525 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
25526 .endd
25527 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25528 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25529
25530 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25531
25532 .ilist
25533 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25534 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
25535 .next
25536 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25537 .next
25538 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25539 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
25540 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25541 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25542 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
25543 .next
25544 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25545 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25546 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25547 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25548 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25549 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25550 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25551 option).
25552 .next
25553 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25554 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25555 .next
25556 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25557 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25558 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25559 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25560 .next
25561 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25562 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25563 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25564 implementation, then patches are welcome.
25565 .endlist
25566
25567
25568 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25569 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25570 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25571 but not the chosen filename.
25572 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25573 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25574
25575 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25576 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25577 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25578 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25579 of bits requested.
25580 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25581 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25582 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25583 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25584 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25585 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25586 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25587
25588 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25589 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25590 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25591 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25592 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25593
25594 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25595 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25596 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25597 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25598 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25599 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25600
25601 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25602 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25603 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25604
25605 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25606 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25607 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25608 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25609 .code
25610 # ls
25611 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25612 # rm -f new-params
25613 # touch new-params
25614 # chown exim:exim new-params
25615 # chmod 0600 new-params
25616 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25617 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
25618 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
25619 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
25620 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
25621 # chmod 0400 new-params
25622 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25623 .endd
25624 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25625 stalling is removed.
25626
25627 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25628 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25629 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25630 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25631 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25632 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25633 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25634 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25635 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25636 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25637 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25638
25639 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25640 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25641 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
25642 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25643
25644 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
25645 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
25646 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
25647 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
25648 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
25649
25650
25651 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25652 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25653 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25654 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25655 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25656 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25657 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25658 directly to this function call.
25659 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25660 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25661 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25662 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25663
25664 .ilist
25665 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25666 .next
25667 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25668 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25669 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25670 SSL v3 algorithms.
25671 .next
25672 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25673 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25674 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25675 algorithms.
25676 .endlist
25677
25678 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25679 &`-`& or &`+`&.
25680 .ilist
25681 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25682 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25683 stated.
25684 .next
25685 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25686 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25687 .next
25688 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25689 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25690 .endlist
25691
25692 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25693 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25694 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25695 not be moved to the end of the list.
25696 .endlist
25697
25698 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
25699 string:
25700 .code
25701 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
25702 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
25703 .endd
25704
25705 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25706 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
25707 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
25708 choice of clients used:
25709 .code
25710 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
25711 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25712 {DEFAULT}\
25713 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
25714 .endd
25715
25716
25717
25718 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25719 "SECTreqciphgnu"
25720 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25721 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25722 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25723 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25724 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25725 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25726 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25727 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25728 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25729 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25730
25731 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25732
25733 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25734 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25735 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25736 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25737 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25738 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25739
25740 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25741 "Priority strings". This is online as
25742 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
25743 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
25744 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
25745 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
25746 on that site can be used to test a given string.
25747
25748 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25749 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25750 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25751
25752 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25753 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
25754 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
25755 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
25756 used:
25757 .code
25758 # GnuTLS variant
25759 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25760 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
25761 {SECURE128}}
25762 .endd
25763
25764
25765 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25766 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25767 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25768 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25769 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25770 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25771 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25772 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25773
25774 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25775 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25776 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25777 with the error
25778 .code
25779 554 Security failure
25780 .endd
25781 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25782 rejected with a 554 error code.
25783
25784 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25785 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25786 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25787 without some further configuration at the server end.
25788
25789 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25790 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25791 .code
25792 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25793 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25794 .endd
25795 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25796 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25797 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25798 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25799 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25800 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25801 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25802 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25803 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25804 the server's certificate.
25805
25806 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25807 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25808 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25809
25810 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25811 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25812 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25813 transport.
25814
25815 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25816 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25817 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25818 .code
25819 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25820 .endd
25821 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25822 with the parameters contained in the file.
25823 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
25824 available:
25825 .code
25826 tls_dhparam = none
25827 .endd
25828 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
25829 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
25830 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
25831 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
25832
25833 See the command
25834 .code
25835 openssl dhparam
25836 .endd
25837 for a way of generating file data.
25838
25839 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25840 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25841 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25842 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25843 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25844
25845 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25846 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25847 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25848 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25849 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25850 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25851 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25852 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25853 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25854
25855 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25856 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25857 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25858 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25859 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25860 documentation for more details.
25861
25862 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
25863 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
25864
25865
25866 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25867 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25868 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25869 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25870 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25871 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25872 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25873 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25874 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25875 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25876 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25877 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25878
25879 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25880 directory is used
25881 (OpenSSL only),
25882 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25883 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25884 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25885 .code
25886 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25887 .endd
25888 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25889
25890 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25891 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25892 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25893 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25894 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25895 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25896 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25897 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25898 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25899 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25900
25901 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25902 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25903 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25904 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25905
25906 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25907 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25908 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25909 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25910 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25911 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
25912
25913
25914 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25915 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25916 .cindex "revocation list"
25917 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25918 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25919 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25920 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25921 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25922 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25923 CRL in PEM format.
25924
25925
25926 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25927 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25928 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25929 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25930 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25931 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25932 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25933 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25934 within the &(smtp)& transport.
25935
25936 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25937 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25938 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25939 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25940 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25941
25942 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25943 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25944 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25945 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25946 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25947 usual way.
25948
25949 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25950 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25951 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25952 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25953 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25954 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25955 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25956 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25957 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25958 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25959 unencrypted.
25960
25961 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25962 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25963 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25964 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25965
25966 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25967 must name a file or,
25968 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25969 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25970 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25971 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25972 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
25973 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
25974
25975 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
25976 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
25977 or need not succeed respectively.
25978
25979 If
25980 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25981 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25982 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25983 alternative hosts, if any.
25984
25985 &*Note*&:
25986 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25987 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25988 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25989 client.
25990
25991 .vindex "&$host$&"
25992 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25993 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25994 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25995 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25996 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25997
25998 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
25999 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26000 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26001 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26002 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26003 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26004 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26005 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26006 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26007 outgoing connection.
26008
26009
26010
26011 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
26012 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26013 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
26014 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
26015 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
26016 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
26017 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
26018 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
26019 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
26020 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
26021 for this session.
26022
26023 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
26024 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
26025 address.
26026
26027 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
26028 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
26029 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
26030 be of limited use in that environment.
26031
26032 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
26033 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
26034 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
26035 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
26036 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
26037
26038 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
26039 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
26040 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
26041 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
26042 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
26043
26044 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
26045 received from a client.
26046 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
26047
26048 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
26049 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
26050 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
26051
26052 .ilist
26053 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
26054 &%tls_certificate%&
26055 .next
26056 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
26057 &%tls_crl%&
26058 .next
26059 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
26060 &%tls_privatekey%&
26061 .next
26062 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
26063 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
26064 .endlist
26065
26066 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
26067 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
26068 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
26069 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
26070
26071 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
26072 are re-expanded.
26073
26074 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
26075 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
26076 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
26077 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
26078
26079 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
26080 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
26081 built, then you have SNI support).
26082
26083
26084
26085 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
26086 "SECTmulmessam"
26087 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
26088 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26089 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
26090 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
26091 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
26092 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
26093 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
26094 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26095 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26096 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26097 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26098
26099 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26100 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
26101 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
26102 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
26103 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
26104 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
26105 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
26106 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
26107 and delay other deliveries to that host.
26108
26109 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
26110 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
26111 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
26112 information is recorded.
26113
26114 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
26115 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
26116 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
26117
26118
26119
26120
26121 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
26122 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
26123 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
26124 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
26125 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
26126 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
26127 to Apache, currently at
26128 .display
26129 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
26130 .endd
26131 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
26132 links to further files.
26133 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
26134 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
26135 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
26136 .display
26137 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
26138 .endd
26139
26140
26141 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
26142 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
26143 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
26144 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
26145 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
26146 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
26147 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
26148 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
26149 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
26150 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
26151 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
26152 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
26153 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
26154
26155 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
26156 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
26157 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
26158 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
26159
26160
26161
26162 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
26163 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
26164 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
26165 with OpenSSL, like this:
26166 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
26167 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
26168 .code
26169 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
26170 -days 9999 -nodes
26171 .endd
26172 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
26173 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
26174 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
26175 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
26176 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
26177 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
26178 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
26179
26180 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
26181 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
26182 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
26183 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
26184 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
26185 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
26186 . ==== -pdp, 2012
26187 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
26188 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
26189 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
26190 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
26191 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
26192 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
26193 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
26194 be a sensible resolution).
26195
26196 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
26197 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
26198 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
26199
26200 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
26201 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
26202 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
26203 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
26204 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
26205 signed with that self-signed certificate.
26206
26207 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
26208 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
26209 Open-source PKI book, available online at
26210 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
26211 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
26212 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
26213
26214
26215
26216 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26217 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26218
26219 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
26220 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
26221 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
26222 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
26223 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
26224 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
26225 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
26226 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
26227 one very small ACL:
26228 .code
26229 begin acl
26230 small_acl:
26231 accept hosts = one.host.only
26232 .endd
26233 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
26234 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
26235
26236 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
26237 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
26238 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
26239 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
26240 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
26241 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
26242 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
26243 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
26244
26245
26246 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
26247 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
26248 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
26249 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
26250 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
26251
26252
26253
26254 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
26255 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
26256 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
26257 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
26258 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
26259 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26260 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
26261 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
26262 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26263 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26264 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
26265 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26266 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
26267 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
26268 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
26269 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26270 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26271 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
26272
26273 .table2 140pt
26274 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
26275 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
26276 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
26277 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
26278 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
26279 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
26280 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
26281 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
26282 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
26283 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
26284 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
26285 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
26286 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
26287 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
26288 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
26289 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
26290 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
26291 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
26292 .endtable
26293
26294 For example, if you set
26295 .code
26296 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
26297 .endd
26298 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
26299 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
26300 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
26301 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
26302 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
26303 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
26304 testing as possible at RCPT time.
26305
26306
26307 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
26308 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26309 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
26310 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
26311 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
26312 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
26313 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
26314 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
26315 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
26316 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
26317 in any of these ACLs.
26318
26319 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
26320 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
26321 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
26322 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
26323 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
26324 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
26325 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
26326 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
26327 .code
26328 control = suppress_local_fixups
26329 .endd
26330 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
26331 run, it is too late.
26332
26333 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26334 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26335
26336 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
26337 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
26338 temporary error for these kinds of message.
26339
26340
26341 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
26342 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26343 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
26344 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
26345 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
26346 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
26347 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
26348 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
26349 &%smtp_banner%& option.
26350
26351
26352 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
26353 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26354 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26355 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
26356 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
26357 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
26358 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
26359 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
26360 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
26361
26362 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
26363 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
26364 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
26365 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
26366 an EHLO response.
26367
26368
26369 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
26370 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26371 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
26372 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
26373 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
26374 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
26375 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
26376 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
26377 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
26378 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
26379
26380 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
26381 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
26382 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
26383 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
26384 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
26385 associated with the DATA command.
26386
26387 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
26388 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
26389 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
26390 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
26391 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
26392 your resources.
26393
26394 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after both the &%acl_smtp_dkim%& and
26395 the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
26396
26397 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
26398 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
26399 enabled (which is the default).
26400
26401 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
26402 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
26403 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
26404
26405 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26406
26407 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
26408
26409
26410 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
26411 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26412 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26413
26414 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26415
26416
26417 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
26418 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26419 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
26420 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
26421 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
26422 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
26423
26424 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
26425 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
26426 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
26427 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
26428
26429 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
26430 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
26431
26432 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
26433 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
26434 response to QUIT.
26435
26436 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
26437 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
26438 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
26439 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
26440 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
26441
26442
26443 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
26444 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
26445 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
26446 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
26447 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
26448 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
26449 situation even worse.
26450
26451 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
26452 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
26453 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
26454 and &%warn%&.
26455
26456 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
26457 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
26458 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
26459 connection. The possible values are:
26460 .table2
26461 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
26462 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
26463 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
26464 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
26465 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
26466 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
26467 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
26468 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
26469 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
26470 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
26471 .endtable
26472 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
26473 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
26474 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
26475 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
26476 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
26477 used.
26478
26479
26480 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
26481 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
26482 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
26483 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
26484 .code
26485 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
26486 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
26487 .endd
26488 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
26489 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
26490 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
26491 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
26492 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
26493
26494 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
26495 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
26496 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
26497
26498 .ilist
26499 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
26500 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
26501 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
26502 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
26503 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
26504 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
26505 .code
26506 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
26507 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
26508 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
26509 .endd
26510 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
26511 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
26512 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
26513 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
26514 .next
26515 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
26516 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
26517 matches the string.
26518 .next
26519 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
26520 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
26521 want to have something like
26522 .code
26523 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
26524 .endd
26525 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
26526 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
26527 .endlist
26528
26529
26530
26531
26532 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
26533 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
26534 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
26535 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
26536 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
26537 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
26538 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
26539 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
26540 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
26541
26542 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
26543 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
26544 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
26545
26546
26547 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
26548 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
26549 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
26550 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
26551
26552 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
26553 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
26554 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
26555 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
26556 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
26557 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
26558 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
26559
26560
26561 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
26562 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
26563 recipients; it may create new recipients.
26564
26565
26566
26567 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
26568 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
26569 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
26570 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
26571 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
26572 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
26573
26574 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
26575 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
26576 used to accept or reject anything.
26577
26578 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
26579 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
26580 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
26581 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
26582
26583 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
26584 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
26585 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
26586 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
26587 configuration file.
26588
26589
26590
26591
26592 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
26593 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
26594 .vindex &$domain$&
26595 .vindex &$local_part$&
26596 .vindex &$sender_address$&
26597 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
26598 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26599 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
26600 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
26601 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
26602 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
26603 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
26604 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26605
26606 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
26607 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
26608 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
26609 how it is used.
26610
26611 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
26612 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
26613 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
26614 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
26615 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
26616 received).
26617
26618 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
26619 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
26620 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
26621 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
26622 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
26623 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
26624 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
26625 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
26626
26627
26628
26629
26630
26631 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
26632 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
26633 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
26634 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26635 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
26636 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
26637 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26638 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
26639 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
26640 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
26641 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
26642 unencrypted connections.
26643 .code
26644 acl_check_auth:
26645 accept encrypted = *
26646 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
26647 {CRAM-MD5}}
26648 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
26649 .endd
26650 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
26651 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
26652 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
26653 option to do this.)
26654
26655
26656
26657 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
26658 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
26659 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
26660 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
26661 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
26662 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
26663 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
26664
26665 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
26666 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
26667 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
26668 example:
26669 .code
26670 deny dnslists = list1.example
26671 dnslists = list2.example
26672 .endd
26673 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
26674 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
26675 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
26676 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
26677 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
26678
26679
26680 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
26681 The ACL verbs are as follows:
26682
26683 .ilist
26684 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
26685 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
26686 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
26687 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
26688 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
26689 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
26690 check a RCPT command:
26691 .code
26692 accept domains = +local_domains
26693 endpass
26694 verify = recipient
26695 .endd
26696 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
26697 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
26698 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
26699 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
26700 &%endpass%&.
26701
26702 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
26703 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
26704 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
26705 configuration.
26706
26707 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
26708 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
26709 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
26710 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
26711 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
26712 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
26713 .display
26714 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
26715 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
26716 .endd
26717 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
26718 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
26719 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
26720
26721 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
26722 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
26723 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26724 of &%endpass%&.
26725
26726
26727 .next
26728 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26729 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26730 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26731 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26732 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26733 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26734 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26735
26736
26737 .next
26738 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26739 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26740 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26741 example,
26742 .code
26743 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26744 .endd
26745 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26746
26747
26748 .next
26749 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26750 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26751 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26752 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26753 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26754 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26755 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26756 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26757 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26758
26759 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26760 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26761 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26762
26763
26764 .next
26765 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26766 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26767 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26768 .code
26769 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26770 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26771 .endd
26772 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26773 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26774
26775 .next
26776 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26777 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26778 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26779 example, when checking a RCPT command,
26780 .code
26781 require message = Sender did not verify
26782 verify = sender
26783 .endd
26784 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26785 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26786 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26787 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26788
26789 .next
26790 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26791 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26792 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26793 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26794 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26795 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26796 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26797
26798 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26799 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26800 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
26801 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26802 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26803
26804 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26805 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26806 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26807 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26808 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26809 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26810 onwards.
26811
26812
26813 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26814 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26815 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26816 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26817 .code
26818 warn !verify = sender
26819 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26820 .endd
26821 .endlist
26822
26823 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26824
26825 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26826 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26827 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26828 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26829 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26830
26831
26832
26833 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26834 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26835 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26836 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26837 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26838 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26839 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26840 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26841 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26842 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26843 .ilist
26844 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26845 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26846 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26847 on the same SMTP connection.
26848 .next
26849 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26850 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26851 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26852 .endlist
26853
26854 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26855 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26856 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26857 .code
26858 accept hosts = whatever
26859 set acl_m4 = some value
26860 accept authenticated = *
26861 set acl_c_auth = yes
26862 .endd
26863 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26864 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26865 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26866
26867 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26868 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26869 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26870 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26871 error is generated.
26872
26873 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26874 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26875
26876
26877 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26878 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26879 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26880 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26881 .code
26882 deny domains = *.dom.example
26883 !verify = recipient
26884 .endd
26885 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26886 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26887 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26888 two statements are equivalent:
26889 .code
26890 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26891 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26892 .endd
26893 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26894 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26895
26896 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26897 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26898 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26899 .code
26900 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26901 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26902 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26903 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26904 .endd
26905 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26906 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26907 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26908 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26909 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26910 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26911 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26912
26913 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26914 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26915 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26916 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26917 message is handled.
26918
26919 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
26920 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26921 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26922 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26923 .code
26924 require message = Can't verify sender
26925 verify = sender
26926 message = Can't verify recipient
26927 verify = recipient
26928 message = This message cannot be used
26929 .endd
26930 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26931 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26932 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26933 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26934 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26935 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26936
26937 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26938 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26939 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26940 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26941 .code
26942 deny hosts = ...
26943 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26944 message = Invalid sender from client host
26945 .endd
26946 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26947 by which time Exim has set up the message.
26948
26949
26950
26951 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26952 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26953 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26954
26955 .vlist
26956 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26957 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26958 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26959 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26960
26961 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26962 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26963 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26964 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26965 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26966 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26967 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26968 write rather ugly lines like this:
26969 .display
26970 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26971 .endd
26972 Instead, all you need is
26973 .display
26974 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26975 .endd
26976
26977 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26978 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26979 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26980 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26981 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26982 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26983 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26984 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26985
26986 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26987 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26988 in several different ways. For example:
26989
26990 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26991 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26992 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26993 . ==== way.
26994
26995 .ilist
26996 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26997 .code
26998 accept ...some conditions
26999 control = queue_only
27000 .endd
27001 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
27002 other words, when the conditions are all true.
27003
27004 .next
27005 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
27006 .code
27007 accept ...some conditions...
27008 control = queue_only
27009 ...some more conditions...
27010 .endd
27011 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
27012 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
27013 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
27014 to be relevant.
27015
27016 .next
27017 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
27018 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
27019 example:
27020 .code
27021 warn ...some conditions...
27022 control = freeze
27023 accept ...
27024 .endd
27025 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
27026 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
27027 log entry.
27028
27029 .next
27030 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
27031 &%require%& verb. For example:
27032 .code
27033 require control = no_multiline_responses
27034 .endd
27035 .endlist
27036
27037 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
27038 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
27039 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
27040 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
27041 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
27042 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
27043 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
27044 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
27045 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
27046
27047 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
27048 example:
27049 .code
27050 deny ...some conditions...
27051 delay = 30s
27052 .endd
27053 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
27054 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
27055 .code
27056 deny delay = 30s
27057 ...some conditions...
27058 .endd
27059 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
27060 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
27061 .code
27062 warn ...some conditions...
27063 delay = 2m
27064 control = freeze
27065 accept ...
27066 .endd
27067
27068 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
27069 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
27070 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
27071 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
27072 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
27073 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
27074 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
27075
27076
27077 .vitem &*endpass*&
27078 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
27079 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
27080 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
27081 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
27082 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
27083 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
27084 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
27085
27086
27087 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27088 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
27089 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
27090 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
27091 .code
27092 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
27093 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
27094 .endd
27095 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
27096 example:
27097 .display
27098 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
27099 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
27100 .endd
27101 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
27102 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
27103 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
27104 message.
27105
27106 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
27107 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
27108 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
27109 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
27110 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
27111 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
27112 ignored.
27113
27114 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27115 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
27116 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
27117 error message.
27118
27119 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
27120 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
27121 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
27122 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
27123 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
27124 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
27125
27126 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
27127 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
27128 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
27129 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
27130 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
27131 logging rejections.
27132
27133
27134 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
27135 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
27136 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
27137 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
27138 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
27139 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
27140 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
27141 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
27142 .display
27143 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
27144 &` log_reject_target =`&
27145 .endd
27146 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
27147 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
27148 current ACL.
27149
27150
27151 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27152 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
27153 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
27154 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
27155 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
27156 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
27157 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
27158 ACLs. For example:
27159 .display
27160 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
27161 &` control = freeze`&
27162 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
27163 .endd
27164 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
27165 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
27166 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
27167 example:
27168 .code
27169 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
27170 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
27171 .endd
27172
27173
27174 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27175 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27176 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
27177 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
27178 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
27179 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
27180 &%accept%& for details.)
27181
27182 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
27183 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
27184 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
27185 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
27186 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
27187 .code
27188 require message = Host not recognized
27189 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
27190 .endd
27191 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
27192 processed.)
27193
27194 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
27195 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
27196 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
27197 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
27198 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
27199 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
27200 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
27201 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
27202 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
27203 EHLO options.
27204
27205 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
27206 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
27207 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
27208 .code
27209 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
27210 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
27211 .endd
27212 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
27213 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
27214 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
27215 2&'xx'&.
27216
27217 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
27218 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
27219
27220 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
27221 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
27222 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
27223 response.
27224
27225 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27226 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
27227 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
27228 However, the original message is available in the variable
27229 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
27230 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
27231 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
27232 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
27233
27234 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
27235 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
27236 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
27237 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
27238 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
27239 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
27240 effect.
27241
27242
27243 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27244 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
27245 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
27246 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
27247
27248
27249 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
27250 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
27251 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
27252 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
27253
27254
27255 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
27256 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
27257 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
27258 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
27259 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
27260 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
27261 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
27262 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
27263 when:
27264 .code
27265 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
27266 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
27267 .endd
27268 .endlist
27269
27270
27271
27272
27273 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
27274 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27275 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
27276
27277 .vlist
27278 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
27279 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
27280 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
27281 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
27282 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
27283 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
27284 not work without it. For example:
27285 .code
27286 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
27287 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
27288 .endd
27289 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
27290 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
27291 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
27292 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
27293 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
27294
27295
27296 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
27297 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
27298 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
27299 .cindex "case of local parts"
27300 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27301 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
27302 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
27303 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
27304 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
27305 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
27306 is encountered.
27307
27308 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
27309 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
27310 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
27311 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
27312 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
27313
27314 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
27315 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
27316 spam score:
27317 .code
27318 warn control = caseful_local_part
27319 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
27320 $acl_m4 + \
27321 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
27322 }
27323 control = caselower_local_part
27324 .endd
27325 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
27326 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
27327
27328
27329 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
27330 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
27331 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
27332 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
27333 It is usable in the RCPT ACL and valid only for single-recipient mails forwarded
27334 from one SMTP connection to another. If a recipient-verify callout connection is
27335 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data, otherwise one is made
27336 after the ACL completes.
27337
27338 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
27339 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
27340 Note also that headers cannot be
27341 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
27342 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
27343
27344 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
27345 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
27346 before the entire message has been received from the source.
27347
27348 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
27349 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
27350 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
27351 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode the log line
27352 is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears before the acceptance "<="
27353 line.
27354
27355 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a (possibly faked)
27356 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
27357
27358
27359 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
27360 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
27361 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
27362 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
27363 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
27364 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
27365 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
27366 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
27367 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
27368 contexts):
27369 .code
27370 control = debug
27371 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
27372 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
27373 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
27374 .endd
27375
27376
27377 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
27378 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
27379 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
27380 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
27381 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27382
27383
27384 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
27385 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
27386 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
27387 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
27388 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
27389 strings or to numeric value.
27390 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
27391 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
27392 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
27393
27394 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
27395 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
27396 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
27397 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
27398 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
27399
27400
27401 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
27402 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
27403 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
27404 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
27405 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
27406 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
27407 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
27408 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
27409
27410 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27411 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
27412 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
27413 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
27414 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
27415 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
27416 work with.
27417
27418
27419 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
27420 .cindex "fake defer"
27421 .cindex "defer, fake"
27422 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
27423 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
27424 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
27425 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
27426 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
27427
27428 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
27429 .cindex "fake rejection"
27430 .cindex "rejection, fake"
27431 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
27432 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
27433 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
27434 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
27435 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27436 the same SMTP connection.
27437
27438 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
27439 message is supplied, the following is used:
27440 .code
27441 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
27442 550-kept for evaluation.
27443 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
27444 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
27445 .endd
27446 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
27447
27448 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
27449 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
27450 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27451 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27452 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
27453 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
27454 SMTP connection.
27455
27456 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
27457 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
27458 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
27459 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
27460
27461 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
27462 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
27463 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
27464 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27465 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
27466 disables such output flushing.
27467
27468 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
27469 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27470 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
27471 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27472 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
27473 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
27474
27475 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
27476 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
27477 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
27478 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
27479 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
27480 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
27481 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27482 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
27483 to be useful in production.
27484
27485 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
27486 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
27487 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
27488 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
27489 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
27490
27491 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
27492 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
27493 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
27494 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
27495 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
27496 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
27497
27498 .ilist
27499 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
27500 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
27501 verification failed"&) is sent.
27502 .next
27503 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
27504 line is output.
27505 .endlist
27506
27507 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
27508 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
27509
27510 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
27511 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
27512 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
27513 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
27514 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
27515 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
27516 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
27517
27518 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
27519 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
27520 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
27521 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27522 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27523 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
27524 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
27525 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
27526 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
27527 same SMTP connection.
27528
27529 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
27530 .cindex "message" "submission"
27531 .cindex "submission mode"
27532 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
27533 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
27534 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
27535 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
27536 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
27537 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
27538 late (the message has already been created).
27539
27540 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
27541 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
27542 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
27543 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
27544 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
27545
27546 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
27547 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
27548 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
27549 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
27550 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
27551
27552 .ilist
27553 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
27554 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
27555 .next
27556 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
27557 .next
27558 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
27559 .endlist ilist
27560
27561 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
27562 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
27563 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27564 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
27565 data is read.
27566
27567 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
27568 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
27569 .endlist vlist
27570
27571
27572 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
27573 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
27574
27575 .ilist
27576 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
27577 .next
27578 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
27579 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
27580 .next
27581 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
27582 .next
27583 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
27584 .endlist
27585
27586
27587
27588 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
27589 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
27590 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
27591 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
27592 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
27593 to an incoming message, as in this example:
27594 .code
27595 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27596 dialup.mail-abuse.org
27597 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
27598 .endd
27599 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27600 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27601 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27602 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
27603 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
27604 RCPT ACL).
27605
27606 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
27607 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
27608
27609 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
27610 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
27611 contains one or more newlines that
27612 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
27613 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
27614 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
27615
27616 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27617 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27618 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
27619 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
27620 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
27621 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
27622 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
27623 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
27624 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
27625 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
27626 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
27627
27628 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
27629 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
27630 of message headers
27631 until they are added to the
27632 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
27633 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
27634 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
27635 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
27636 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
27637 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
27638 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27639
27640 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
27641
27642 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27643 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27644 .display
27645 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27646 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27647
27648 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27649 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27650 .endd
27651 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
27652 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
27653 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
27654 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
27655 honoured.
27656
27657 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27658 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
27659 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
27660 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
27661 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
27662 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
27663 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
27664 specifications.
27665
27666 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
27667 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
27668 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
27669 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
27670 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
27671
27672 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
27673 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
27674 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
27675 to be a header name first.) For example:
27676 .code
27677 warn add_header = \
27678 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
27679 .endd
27680 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
27681 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
27682 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
27683 up in reverse order.
27684
27685 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27686 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
27687 system filter or in a router or transport.
27688
27689
27690
27691 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
27692 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
27693 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
27694 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
27695 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
27696 from an incoming message, as in this example:
27697 .code
27698 warn message = Remove internal headers
27699 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27700 .endd
27701 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27702 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27703 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27704 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
27705 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
27706 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
27707
27708 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
27709 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
27710
27711 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
27712 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
27713 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
27714 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
27715 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
27716 .code
27717 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
27718 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27719 warn message = Remove internal headers
27720 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
27721 .endd
27722 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27723 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27724 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
27725 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
27726 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
27727 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
27728 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
27729 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
27730 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
27731 would have been removed.
27732
27733 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
27734 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
27735 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
27736 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
27737 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
27738 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
27739 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
27740 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
27741 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27742
27743 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27744 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27745 .display
27746 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
27747 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27748
27749 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27750 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
27751 .endd
27752 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
27753 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
27754 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
27755 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
27756 are honoured.
27757
27758 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27759 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
27760 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
27761
27762
27763
27764
27765 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
27766 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
27767 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
27768 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
27769 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
27770 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27771
27772 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
27773 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
27774 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
27775 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
27776 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
27777 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
27778 The conditions are as follows:
27779
27780
27781 .vlist
27782 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
27783 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
27784 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
27785 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
27786 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
27787 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
27788 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
27789 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
27790 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
27791 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
27792 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
27793 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
27794
27795 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
27796 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
27797 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
27798 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
27799 The name and values are expanded separately.
27800
27801 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
27802 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
27803 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
27804 conditions are tested.
27805
27806 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
27807 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
27808 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
27809 for different local users or different local domains.
27810
27811 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27812 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
27813 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
27814 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
27815 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
27816 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
27817 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
27818 .code
27819 authenticated = *
27820 .endd
27821
27822 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
27823 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
27824 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
27825 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
27826 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
27827 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
27828 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
27829 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
27830 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
27831 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
27832 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
27833 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
27834 negative.
27835
27836 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
27837 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
27838 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27839 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27840 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
27841 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
27842 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
27843 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27844
27845 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
27846 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
27847 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27848 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
27849 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
27850
27851 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
27852 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
27853 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27854 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27855 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27856 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
27857 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
27858 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
27859 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
27860 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
27861
27862 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27863 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
27864 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
27865 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
27866 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
27867 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
27868 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
27869 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
27870 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
27871 &%domains%& test.
27872
27873 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
27874 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
27875
27876
27877 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27878 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
27879 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
27880 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
27881 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
27882 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
27883 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
27884 .code
27885 encrypted = *
27886 .endd
27887
27888
27889 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
27890 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27891 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27892 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27893 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27894 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27895 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27896 .code
27897 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27898 .endd
27899 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27900 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27901 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27902
27903 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27904 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27905 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27906 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27907 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27908 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27909
27910 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27911 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27912 .code
27913 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27914 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27915 .endd
27916 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27917 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27918 statement can then check the IP address.
27919
27920 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
27921 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27922 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27923 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27924 .code
27925 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27926 message = $host_data
27927 .endd
27928 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27929
27930 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27931 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27932 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27933 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27934 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27935 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27936 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27937 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27938 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27939 the next &%local_parts%& test.
27940
27941 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27942 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27943 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27944 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27945 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27946 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27947 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27948
27949 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27950 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27951 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27952 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27953 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27954 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27955 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27956 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27957
27958 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27959 .cindex "rate limiting"
27960 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27961 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27962
27963 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27964 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27965 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27966 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27967 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27968 recipient address against a list of recipients.
27969
27970 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27971 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27972 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27973 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27974 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27975 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27976 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27977
27978 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27979 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27980 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27981 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27982 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27983 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27984 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27985 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27986 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27987 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27988 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27989 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27990 influence the sender checking.
27991
27992 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27993 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27994
27995 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27996 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
27997 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27998 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
27999 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
28000 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
28001 .code
28002 senders = :
28003 .endd
28004 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28005 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28006
28007 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
28008 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
28009 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
28010 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28011 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
28012 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28013
28014 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
28015 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28016 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28017 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28018 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
28019 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
28020 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
28021 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
28022 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
28023 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28024
28025 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
28026 .cindex "CSA verification"
28027 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
28028 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
28029 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
28030
28031 .new
28032 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
28033 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28034 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28035 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28036 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
28037 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28038 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28039 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
28040 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
28041 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
28042
28043 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
28044 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
28045 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
28046 .wen
28047
28048 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
28049 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28050 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
28051 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
28052 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
28053 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
28054 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28055 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28056 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
28057 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
28058 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
28059 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
28060 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
28061 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
28062 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
28063
28064 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
28065 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
28066 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
28067 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
28068 .code
28069 deny senders = :
28070 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
28071 !verify = header_sender
28072 .endd
28073
28074 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
28075 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28076 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
28077 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
28078 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
28079 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28080 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28081 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
28082 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
28083 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
28084 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
28085 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
28086 appropriate.
28087
28088 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
28089 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
28090 .code
28091 To: @
28092 .endd
28093 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
28094 common as they used to be.
28095
28096 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
28097 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28098 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
28099 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
28100 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
28101 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
28102 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
28103 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
28104 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
28105 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
28106 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
28107 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
28108 independently of this condition.
28109
28110 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
28111 option), this condition is always true.
28112
28113
28114 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
28115 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
28116 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
28117 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
28118 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
28119 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
28120 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
28121 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
28122 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
28123
28124 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
28125 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
28126
28127
28128 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
28129 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28130 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
28131 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
28132 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
28133 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28134 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
28135 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
28136 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
28137 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
28138 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
28139 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
28140 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
28141 value for the child address.
28142
28143 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
28144 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28145 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
28146 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
28147 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
28148 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
28149 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
28150 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
28151 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
28152 original IP address.
28153
28154 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
28155 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
28156
28157 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
28158 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28159 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
28160 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
28161 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
28162 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
28163 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
28164 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
28165 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
28166
28167 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28168 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
28169 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
28170 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
28171 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
28172 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
28173 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
28174
28175 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
28176 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
28177 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
28178
28179 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
28180 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28181 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
28182 verified as a sender.
28183 .endlist
28184
28185
28186
28187 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
28188 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28189 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28190 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28191 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
28192 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
28193 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
28194 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
28195 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
28196 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
28197 .code
28198 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
28199 dialups.mail-abuse.org
28200 .endd
28201 the following records are looked up:
28202 .code
28203 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28204 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
28205 .endd
28206 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
28207 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
28208 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
28209 use two separate conditions:
28210 .code
28211 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28212 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28213 .endd
28214 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
28215 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
28216 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
28217 processed.
28218
28219 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
28220 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
28221 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
28222 following special items in the list:
28223 .display
28224 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
28225 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
28226 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
28227 .endd
28228 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
28229 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
28230 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
28231 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
28232 .code
28233 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
28234 .endd
28235 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
28236 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
28237 .code
28238 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28239 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
28240 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28241 .endd
28242 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
28243 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
28244 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
28245 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
28246
28247
28248
28249 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
28250 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
28251 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
28252 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
28253 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
28254 .code
28255 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
28256 .endd
28257 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
28258 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
28259 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
28260 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
28261
28262
28263
28264
28265 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
28266 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
28267 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
28268 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
28269 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
28270 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
28271 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
28272 .code
28273 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
28274 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28275 .endd
28276 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
28277 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
28278 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
28279 up by this example is
28280 .code
28281 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
28282 .endd
28283 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
28284 addresses. For example:
28285 .code
28286 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28287 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28288 .endd
28289 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
28290 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
28291
28292
28293
28294
28295 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
28296 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
28297 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
28298 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
28299 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
28300 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
28301 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
28302 either to double the separators like this:
28303 .code
28304 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
28305 .endd
28306 or to change the separator character, like this:
28307 .code
28308 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
28309 .endd
28310 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
28311 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
28312 occurs. Consider this condition:
28313 .code
28314 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
28315 .endd
28316 The DNS lookups that occur are:
28317 .code
28318 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
28319 a.domain.black.list.tld
28320 .endd
28321 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
28322 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
28323 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
28324 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
28325 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
28326 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
28327 error for a previous item.
28328
28329 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
28330 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
28331 .code
28332 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
28333 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
28334 .endd
28335 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
28336 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
28337 .code
28338 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
28339 $sender_address_domain \
28340 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
28341 see $dnslist_text.
28342 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
28343 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
28344 $sender_address_domain} }} }
28345 .endd
28346 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
28347 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
28348 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
28349 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
28350 .code
28351 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
28352 .endd
28353 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
28354 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
28355
28356 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
28357 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
28358
28359
28360
28361
28362 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
28363 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
28364 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
28365 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
28366 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
28367 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
28368 .display
28369 127.1.0.1 RBL
28370 127.1.0.2 DUL
28371 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
28372 127.1.0.4 RSS
28373 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
28374 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
28375 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
28376 .endd
28377 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
28378 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
28379 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
28380
28381
28382 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
28383 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
28384 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
28385 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
28386 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
28387 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
28388 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
28389 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
28390 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
28391 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
28392 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
28393 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
28394 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
28395 cases, for example:
28396 .code
28397 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
28398 .endd
28399 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
28400 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
28401 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
28402 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
28403 .code
28404 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
28405 .endd
28406 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
28407 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
28408
28409 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
28410 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
28411 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
28412 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
28413 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
28414 information.
28415
28416 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
28417 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
28418 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
28419 .code
28420 deny hosts = !+local_networks
28421 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
28422 at $dnslist_domain
28423 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
28424 .endd
28425
28426
28427
28428 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
28429 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
28430 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
28431 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
28432 For example,
28433 .code
28434 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
28435 .endd
28436 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
28437 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
28438 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
28439 describes how multiple records are handled.
28440
28441 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
28442 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
28443 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
28444 .code
28445 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28446 .endd
28447 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
28448 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
28449 first. For example:
28450 .code
28451 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
28452 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
28453 .endd
28454
28455 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
28456 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
28457 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
28458 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
28459 tested. For example:
28460 .code
28461 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
28462 .endd
28463 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
28464 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
28465 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
28466 .code
28467 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28468 .endd
28469 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
28470 an odd number.
28471
28472
28473
28474 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
28475 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
28476 condition. Whereas
28477 .code
28478 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28479 .endd
28480 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28481 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
28482 .code
28483 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28484 .endd
28485 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28486 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
28487 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
28488 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
28489
28490 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
28491 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
28492
28493 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
28494 previous example is precisely equivalent to
28495 .code
28496 deny dnslists = a.b.c
28497 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28498 .endd
28499 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
28500 Consider this example:
28501 .code
28502 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28503 list.dsbl.org : \
28504 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
28505 relays.ordb.org
28506 .endd
28507 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
28508 .code
28509 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28510 list.dsbl.org
28511 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
28512 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
28513 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
28514 .endd
28515 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
28516
28517
28518
28519
28520 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
28521 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
28522 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
28523 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
28524 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
28525 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
28526 .code
28527 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
28528 .endd
28529 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
28530 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
28531 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
28532 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
28533 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
28534 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
28535
28536 .ilist
28537 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
28538 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
28539 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28540 .next
28541 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
28542 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
28543 changed to:
28544 .code
28545 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
28546 .endd
28547 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28548 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
28549 .code
28550 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
28551 .endd
28552 for the condition to be true.
28553 .endlist
28554
28555 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
28556 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
28557 .ilist
28558 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
28559 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
28560 .code
28561 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
28562 .endd
28563 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28564 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28565 .next
28566 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
28567 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
28568 .code
28569 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
28570 .endd
28571 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28572 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
28573 .code
28574 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28575 .endd
28576 for the condition to be false.
28577 .endlist
28578 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
28579 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
28580
28581
28582
28583
28584 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
28585 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
28586 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
28587 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
28588 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
28589 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
28590 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
28591 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
28592 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
28593 lists.
28594
28595 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
28596 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
28597 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
28598 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
28599 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
28600 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
28601 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
28602 .code
28603 reject message = \
28604 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
28605 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
28606 dnslists = \
28607 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
28608 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28609 .endd
28610 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
28611 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
28612 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
28613 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
28614 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
28615 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
28616
28617 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
28618 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
28619 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
28620 .code
28621 reject dnslists = \
28622 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
28623 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
28624 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
28625 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28626 .endd
28627 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
28628 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
28629 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
28630
28631
28632
28633 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
28634 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
28635 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
28636 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
28637 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
28638 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
28639 .code
28640 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
28641 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28642 .endd
28643 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
28644 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
28645 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
28646 .code
28647 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
28648 .endd
28649 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
28650 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
28651
28652 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
28653 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
28654 .code
28655 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
28656 dnslists = some.list.example
28657 .endd
28658
28659 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
28660 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
28661 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
28662 .code
28663 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
28664 .endd
28665
28666 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
28667 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
28668 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
28669 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
28670 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
28671 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
28672 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
28673 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
28674 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
28675 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
28676 .display
28677 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
28678 .endd
28679 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
28680 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
28681
28682 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
28683 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
28684 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
28685 of &'p'&.
28686
28687 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
28688 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
28689 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
28690 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
28691 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
28692 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
28693 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
28694 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
28695 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
28696
28697 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
28698 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
28699 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
28700 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
28701
28702 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
28703 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
28704 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
28705 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
28706 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
28707 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
28708 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
28709 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
28710 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
28711 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
28712
28713 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
28714 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
28715 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
28716 ACL.
28717
28718 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
28719 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
28720 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
28721 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
28722 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
28723 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
28724
28725 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
28726 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
28727 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
28728 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
28729 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
28730 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
28731 the &%count=%& option.
28732
28733
28734 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
28735 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
28736 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
28737 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
28738 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
28739
28740 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
28741 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
28742 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
28743 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
28744
28745 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
28746 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
28747 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
28748 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
28749 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
28750 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
28751 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
28752
28753 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
28754 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28755 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
28756 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
28757 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
28758 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
28759 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
28760
28761 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
28762 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
28763 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
28764 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
28765 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
28766
28767 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
28768 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
28769 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
28770 multiple different commands.
28771
28772 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
28773 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
28774 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
28775 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
28776 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
28777
28778 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
28779
28780
28781 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
28782 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
28783 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
28784 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
28785 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
28786
28787 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
28788 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
28789
28790 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
28791 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
28792 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
28793 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
28794 new rate.
28795 .code
28796 acl_check_connect:
28797 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
28798 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28799 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28800 # ...
28801 acl_check_mail:
28802 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
28803 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28804 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28805 .endd
28806
28807 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
28808 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
28809 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
28810 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
28811 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
28812 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
28813 checks.
28814
28815 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
28816 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
28817 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
28818 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
28819 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
28820
28821
28822 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
28823 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
28824 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
28825 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
28826 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
28827 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
28828 rest of the ACL.
28829
28830 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
28831 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
28832 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
28833 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
28834 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
28835 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
28836 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
28837 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
28838 from getting any email through.
28839
28840 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
28841 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
28842 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
28843 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
28844 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
28845 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
28846 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
28847 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
28848 .code
28849 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
28850 .endd
28851
28852
28853 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
28854 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
28855 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
28856 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
28857 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
28858 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
28859 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
28860 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
28861 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
28862
28863 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
28864 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
28865 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
28866 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
28867 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
28868 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
28869
28870 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
28871 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
28872 rate.
28873
28874 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
28875 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
28876 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
28877 required increases with larger limits.
28878
28879 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
28880 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
28881 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
28882 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
28883 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
28884 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
28885 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
28886 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
28887 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
28888 as intended.
28889
28890
28891 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
28892 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
28893 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
28894 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
28895 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
28896 message. For example:
28897 .code
28898 # Log all senders' rates
28899 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
28900 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
28901
28902 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
28903 # at the decimal point.
28904 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
28905 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
28906 $sender_rate_limit }s
28907
28908 # Keep authenticated users under control
28909 deny authenticated = *
28910 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28911
28912 # System-wide rate limit
28913 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28914 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28915
28916 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28917 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28918 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28919 messages per $sender_rate_period
28920 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28921 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28922 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28923 .endd
28924 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28925 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28926 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28927 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28928 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28929 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28930 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28931
28932
28933
28934 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28935 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28936 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28937 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28938 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28939 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28940 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28941 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28942 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28943 .code
28944 verify = sender/callout
28945 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28946 .endd
28947 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28948 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28949 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28950 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28951 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28952 The available options are as follows:
28953
28954 .ilist
28955 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28956 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28957 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28958 .next
28959 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28960 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28961 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28962 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28963 .next
28964 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28965 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28966 .next
28967 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28968 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28969 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28970 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28971 .endlist
28972
28973 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28974 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28975 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28976 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28977 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28978 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28979 coding like this:
28980 .code
28981 warn !verify = sender
28982 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28983 .endd
28984 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28985 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28986 verification failure.
28987
28988 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28989 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28990
28991 .ilist
28992 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28993 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28994 .next
28995 &%route%&: Routing failed.
28996 .next
28997 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
28998 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
28999 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
29000 .next
29001 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
29002 .next
29003 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
29004 .endlist
29005
29006 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
29007 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
29008
29009
29010
29011
29012 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
29013 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
29014 .cindex "callout" "verification"
29015 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
29016 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
29017 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
29018 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
29019 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
29020 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
29021 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
29022 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
29023 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
29024 sender's domain.
29025
29026 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
29027 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
29028 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
29029 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
29030 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
29031 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
29032
29033 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
29034 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
29035 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
29036 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
29037 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
29038
29039 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
29040 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
29041 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
29042 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
29043 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
29044 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
29045 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
29046 supplies a host list.
29047 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
29048
29049 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
29050 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
29051 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
29052 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
29053 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
29054 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
29055 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
29056
29057 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
29058 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
29059 following SMTP commands are sent:
29060 .display
29061 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
29062 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
29063 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
29064 &`QUIT`&
29065 .endd
29066 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
29067 set to &"lmtp"&.
29068
29069 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
29070 settings.
29071
29072 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
29073 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
29074 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
29075 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
29076 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
29077 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
29078
29079 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
29080 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
29081 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
29082 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
29083 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
29084
29085 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29086 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
29087 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
29088 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
29089 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
29090
29091
29092
29093
29094 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
29095 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
29096 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
29097 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
29098 .code
29099 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
29100 .endd
29101 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
29102 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
29103 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
29104
29105
29106 .vlist
29107 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
29108 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
29109 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
29110 For example:
29111 .code
29112 verify = sender/callout=5s
29113 .endd
29114 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
29115 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
29116 the &%connect%& parameter.
29117
29118
29119 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29120 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
29121 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
29122 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
29123 .code
29124 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
29125 .endd
29126 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
29127
29128 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
29129 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
29130 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
29131 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
29132 updated in this circumstance.
29133
29134 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
29135 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
29136 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
29137 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
29138 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
29139 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
29140
29141
29142 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29143 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
29144 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
29145 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
29146 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
29147 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
29148 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
29149 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
29150 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
29151 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
29152 .code
29153 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
29154 .endd
29155 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
29156
29157
29158 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29159 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
29160 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
29161 For example:
29162 .code
29163 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
29164 .endd
29165 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
29166 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
29167 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
29168 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
29169 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
29170
29171
29172 .vitem &*no_cache*&
29173 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
29174 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
29175 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
29176
29177 .vitem &*postmaster*&
29178 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
29179 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
29180 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
29181 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
29182 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
29183 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
29184 made, until the cache record expires.
29185
29186 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29187 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
29188 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
29189 For example:
29190 .code
29191 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
29192 .endd
29193 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
29194 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
29195 .code
29196 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
29197 .endd
29198 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
29199 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
29200 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
29201 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
29202
29203
29204 .vitem &*random*&
29205 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
29206 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
29207 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
29208 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
29209 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
29210 .code
29211 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
29212 .endd
29213 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
29214 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
29215 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
29216 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
29217 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
29218
29219 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
29220 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
29221 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29222 .code
29223 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
29224 .endd
29225 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29226 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
29227 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
29228 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
29229 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
29230
29231 .vitem &*use_sender*&
29232 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29233 .code
29234 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
29235 .endd
29236 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
29237 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
29238 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
29239 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
29240 usefulness of callout caching.
29241 .endlist
29242
29243 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
29244 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
29245 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
29246 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
29247 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
29248 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
29249 these circumstances.
29250
29251 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
29252 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
29253 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
29254 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
29255 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
29256 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
29257 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
29258
29259 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
29260 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
29261 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
29262 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
29263
29264
29265
29266
29267 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
29268 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
29269 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
29270 .cindex "caching" "callout"
29271 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
29272 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
29273 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
29274 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
29275 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
29276 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
29277
29278 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
29279 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
29280 is not available.
29281
29282 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
29283 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
29284 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
29285
29286 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
29287 commands up to and including
29288 .code
29289 MAIL FROM:<>
29290 .endd
29291 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
29292 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
29293 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
29294 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
29295 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
29296 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
29297 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
29298
29299 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
29300 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
29301 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
29302 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
29303 will eventually be noticed.
29304
29305 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
29306 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
29307 behaviour will be the same.
29308
29309
29310
29311 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
29312 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
29313 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
29314 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
29315 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
29316 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
29317 you might see:
29318 .code
29319 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
29320 250 OK
29321 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
29322 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
29323 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
29324 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
29325 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
29326 550 Sender verification failed
29327 .endd
29328 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
29329 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
29330 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
29331 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
29332 example:
29333 .code
29334 verify = sender/no_details
29335 .endd
29336
29337 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
29338 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
29339 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
29340 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
29341 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
29342 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
29343 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
29344
29345 .ilist
29346 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
29347 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
29348 verification also fails.
29349 .next
29350 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
29351 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
29352 .endlist
29353
29354 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
29355 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
29356 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
29357 .code
29358 A.Wol: aw123
29359 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
29360 .endd
29361 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
29362 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
29363 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
29364 verification to succeed.
29365
29366 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
29367 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
29368 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
29369 option. For example:
29370 .code
29371 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
29372 .endd
29373 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
29374 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
29375
29376 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
29377 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
29378 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
29379 address and a report is output for each of them.
29380
29381
29382
29383 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
29384 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
29385 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
29386 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
29387 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
29388 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
29389 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
29390 .code
29391 verify = csa
29392 .endd
29393 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
29394 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
29395 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
29396 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
29397 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
29398 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
29399
29400 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
29401 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
29402 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
29403 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
29404
29405 .ilist
29406 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
29407 .next
29408 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
29409 .next
29410 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
29411 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
29412 .next
29413 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
29414 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
29415 .endlist
29416
29417 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
29418 use for the DNS query. The default is:
29419 .code
29420 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
29421 .endd
29422 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
29423 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
29424 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
29425 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
29426 meaningful to say:
29427 .code
29428 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
29429 .endd
29430 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
29431 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
29432 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
29433
29434 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
29435 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
29436 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
29437 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
29438 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
29439 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
29440 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
29441 of legitimate HELO domains.
29442
29443 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
29444 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
29445 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
29446 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
29447 lookup such as:
29448 .code
29449 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
29450 .endd
29451 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
29452 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
29453 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
29454
29455
29456
29457
29458 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
29459 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
29460 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
29461 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
29462 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
29463 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
29464 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
29465 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
29466
29467 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
29468 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
29469 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
29470 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
29471 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
29472 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
29473 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
29474
29475 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
29476 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
29477 like this:
29478 .code
29479 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
29480 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
29481 }{$value}}
29482 .endd
29483 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
29484 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
29485 use this:
29486 .code
29487 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
29488 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
29489 senders = :
29490 recipients = +batv_senders
29491
29492 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
29493 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
29494 senders = :
29495 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
29496 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
29497 !condition = $prvscheck_result
29498 .endd
29499 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
29500 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
29501 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
29502 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
29503 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
29504
29505 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
29506 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
29507 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
29508 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
29509 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
29510 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
29511 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
29512
29513 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
29514 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
29515 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
29516 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
29517 .code
29518 batv_redirect:
29519 driver = redirect
29520 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
29521 .endd
29522 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
29523 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
29524 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
29525 local addresses.
29526
29527 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
29528 can be used:
29529 .code
29530 external_smtp_batv:
29531 driver = smtp
29532 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
29533 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
29534 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
29535 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
29536 {$value}fail}}}
29537 .endd
29538 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
29539
29540
29541
29542 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
29543 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
29544 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
29545 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
29546 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
29547 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
29548 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
29549 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
29550 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
29551 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
29552
29553 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
29554 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
29555 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
29556 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
29557 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
29558 same host is fulfilling both functions,
29559 . ///
29560 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
29561 . ///
29562 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
29563 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
29564 system to arbitrary domains.
29565
29566
29567 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
29568 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
29569 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
29570 example, suppose you want to do the following:
29571
29572 .ilist
29573 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
29574 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
29575 &'my.dom2.example'&.
29576 .next
29577 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
29578 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
29579 .next
29580 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
29581 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
29582 .endlist
29583
29584
29585 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
29586 .code
29587 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
29588 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
29589 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
29590 .endd
29591 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
29592 command:
29593 .code
29594 acl_check_rcpt:
29595 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
29596 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
29597 .endd
29598 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
29599 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
29600 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
29601 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
29602 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
29603 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
29604 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29605
29606
29607
29608 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
29609 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
29610 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
29611 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
29612 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29613
29614 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
29615 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
29616 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
29617 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
29618 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
29619 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
29620 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
29621 .ecindex IIDacl
29622
29623
29624
29625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29626 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29627
29628 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
29629 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
29630 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
29631 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
29632 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
29633 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
29634 specification.
29635
29636 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
29637 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
29638 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
29639 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
29640 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
29641
29642 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
29643 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
29644 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
29645
29646 .ilist
29647 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
29648 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
29649 .next
29650 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
29651 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
29652 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
29653 .next
29654 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
29655 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
29656 .next
29657 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
29658 conditions.
29659 .next
29660 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
29661 .endlist
29662
29663 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
29664 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
29665 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
29666
29667 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
29668 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
29669 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
29670 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
29671 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
29672 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
29673
29674 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
29675 temporarily created in a file called:
29676 .display
29677 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
29678 .endd
29679 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
29680 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
29681 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
29682 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
29683 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
29684 .code
29685 control = no_mbox_unspool
29686 .endd
29687 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
29688 same directory by default.
29689
29690
29691
29692 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
29693 .cindex "virus scanning"
29694 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
29695 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
29696 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
29697 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
29698 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
29699 in memory and thus are much faster.
29700
29701
29702 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
29703 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
29704 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
29705 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
29706 .display
29707 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
29708 .endd
29709 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
29710 .code
29711 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
29712 .endd
29713 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
29714 before use.
29715 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
29716 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
29717
29718 .vlist
29719 .vitem &%aveserver%&
29720 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29721 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
29722 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
29723 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
29724 example:
29725 .code
29726 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
29727 .endd
29728
29729
29730 .vitem &%clamd%&
29731 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
29732 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
29733 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
29734 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
29735 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
29736 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
29737 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
29738 .code
29739 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
29740 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
29741 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
29742 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
29743 .endd
29744 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
29745 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
29746 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
29747 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
29748 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
29749 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
29750 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
29751
29752 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
29753 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
29754 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
29755 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
29756 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
29757 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
29758 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
29759 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
29760 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
29761 .code
29762 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
29763 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
29764 (Connection refused)
29765 .endd
29766
29767 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
29768 contributing the code for this scanner.
29769
29770 .vitem &%cmdline%&
29771 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
29772 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
29773 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
29774 type takes 3 mandatory options:
29775
29776 .olist
29777 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
29778 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
29779
29780 .next
29781 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
29782 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
29783 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
29784 the &"trigger"& expression.
29785
29786 .next
29787 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
29788 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
29789 &"name"& expression.
29790 .endlist olist
29791
29792 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
29793 .code
29794 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
29795 .endd
29796 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
29797 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
29798 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
29799 configuration setting:
29800 .code
29801 av_scanner = cmdline:\
29802 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
29803 found in file:'(.+)'
29804 .endd
29805 .vitem &%drweb%&
29806 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
29807 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
29808 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
29809 separated by white space, as in these examples:
29810 .code
29811 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
29812 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
29813 .endd
29814 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
29815 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
29816
29817 .vitem &%fsecure%&
29818 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
29819 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
29820 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
29821 .code
29822 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
29823 .endd
29824 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
29825 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
29826
29827 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
29828 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29829 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
29830 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
29831 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
29832 For example:
29833 .code
29834 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
29835 .endd
29836 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
29837
29838 .vitem &%mksd%&
29839 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
29840 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
29841 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
29842 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
29843 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
29844 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
29845 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
29846 .code
29847 av_scanner = mksd:2
29848 .endd
29849 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
29850
29851 .vitem &%sock%&
29852 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
29853 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
29854 running on the local machine.
29855 There are four options:
29856 an address (which may be an IP addres and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
29857 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
29858 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
29859 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
29860 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
29861 For example:
29862 .code
29863 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
29864 .endd
29865 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
29866 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
29867 Both regular-expressions are required.
29868
29869 .vitem &%sophie%&
29870 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
29871 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
29872 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
29873 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
29874 client communication. For example:
29875 .code
29876 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
29877 .endd
29878 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
29879 the option.
29880 .endlist
29881
29882 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
29883 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
29884 ACL.
29885
29886 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
29887 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
29888 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
29889 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
29890 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
29891 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
29892 message.
29893
29894 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
29895 use. It can then be one of
29896
29897 .ilist
29898 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
29899 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
29900 recommended usage.
29901 .next
29902 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
29903 the condition fails immediately.
29904 .next
29905 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
29906 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
29907 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
29908 .endlist
29909
29910 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
29911 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
29912 causes the ACL to defer.
29913
29914 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
29915 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
29916 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
29917 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
29918 logging data.
29919
29920 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
29921 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
29922 &%malware%& condition.
29923
29924 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
29925 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
29926
29927 Here is a very simple scanning example:
29928 .code
29929 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29930 demime = *
29931 malware = *
29932 .endd
29933 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
29934 .code
29935 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29936 demime = *
29937 malware = */defer_ok
29938 .endd
29939 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
29940 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
29941 .code
29942 av_scanner = $acl_m0
29943 .endd
29944 in the main Exim configuration.
29945 .code
29946 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29947 set acl_m0 = sophie
29948 malware = *
29949
29950 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29951 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29952 malware = *
29953 .endd
29954
29955
29956 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29957 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29958 .cindex "spam scanning"
29959 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
29960 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29961 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29962 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29963 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29964 .code
29965 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29966 .endd
29967 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29968 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29969 nicely, however.
29970
29971 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29972 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29973 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29974 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29975 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29976 .code
29977 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29978 .endd
29979 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29980 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29981 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29982 address/port pair:
29983 .code
29984 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29985 .endd
29986 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29987 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29988 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29989 option, separated with colons:
29990 .code
29991 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29992 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29993 192.168.2.12 783
29994 .endd
29995 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29996 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
29997 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
29998 condition defers.
29999
30000 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
30001 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
30002
30003 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
30004 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
30005 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
30006 expansion.
30007
30008 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
30009 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
30010 .code
30011 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30012 spam = joe
30013 .endd
30014 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
30015 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
30016 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
30017 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
30018 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
30019
30020 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
30021 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
30022 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
30023 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
30024 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
30025 are not set.
30026
30027 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
30028 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
30029 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
30030
30031
30032 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
30033 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
30034 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
30035 example:
30036 .code
30037 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30038 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
30039 spam = nobody
30040 .endd
30041
30042 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
30043 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
30044 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
30045 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
30046
30047 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
30048 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
30049 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
30050 available for use at delivery time.
30051
30052 .vlist
30053 .vitem &$spam_score$&
30054 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
30055 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
30056
30057 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
30058 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
30059 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
30060 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
30061 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
30062
30063 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
30064 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
30065 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
30066 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
30067 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
30068
30069 .vitem &$spam_report$&
30070 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
30071 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
30072 .endlist
30073
30074 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
30075 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
30076 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
30077
30078 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
30079 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
30080 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
30081 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
30082 spam condition, like this:
30083 .code
30084 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30085 spam = joe/defer_ok
30086 .endd
30087 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
30088
30089 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
30090 condition:
30091 .code
30092 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
30093 warn spam = nobody:true
30094 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
30095 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
30096
30097 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
30098 # is over threshold
30099 warn spam = nobody
30100 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
30101
30102 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
30103 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
30104 spam = nobody:true
30105 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
30106 .endd
30107
30108
30109
30110 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
30111 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
30112 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30113 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
30114 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
30115 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
30116 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
30117 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
30118 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
30119 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
30120 cases.
30121
30122 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
30123 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
30124 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
30125 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
30126 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
30127 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
30128 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
30129
30130 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
30131 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
30132 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
30133 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
30134 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
30135
30136 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
30137 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
30138 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
30139 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
30140 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
30141 syntax is:
30142 .display
30143 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
30144 .endd
30145 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
30146 the value can be:
30147
30148 .olist
30149 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
30150 .next
30151 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
30152 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
30153 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
30154 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
30155 .next
30156 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
30157 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
30158 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
30159 the full path and file name.
30160 .next
30161 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
30162 filename, and the default path is then used.
30163 .endlist
30164 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
30165 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
30166 a file with its original, proposed filename using
30167 .code
30168 decode = $mime_filename
30169 .endd
30170 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
30171 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
30172 automatically unlinked.
30173
30174 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
30175 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
30176 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
30177 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
30178 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
30179
30180 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
30181 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
30182 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
30183
30184 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
30185 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
30186 available in the MIME ACL:
30187
30188 .vlist
30189 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
30190 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
30191 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
30192 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
30193 contains the empty string.
30194
30195 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
30196 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
30197 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
30198 .code
30199 us-ascii
30200 gb2312 (Chinese)
30201 iso-8859-1
30202 .endd
30203 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
30204 case-insensitively.
30205
30206 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
30207 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
30208 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
30209 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
30210 only used for display purposes.
30211
30212 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
30213 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
30214 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
30215
30216 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
30217 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
30218 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
30219
30220 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
30221 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30222 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
30223 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
30224 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
30225
30226 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
30227 This variable contains the normalized content of the
30228 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
30229 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
30230
30231 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
30232 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
30233 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
30234 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
30235 .code
30236 text/plain
30237 text/html
30238 application/octet-stream
30239 image/jpeg
30240 audio/midi
30241 .endd
30242 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
30243 empty string.
30244
30245 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
30246 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30247 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
30248 containing the decoded data.
30249 .endlist
30250
30251 .cindex "RFC 2047"
30252 .vlist
30253 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
30254 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
30255 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
30256 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
30257 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
30258 found, this variable contains the empty string.
30259
30260 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
30261 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
30262 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
30263 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
30264
30265 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
30266 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
30267 follows:
30268
30269 .olist
30270 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
30271
30272 .next
30273 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
30274 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
30275
30276 .next
30277 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
30278 and the rest are attachments.
30279
30280 .next
30281 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
30282 .endlist olist
30283
30284 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
30285 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
30286 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
30287 .code
30288 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
30289 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
30290 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
30291 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
30292 .endd
30293 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
30294 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
30295 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
30296 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
30297 want to carry out specific actions on them.
30298
30299 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
30300 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
30301 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
30302 decoding is fully recursive.
30303
30304 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
30305 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
30306 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
30307 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
30308 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
30309 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
30310 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
30311 .endlist
30312
30313
30314
30315 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
30316 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
30317 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
30318 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
30319 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
30320
30321 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
30322 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
30323 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
30324 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
30325 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
30326
30327 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
30328 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
30329 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
30330 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
30331 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
30332 32K characters are checked.
30333
30334 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
30335 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
30336 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
30337 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
30338 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
30339 .code
30340 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
30341 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
30342 .endd
30343 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
30344 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
30345 matching regular expression.
30346
30347 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
30348 CPU-intensive.
30349
30350
30351
30352
30353 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
30354 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
30355 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30356 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
30357 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
30358 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
30359 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
30360 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
30361 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
30362 use the &%demime%& condition.
30363
30364 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
30365 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
30366 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
30367 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
30368 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
30369 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
30370
30371 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
30372 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
30373 example:
30374 .code
30375 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
30376 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
30377 .endd
30378 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
30379 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
30380 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
30381 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
30382
30383 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
30384 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
30385 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
30386
30387 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
30388
30389 .vlist
30390 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
30391 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
30392 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
30393 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
30394 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
30395 zero, no error occurred.
30396
30397 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
30398 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
30399 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
30400 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
30401 .endlist
30402
30403 .vlist
30404 .vitem &$found_extension$&
30405 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
30406 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
30407 extension it found.
30408 .endlist
30409
30410 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
30411 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
30412
30413 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
30414 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
30415 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
30416 facility:
30417 .code
30418 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
30419 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
30420 demime = *
30421 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
30422
30423 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
30424 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
30425 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
30426 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
30427
30428 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
30429 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
30430 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
30431 demime = exe:doc
30432 control = freeze
30433 .endd
30434 .ecindex IIDcosca
30435
30436
30437
30438
30439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30441
30442 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
30443 "Local scan function"
30444 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
30445 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
30446 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
30447 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
30448 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
30449
30450 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
30451 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
30452 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
30453 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
30454 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
30455
30456 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
30457 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
30458 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
30459 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
30460
30461 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
30462 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
30463 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
30464 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
30465
30466 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
30467 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
30468 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
30469 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
30470 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
30471 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
30472 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
30473 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
30474 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
30475
30476
30477
30478 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
30479 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
30480 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
30481 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
30482 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
30483 directory, so you might set
30484 .code
30485 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
30486 .endd
30487 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
30488 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
30489 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
30490 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
30491 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
30492 _src/local_scan.c_.
30493
30494 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
30495 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
30496 .code
30497 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30498 .endd
30499 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
30500
30501
30502
30503
30504 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
30505 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
30506 You must include this line near the start of your code:
30507 .code
30508 #include "local_scan.h"
30509 .endd
30510 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
30511 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
30512 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
30513 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
30514 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
30515 strings and pointers to character strings:
30516 .code
30517 #define CS (char *)
30518 #define CCS (const char *)
30519 #define CSS (char **)
30520 #define US (unsigned char *)
30521 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
30522 #define USS (unsigned char **)
30523 .endd
30524 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
30525 .code
30526 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
30527 .endd
30528 The arguments are as follows:
30529
30530 .ilist
30531 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
30532 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
30533 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
30534
30535 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
30536 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
30537 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
30538 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
30539 case this changes in some future version.
30540 .next
30541 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
30542 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
30543 .endlist
30544
30545 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
30546
30547 .vlist
30548 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
30549 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
30550 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
30551 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
30552 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
30553 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
30554
30555 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
30556 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30557 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
30558
30559 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
30560 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30561 queued without immediate delivery.
30562
30563 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
30564 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
30565 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
30566 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
30567 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
30568 used.
30569
30570 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
30571 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
30572 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
30573 problem"& is used.
30574
30575 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30576 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
30577 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
30578 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
30579 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
30580 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
30581 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30582
30583 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30584 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
30585 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30586 .endlist
30587
30588 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
30589 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
30590 &%-oe%& command line options.
30591
30592
30593
30594 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
30595 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
30596 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
30597 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
30598 want to do this, you must have the line
30599 .code
30600 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30601 .endd
30602 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
30603 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
30604 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
30605 to define them.
30606
30607 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
30608 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
30609 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
30610 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
30611 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
30612 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
30613 .code
30614 static int my_integer_option = 42;
30615 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
30616
30617 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
30618 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
30619 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
30620 };
30621
30622 int local_scan_options_count =
30623 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
30624 .endd
30625 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
30626 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
30627 .code
30628 begin local_scan
30629 my_integer = 99
30630 my_string = some string of text...
30631 .endd
30632 The available types of option data are as follows:
30633
30634 .vlist
30635 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
30636 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
30637 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
30638 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
30639 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
30640 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
30641 values.)
30642
30643 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
30644 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
30645 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
30646 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
30647
30648 .vitem &*opt_int*&
30649 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
30650 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
30651 Exim.
30652
30653 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
30654 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
30655 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
30656 printed with the suffix K or M.
30657
30658 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
30659 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
30660 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
30661 always output in octal.
30662
30663 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
30664 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
30665 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
30666
30667 .vitem &*opt_time*&
30668 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
30669 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
30670 .endlist
30671
30672 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
30673 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
30674
30675
30676
30677 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
30678 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
30679 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
30680 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
30681 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
30682 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
30683 C variables are as follows:
30684
30685 .vlist
30686 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
30687 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
30688
30689 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
30690 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
30691
30692 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
30693 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
30694 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
30695 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
30696
30697 .ilist
30698 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
30699 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
30700 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
30701
30702 .next
30703 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
30704 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
30705 of debugging bits.
30706 .endlist ilist
30707
30708 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
30709 selected, you should use code like this:
30710 .code
30711 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30712 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30713 .endd
30714 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
30715 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
30716 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
30717
30718 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
30719 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
30720 discussed below.
30721
30722 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
30723 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
30724
30725 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
30726 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
30727
30728 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
30729 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
30730 &%-bh%& command line option.
30731
30732 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
30733 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
30734 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
30735
30736 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
30737 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
30738 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
30739 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
30740
30741 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
30742 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
30743 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
30744
30745 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
30746 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
30747
30748 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
30749 The number of accepted recipients.
30750
30751 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
30752 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
30753 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
30754 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
30755 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
30756 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
30757 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
30758 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
30759 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
30760 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
30761 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
30762 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
30763
30764 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
30765 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
30766
30767 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
30768 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
30769 locally-submitted messages.
30770
30771 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
30772 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
30773 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
30774
30775 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
30776 The name of the sending host, if known.
30777
30778 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
30779 The port on the sending host.
30780
30781 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
30782 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
30783
30784 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
30785 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
30786
30787 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
30788 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
30789 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
30790 .endlist
30791
30792
30793 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
30794 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
30795 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
30796 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
30797 their type to *.
30798
30799
30800 .vlist
30801 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
30802 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
30803
30804 .vitem &*int&~type*&
30805 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
30806 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
30807 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
30808 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
30809 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
30810 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
30811
30812 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
30813 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
30814 internal newlines.
30815
30816 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
30817 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
30818 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
30819 .endlist
30820
30821
30822
30823 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
30824 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
30825
30826 .vlist
30827 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
30828 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
30829
30830 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
30831 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
30832 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
30833 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
30834
30835 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
30836 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
30837 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
30838 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
30839 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
30840 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
30841 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
30842 is NULL for all recipients.
30843 .endlist
30844
30845
30846
30847 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
30848 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
30849 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
30850 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
30851 release:
30852
30853 .vlist
30854 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
30855 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
30856
30857 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
30858 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
30859 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
30860 for the process in &%newumask%&.
30861
30862 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
30863 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
30864 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
30865 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
30866 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
30867
30868 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
30869
30870 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
30871 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
30872 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
30873 return value is as follows:
30874
30875 .ilist
30876 >= 0
30877
30878 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
30879 ending status.
30880
30881 .next
30882 < 0 and > &--256
30883
30884 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
30885 signal number.
30886
30887 .next
30888 &--256
30889
30890 The process timed out.
30891 .next
30892 &--257
30893
30894 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
30895 .endlist
30896
30897 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
30898 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
30899 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
30900 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
30901 forks a subprocess that is running
30902 .code
30903 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
30904 .endd
30905 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
30906 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
30907 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
30908 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
30909
30910 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
30911 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
30912 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
30913 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
30914
30915
30916 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
30917 *sender_authentication)*&
30918 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
30919 that it runs is:
30920 .display
30921 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
30922 .endd
30923 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
30924
30925
30926 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30927 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
30928 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
30929 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
30930 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
30931 .code
30932 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30933 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30934 .endd
30935
30936 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
30937 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
30938 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
30939 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
30940 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
30941 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
30942 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
30943 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
30944
30945 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
30946 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
30947 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
30948 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
30949 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
30950 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
30951
30952 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30953 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30954 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30955 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30956
30957 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30958 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30959 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30960 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30961 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30962 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30963 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30964 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30965 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30966 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30967 .code
30968 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30969 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30970 .endd
30971 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30972 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30973
30974
30975 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30976 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30977 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30978 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30979 match the specification, the function does nothing.
30980
30981
30982 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30983 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30984 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30985 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30986 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30987 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30988 .code
30989 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30990 .endd
30991 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30992 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30993 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30994 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30995 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
30996 zero-terminated.
30997
30998 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
30999 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
31000 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
31001 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
31002 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
31003 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
31004 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
31005 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
31006
31007 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
31008 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
31009 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
31010 .display
31011 &`OK `& match succeeded
31012 &`FAIL `& match failed
31013 &`DEFER `& match deferred
31014 .endd
31015 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
31016 inability to contact a database.
31017
31018 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31019 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
31020 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
31021 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
31022 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
31023
31024 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31025 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
31026 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
31027 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
31028 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
31029
31030 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
31031 uschar&~*list)*&"
31032 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
31033 expected to be
31034 .code
31035 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
31036 .endd
31037 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
31038 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
31039 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
31040 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
31041 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
31042 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
31043 failed.
31044
31045 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
31046 *format,&~...)*&"
31047 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
31048 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
31049 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
31050 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
31051 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
31052 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
31053
31054
31055 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
31056 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
31057 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
31058 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
31059
31060 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
31061 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
31062 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
31063 value afterwards. For example:
31064 .code
31065 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
31066 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
31067 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
31068 .endd
31069
31070 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
31071 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
31072 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
31073 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
31074 address.
31075 .endlist
31076
31077
31078 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31079 .vlist
31080 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
31081 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
31082 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
31083 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
31084 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
31085 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
31086 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
31087 binary string is returned with an error message.
31088
31089 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
31090 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
31091 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
31092
31093 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
31094 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
31095 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
31096 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
31097 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
31098
31099 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
31100 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
31101 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
31102
31103 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
31104 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
31105 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
31106 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
31107 with translation.
31108
31109
31110 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
31111 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
31112 below.
31113
31114 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
31115 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
31116 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
31117 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
31118 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
31119 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
31120 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
31121 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
31122 is involved.
31123
31124 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
31125 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
31126
31127 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
31128 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
31129 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
31130 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
31131 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
31132 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
31133 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
31134 .code
31135 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
31136 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
31137 .endd
31138 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
31139 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
31140 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
31141 multiple output lines.
31142
31143 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
31144 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
31145 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
31146 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
31147 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
31148 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
31149 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
31150 is an error.
31151
31152 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
31153 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
31154 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
31155 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31156
31157 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
31158 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
31159 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31160
31161 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
31162 See below.
31163
31164 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
31165 See below.
31166
31167 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
31168 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
31169 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
31170 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
31171 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
31172 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
31173 more discussion.
31174 .endlist
31175
31176
31177
31178 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
31179 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
31180 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
31181 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
31182 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
31183 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
31184 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
31185 terminates.
31186
31187 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
31188 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
31189 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
31190 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
31191
31192 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
31193 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
31194 .code
31195 store_pool = POOL_PERM
31196 .endd
31197 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
31198 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
31199 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
31200 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
31201
31202 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
31203 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
31204 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
31205 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
31206 &%store_pool%&.
31207 .ecindex IIDlosca
31208
31209
31210
31211
31212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31214
31215 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
31216 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
31217 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
31218 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
31219 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
31220 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
31221 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
31222 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
31223
31224 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
31225 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
31226 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
31227 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
31228 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
31229
31230 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
31231 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
31232 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
31233 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
31234 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
31235 prevent it happening on retries.
31236
31237 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31238 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31239 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
31240 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
31241 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
31242 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
31243 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
31244 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
31245
31246
31247 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
31248 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
31249 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
31250 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
31251 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
31252 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
31253 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
31254 .code
31255 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
31256 system_filter_user = exim
31257 .endd
31258 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
31259 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
31260 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
31261 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
31262 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
31263 by the &%reply%& command.
31264
31265
31266 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
31267 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
31268 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
31269 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
31270
31271 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
31272 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
31273
31274
31275
31276 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
31277 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
31278 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
31279 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
31280 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
31281 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
31282 they cause errors.
31283
31284 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
31285 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
31286 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
31287 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
31288 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
31289 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
31290 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
31291
31292 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
31293 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
31294 succeed, it will not be tried again.
31295 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
31296 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
31297
31298 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
31299 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
31300 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
31301 to which users' filter files can refer.
31302
31303
31304
31305 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
31306 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
31307 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
31308 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
31309 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
31310
31311
31312
31313 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
31314 .cindex "freezing messages"
31315 .cindex "message" "freezing"
31316 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
31317 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
31318 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
31319 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
31320 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
31321 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
31322 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
31323 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
31324 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
31325 .code
31326 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
31327 .endd
31328 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
31329
31330 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
31331 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
31332 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
31333 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
31334 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
31335 run.
31336
31337 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
31338 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
31339 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
31340 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
31341
31342 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
31343 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
31344 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
31345 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
31346 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
31347 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
31348 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
31349 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
31350 message. For example:
31351 .code
31352 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
31353 because it contains attachments that we are \
31354 not prepared to receive."
31355 .endd
31356
31357 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
31358 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
31359 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
31360 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
31361 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
31362 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
31363 use, for example
31364 .code
31365 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
31366 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
31367 .endd
31368 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
31369 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
31370 generated by the filter.
31371
31372 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
31373 &%defer%&,
31374 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
31375 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
31376 as
31377 .code
31378 mail ...
31379 freeze
31380 .endd
31381 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
31382 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
31383 take place.
31384
31385
31386
31387 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
31388 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
31389 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
31390 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
31391 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
31392 .code
31393 headers add <string>
31394 headers remove <string>
31395 .endd
31396 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
31397 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
31398 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
31399 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
31400 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
31401
31402 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
31403 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
31404 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
31405 example:
31406 .code
31407 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
31408 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
31409 X-header-2: ...."
31410 .endd
31411 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
31412 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
31413 space after input continuations is ignored.
31414
31415 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
31416 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
31417 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
31418 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
31419 header with the same name, they are all removed.
31420
31421 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
31422 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
31423 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
31424 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
31425 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
31426 used for all recipients of the message.
31427
31428 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
31429 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
31430 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
31431 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
31432 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
31433 until the message is actually being written (see section
31434 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
31435
31436 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
31437 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
31438 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
31439 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
31440 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
31441 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
31442 modified more than once.
31443
31444 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
31445 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
31446 For example:
31447 .code
31448 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
31449 headers remove "Subject"
31450 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
31451 headers remove "Old-Subject"
31452 .endd
31453
31454
31455
31456 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
31457 .cindex "envelope sender"
31458 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
31459 .code
31460 errors_to <some address>
31461 .endd
31462 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
31463 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
31464 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
31465 might use
31466 .code
31467 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
31468 .endd
31469 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
31470 address if its delivery failed.
31471
31472
31473
31474 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
31475 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31476 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31477 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
31478 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
31479 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
31480 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
31481 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
31482 which implements such a filter:
31483 .code
31484 central_filter:
31485 check_local_user
31486 driver = redirect
31487 domains = +local_domains
31488 file = /central/filters/$local_part
31489 no_verify
31490 allow_filter
31491 allow_freeze
31492 .endd
31493 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
31494 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
31495 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
31496 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
31497
31498 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
31499 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
31500 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
31501 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
31502 normal way.
31503 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
31504 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
31505 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
31506
31507
31508
31509
31510
31511
31512 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31513 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31514
31515 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
31516 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
31517 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
31518 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
31519 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
31520 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
31521 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
31522 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
31523
31524 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
31525 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
31526 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
31527 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
31528 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
31529
31530 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
31531 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
31532 loopback interface specially in any way.
31533
31534 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
31535 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
31536
31537
31538
31539
31540 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
31541 .cindex "message" "submission"
31542 .cindex "submission mode"
31543 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
31544 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
31545 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
31546 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
31547 .code
31548 control = submission
31549 .endd
31550 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
31551 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
31552 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
31553 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
31554 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
31555 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
31556 .code
31557 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
31558 control = submission
31559 .endd
31560 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
31561 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
31562 is used to separate options. For example:
31563 .code
31564 control = submission/sender_retain
31565 .endd
31566 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
31567 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
31568 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
31569 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
31570 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
31571 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
31572 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
31573
31574 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
31575 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
31576 example:
31577 .code
31578 control = submission/domain=some.domain
31579 .endd
31580 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
31581 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
31582 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
31583 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
31584 .code
31585 accept authenticated = *
31586 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
31587 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
31588 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
31589 .endd
31590 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
31591 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
31592 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
31593 .code
31594 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
31595 .endd
31596 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
31597 line would be:
31598 .code
31599 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
31600 .endd
31601 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
31602 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
31603 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
31604 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
31605
31606 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
31607 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
31608 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
31609 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
31610 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
31611 spoof another's address.
31612
31613 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
31614 .cindex "line endings"
31615 .cindex "carriage return"
31616 .cindex "linefeed"
31617 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
31618 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
31619 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
31620 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
31621 use CRLF or just CR.
31622
31623 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
31624 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
31625 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
31626 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
31627 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
31628 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
31629 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
31630 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
31631 follows:
31632
31633 .ilist
31634 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
31635 .next
31636 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
31637 is ignored.
31638 .next
31639 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
31640 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
31641 terminator.
31642 .next
31643 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
31644 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
31645 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
31646 people trying to play silly games.
31647 .next
31648 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
31649 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
31650 line.
31651 .endlist
31652
31653
31654
31655
31656
31657 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
31658 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
31659 .cindex "address" "qualification"
31660 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
31661 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
31662 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
31663 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
31664 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
31665
31666 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
31667 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
31668 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
31669 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
31670 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
31671
31672 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
31673 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
31674 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
31675 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
31676 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
31677 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
31678 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
31679 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
31680
31681
31682
31683
31684 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
31685 .cindex "&""From""& line"
31686 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
31687 .cindex "sender" "address"
31688 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
31689 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
31690 .cindex "envelope sender"
31691 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31692 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
31693 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
31694 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
31695 .code
31696 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
31697 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
31698 .endd
31699 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
31700 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
31701 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
31702 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
31703 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
31704 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
31705 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
31706 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
31707 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
31708
31709 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
31710 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
31711 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
31712 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
31713 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
31714 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
31715 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
31716
31717 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
31718 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
31719 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
31720
31721 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
31722 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
31723 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
31724 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
31725
31726
31727
31728 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
31729 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
31730 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
31731 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
31732 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
31733 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
31734 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
31735
31736 .blockquote
31737 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
31738 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
31739 .endblockquote
31740
31741 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
31742 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
31743 follows:
31744
31745 .ilist
31746 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
31747 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
31748 .next
31749 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
31750 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
31751 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
31752 .next
31753 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
31754 also removed.
31755 .next
31756 For a locally-submitted message,
31757 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
31758 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
31759 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
31760 included in log lines in this case.
31761 .next
31762 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
31763 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
31764 .endlist
31765
31766
31767
31768
31769 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
31770 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
31771 includes the header line:
31772 .code
31773 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
31774 .endd
31775
31776 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
31777 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
31778 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
31779 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
31780 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
31781 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
31782
31783
31784 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
31785 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
31786 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
31787 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
31788 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
31789
31790 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
31791 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
31792 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
31793 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
31794 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
31795 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
31796 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
31797 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
31798 messages.
31799
31800
31801 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
31802 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
31803 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
31804 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
31805 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
31806 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
31807 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
31808 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
31809 messages.
31810
31811
31812 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
31813 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
31814 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31815 .cindex "message" "submission"
31816 .cindex "submission mode"
31817 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
31818 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
31819
31820 .ilist
31821 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
31822 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
31823 .next
31824 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31825 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
31826 .olist
31827 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31828 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31829 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31830 .next
31831 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
31832 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31833 .next
31834 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31835 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31836 .endlist
31837 .endlist
31838
31839 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
31840
31841 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
31842 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
31843 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
31844 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31845 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
31846 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
31847 &%qualify_domain%&.
31848
31849 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
31850 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
31851 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
31852 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31853
31854
31855 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
31856 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
31857 .cindex "message" "submission"
31858 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
31859 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
31860 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
31861 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
31862 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
31863 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
31864 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
31865 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
31866 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
31867 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
31868
31869
31870 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
31871 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
31872 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
31873 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
31874 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
31875
31876 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
31877 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
31878 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
31879 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
31880
31881 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
31882 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
31883 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
31884
31885
31886 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
31887 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
31888 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
31889 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
31890 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
31891 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
31892 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
31893 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
31894 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
31895 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
31896 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
31897
31898
31899
31900 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
31901 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
31902 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
31903 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
31904 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
31905 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
31906 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
31907 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
31908
31909
31910
31911 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
31912 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
31913 .cindex "message" "submission"
31914 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
31915 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
31916 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
31917 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31918 control setting.
31919
31920 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
31921 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31922 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
31923 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
31924 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
31925 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
31926 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
31927 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
31928 line is added to the message.
31929
31930 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
31931 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
31932 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
31933 options true at the same time.
31934
31935 .cindex "submission mode"
31936 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
31937 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
31938 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
31939 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
31940
31941 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31942 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
31943 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
31944 created as follows:
31945
31946 .ilist
31947 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31948 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31949 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31950 .next
31951 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31952 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31953 .next
31954 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31955 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31956 .endlist
31957
31958 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31959 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31960 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31961 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31962
31963 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31964 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31965 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31966 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31967
31968
31969
31970 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31971 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31972 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31973 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31974 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31975 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31976 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31977 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31978 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31979
31980 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31981 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31982 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31983 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31984 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31985 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31986
31987 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31988 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31989 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31990
31991 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
31992 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31993 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31994 .code
31995 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31996 X-added-second: another added header line
31997 .endd
31998 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
31999
32000 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
32001 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
32002 Each header-line is separately expanded.
32003
32004 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
32005 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
32006 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
32007 not part of the names. For example:
32008 .code
32009 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
32010 .endd
32011
32012 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
32013 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
32014 Each item is separately expanded.
32015
32016 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
32017 items are expanded at routing time,
32018 and then associated with all addresses that are
32019 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
32020 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
32021 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
32022
32023 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
32024 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
32025 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
32026 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
32027
32028 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
32029 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
32030 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
32031 requirements.
32032
32033 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
32034 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
32035 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
32036 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
32037 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
32038 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
32039 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
32040
32041 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
32042 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
32043 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
32044 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
32045
32046 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
32047 the following consequences:
32048
32049 .ilist
32050 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
32051 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
32052 to it, at all times.
32053 .next
32054 Header lines that are added by a router's
32055 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
32056 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
32057 .next
32058 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
32059 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
32060 .next
32061 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
32062 a later router or by a transport.
32063 .next
32064 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
32065 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
32066 .code
32067 headers_remove = subject
32068 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
32069 .endd
32070 .endlist
32071
32072 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
32073 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
32074
32075
32076
32077
32078
32079 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
32080 .cindex "address" "constructed"
32081 .cindex "constructed address"
32082 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
32083 the form
32084 .display
32085 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
32086 .endd
32087 For example:
32088 .code
32089 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
32090 .endd
32091 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
32092 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
32093 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
32094 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
32095 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
32096 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
32097 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
32098 there is no password file entry.
32099
32100 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32101 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
32102 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
32103 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
32104 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
32105 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
32106 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
32107 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
32108 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
32109
32110
32111
32112 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
32113 .cindex "case of local parts"
32114 .cindex "local part" "case of"
32115 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
32116 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
32117 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
32118 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
32119 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
32120 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
32121 router option.
32122
32123 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
32124 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
32125 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
32126 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
32127 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
32128 .code
32129 correct_case:
32130 driver = redirect
32131 domains = +local_domains
32132 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
32133 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
32134 @$domain
32135 .endd
32136 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
32137 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
32138 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
32139 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
32140 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
32141
32142
32143
32144 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
32145 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
32146 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
32147 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
32148 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
32149 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
32150 empty components for compatibility.
32151
32152
32153
32154 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
32155 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
32156 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
32157 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
32158 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
32159 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
32160
32161 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
32162 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
32163 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
32164 example, a header such as
32165 .code
32166 To: hare@teaparty
32167 .endd
32168 might get rewritten as
32169 .code
32170 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
32171 .endd
32172 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
32173 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
32174 been routed.
32175
32176 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
32177 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
32178 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
32179 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
32180 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
32181 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
32182 .ecindex IIDmesproc
32183
32184
32185
32186 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32187 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32188
32189 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
32190 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
32191 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
32192 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
32193 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
32194 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
32195 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
32196
32197 .ilist
32198 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
32199 .next
32200 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
32201 .next
32202 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
32203 .endlist
32204
32205 For mail delivery, the following are available:
32206
32207 .ilist
32208 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
32209 .next
32210 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
32211 &"lmtp"&);
32212 .next
32213 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
32214 transport);
32215 .next
32216 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
32217 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
32218 .endlist
32219
32220 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
32221 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
32222 used to contain the envelope information.
32223
32224
32225
32226 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
32227 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
32228 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
32229 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
32230 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
32231 .cindex "EHLO"
32232 .cindex "HELO"
32233 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32234 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
32235 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
32236 processing is the same in both cases.
32237
32238 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
32239 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
32240 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
32241 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
32242 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
32243 .cindex "transport" "filter"
32244 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
32245 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
32246 suppressed.
32247
32248 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
32249 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
32250 required for the transaction.
32251
32252 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
32253 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
32254 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
32255 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
32256 is called for verification.
32257
32258 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
32259 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
32260 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
32261
32262 .cindex "carriage return"
32263 .cindex "linefeed"
32264 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32265 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
32266 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32267 line terminator.
32268
32269 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
32270 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
32271 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
32272 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
32273 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
32274 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
32275 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
32276 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
32277 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
32278
32279 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
32280 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
32281 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
32282 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
32283
32284 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
32285 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
32286 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
32287 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
32288
32289 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32290 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
32291 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
32292 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
32293 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
32294 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
32295 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
32296 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
32297 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
32298 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
32299
32300 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
32301 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
32302
32303 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32304 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
32305 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
32306 square bracket of the IP address.
32307
32308
32309
32310
32311 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
32312 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
32313 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
32314 .cindex "host" "error"
32315 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
32316 message errors, and recipient errors.
32317
32318 .vlist
32319 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
32320 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
32321 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
32322
32323 .ilist
32324 Connection refused or timed out,
32325 .next
32326 Any error response code on connection,
32327 .next
32328 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
32329 .next
32330 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
32331 .next
32332 I/O errors at any time,
32333 .next
32334 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
32335 the &"."& at the end of the data.
32336 .endlist ilist
32337
32338 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
32339 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
32340 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
32341 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
32342 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
32343 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
32344 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
32345 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
32346
32347 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
32348 .cindex "message" "error"
32349 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
32350 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
32351 message errors are:
32352
32353 .ilist
32354 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
32355 the data,
32356 .next
32357 Timeout after MAIL,
32358 .next
32359 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
32360 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
32361 connection at any other time.
32362 .endlist ilist
32363
32364 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
32365 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
32366 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
32367 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
32368 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
32369 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
32370 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
32371 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
32372 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
32373 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
32374
32375 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
32376 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
32377 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
32378 response to MAIL.
32379
32380 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
32381 .cindex "recipient" "error"
32382 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
32383 recipient errors are:
32384
32385 .ilist
32386 Any error response to RCPT,
32387 .next
32388 Timeout after RCPT.
32389 .endlist
32390
32391 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
32392 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
32393 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
32394 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
32395 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
32396 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
32397 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
32398 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
32399 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
32400 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
32401 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
32402 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
32403 the retry clock is reset.
32404
32405 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
32406 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
32407 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
32408 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
32409 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
32410 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
32411 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
32412 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
32413 recipient's retry time.
32414 .endlist
32415
32416 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
32417 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
32418 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
32419 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
32420 until the next delivery attempt.
32421
32422 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
32423 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
32424 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
32425 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
32426 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
32427 is created.
32428
32429 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
32430 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
32431 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
32432 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
32433 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
32434 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
32435 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
32436
32437 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
32438 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
32439 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
32440 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
32441 then to be treated as a host error.
32442
32443 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
32444 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
32445 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
32446 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
32447 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
32448
32449
32450
32451
32452 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
32453 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
32454 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
32455 .cindex "inetd"
32456 .cindex "daemon"
32457 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
32458 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
32459 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
32460 .code
32461 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
32462 .endd
32463 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
32464 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
32465 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
32466 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
32467 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
32468 stream and exits with an error code.
32469
32470 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
32471 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
32472 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
32473 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
32474
32475 .cindex "carriage return"
32476 .cindex "linefeed"
32477 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32478 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
32479 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32480 line terminator.
32481 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
32482 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
32483 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
32484
32485 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
32486 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
32487 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
32488 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
32489 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
32490 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
32491 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
32492 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
32493
32494 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32495 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
32496 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
32497 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
32498 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
32499 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
32500 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
32501 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
32502 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
32503
32504 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
32505 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
32506 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
32507
32508 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
32509 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
32510 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
32511 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
32512 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
32513
32514 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
32515 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
32516 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
32517 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
32518 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
32519 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
32520 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
32521
32522 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
32523 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
32524 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
32525 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
32526 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
32527
32528 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
32529 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
32530 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
32531 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
32532 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
32533 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
32534 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
32535 a delivery process.
32536
32537 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
32538 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
32539 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
32540 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
32541 however, available with &'inetd'&.
32542
32543 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
32544 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
32545 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
32546 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
32547
32548 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
32549 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
32550 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
32551
32552
32553
32554 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
32555 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
32556 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
32557 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
32558 the error response to the last command. The default value for
32559 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
32560 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
32561 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
32562
32563
32564 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
32565 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
32566 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
32567 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
32568 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
32569 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
32570 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
32571 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
32572 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
32573 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
32574 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
32575
32576
32577
32578 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
32579 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
32580 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
32581 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
32582 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
32583 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
32584 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
32585 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
32586
32587 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
32588 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
32589 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
32590 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
32591 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
32592 counted.
32593
32594 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
32595 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
32596 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
32597
32598 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
32599 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
32600 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
32601 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
32602 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
32603
32604
32605
32606
32607 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
32608 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
32609 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
32610 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
32611 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32612
32613 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
32614 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
32615 called with the &%-bv%& option.
32616
32617 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
32618 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
32619 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
32620 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
32621 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
32622 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
32623 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
32624 RCPT failures.
32625
32626
32627
32628 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
32629 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
32630 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
32631 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
32632 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
32633 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
32634 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32635
32636 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
32637 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
32638 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
32639 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
32640 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
32641 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
32642 argument. For example,
32643 .code
32644 ETRN #brigadoon
32645 .endd
32646 runs the command
32647 .code
32648 exim -R brigadoon
32649 .endd
32650 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
32651 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
32652 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
32653 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
32654 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
32655
32656 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
32657 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
32658 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
32659 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
32660 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
32661 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
32662 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
32663 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
32664
32665 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
32666 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
32667 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
32668 whatever the form of its argument. For
32669 example:
32670 .code
32671 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
32672 $sender_host_address
32673 .endd
32674 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32675 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
32676 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
32677 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
32678 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
32679 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
32680 for it to change them before running the command.
32681
32682
32683
32684 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
32685 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
32686 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
32687 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
32688 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
32689 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
32690 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
32691 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
32692 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
32693 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
32694 runs for RCPT commands:
32695 .code
32696 accept hosts = :
32697 .endd
32698 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
32699
32700
32701
32702 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
32703 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
32704 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
32705 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
32706 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
32707 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
32708 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
32709 envelope along with the message.
32710
32711 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
32712 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
32713 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
32714 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
32715 can be used to specify it.
32716
32717 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
32718 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
32719 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
32720 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
32721 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
32722
32723 .vindex "&$host$&"
32724 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
32725 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
32726 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
32727 router:
32728 .code
32729 begin routers
32730 route_append:
32731 driver = manualroute
32732 transport = smtp_appendfile
32733 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
32734
32735 begin transports
32736 smtp_appendfile:
32737 driver = appendfile
32738 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
32739 batch_max = 1000
32740 use_bsmtp
32741 user = exim
32742 .endd
32743 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
32744 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
32745 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
32746
32747
32748
32749 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
32750 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
32751 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
32752 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
32753 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
32754 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
32755 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
32756 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
32757 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
32758 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
32759
32760 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
32761 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
32762
32763 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
32764 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
32765 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
32766 make some use of automatically, for example:
32767 .code
32768 554 Unexpected end of file
32769 Transaction started in line 10
32770 Error detected in line 14
32771 .endd
32772 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
32773 file, for example:
32774 .code
32775 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
32776 The error message was:
32777
32778 501 '>' missing at end of address
32779
32780 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
32781 The error was detected in line 12.
32782 The SMTP command at fault was:
32783
32784 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
32785
32786 1 previous message was successfully processed.
32787 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
32788 .endd
32789 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
32790 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
32791 accepted.
32792 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
32793 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
32794
32795
32796
32797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32799
32800 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
32801 "Customizing messages"
32802 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
32803 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
32804 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
32805 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
32806 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
32807
32808 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
32809 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
32810 option. Exim also adds the line
32811 .code
32812 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
32813 .endd
32814 to all warning and bounce messages,
32815
32816
32817 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
32818 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
32819 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
32820 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
32821 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
32822 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
32823 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
32824
32825 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
32826 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
32827 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
32828 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
32829 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
32830 item.
32831
32832 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
32833 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
32834 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
32835 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
32836 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
32837 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
32838 option, rounded to a whole number.
32839
32840 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
32841
32842 .ilist
32843 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32844 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32845 .next
32846 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
32847 failing addresses with their error messages.
32848 .next
32849 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
32850 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
32851 .next
32852 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
32853 as part of the error report.
32854 .next
32855 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
32856 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
32857 .next
32858 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
32859 .endlist
32860
32861 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
32862 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
32863 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
32864 .code
32865 Subject: Mail delivery failed
32866 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32867 {: returning message to sender}}
32868 ****
32869 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32870
32871 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32872 {that you sent }{sent by
32873
32874 <$sender_address>
32875
32876 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
32877 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
32878 ****
32879 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
32880 ****
32881 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
32882 ------
32883 ****
32884 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
32885 only the first
32886 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
32887 ****
32888 .endd
32889 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
32890 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
32891 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
32892 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
32893 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
32894 text sections:
32895
32896 .ilist
32897 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32898 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32899 .next
32900 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
32901 the delayed addresses.
32902 .next
32903 The third item then ends the message.
32904 .endlist
32905
32906 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
32907 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
32908 .code
32909 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
32910 $warn_message_delay
32911 ****
32912 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32913
32914 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
32915 {that you sent }{sent by
32916
32917 <$sender_address>
32918
32919 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
32920 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
32921
32922 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
32923 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
32924 The date of the message is: $h_date
32925
32926 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
32927 ****
32928 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
32929 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
32930 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
32931 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
32932 the message will be returned to you.
32933 .endd
32934 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
32935 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
32936 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
32937 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
32938 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
32939 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
32940 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
32941 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
32942 handled them.
32943
32944
32945
32946
32947 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32948 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32949
32950 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
32951 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
32952 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
32953
32954
32955
32956 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
32957 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
32958 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
32959 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
32960 routing explicitly:
32961 .code
32962 send_to_smart_host:
32963 driver = manualroute
32964 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32965 transport = remote_smtp
32966 .endd
32967 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32968 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32969 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32970 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32971 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32972
32973
32974
32975
32976 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32977 .cindex "mailing lists"
32978 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32979 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32980 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32981
32982 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32983 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32984 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32985 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32986 .code
32987 lists:
32988 driver = redirect
32989 domains = lists.example
32990 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32991 forbid_pipe
32992 forbid_file
32993 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32994 no_more
32995 .endd
32996 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
32997 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
32998 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
32999 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
33000
33001 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
33002 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
33003 a mailing list.
33004
33005 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
33006 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
33007 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
33008 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
33009 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
33010
33011 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
33012 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
33013 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
33014 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
33015 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
33016 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
33017 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
33018 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
33019 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
33020
33021
33022
33023 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
33024 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
33025 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
33026 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
33027 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
33028 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
33029 addresses are not rigorously checked.
33030
33031 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
33032 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
33033 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
33034 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
33035 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
33036
33037
33038
33039 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
33040 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
33041 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
33042 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
33043 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
33044 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
33045 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
33046 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
33047 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
33048 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
33049
33050 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
33051 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
33052 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
33053 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
33054 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
33055 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
33056 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
33057 pre-existing messages.
33058
33059 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
33060 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
33061 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
33062 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
33063 one level of expansion anyway.
33064
33065
33066
33067 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
33068 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
33069 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
33070 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
33071 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
33072 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
33073
33074 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
33075 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
33076 .code
33077 lists_request:
33078 driver = redirect
33079 domains = lists.example
33080 local_part_suffix = -request
33081 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
33082 no_more
33083
33084 lists_post:
33085 driver = redirect
33086 domains = lists.example
33087 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
33088 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
33089 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
33090 forbid_pipe
33091 forbid_file
33092 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
33093 no_more
33094
33095 lists_closed:
33096 driver = redirect
33097 domains = lists.example
33098 allow_fail
33099 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
33100 .endd
33101 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
33102 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
33103 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
33104 mailing list.
33105
33106 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
33107 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
33108 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
33109 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
33110 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
33111 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
33112 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
33113 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
33114 &"unrouteable address"& error.
33115
33116 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
33117 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
33118 the address, giving a suitable error message.
33119
33120
33121
33122
33123 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
33124 .cindex "VERP"
33125 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
33126 .cindex "envelope sender"
33127 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
33128 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
33129 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
33130 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
33131 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
33132 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
33133
33134 .oindex &%errors_to%&
33135 .oindex &%return_path%&
33136 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
33137 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
33138 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
33139 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
33140 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
33141 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
33142 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
33143 .code
33144 verp_smtp:
33145 driver = smtp
33146 max_rcpt = 1
33147 return_path = \
33148 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33149 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33150 .endd
33151 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
33152 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
33153 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
33154 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
33155 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
33156 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
33157 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
33158 rewritten as
33159 .code
33160 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
33161 .endd
33162 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33163 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
33164 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
33165 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
33166 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
33167 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
33168
33169 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
33170 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
33171 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
33172 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
33173 .code
33174 dnslookup:
33175 driver = dnslookup
33176 domains = ! +local_domains
33177 transport = \
33178 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33179 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
33180 no_more
33181 .endd
33182 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
33183 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
33184 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
33185 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
33186 address.
33187
33188 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
33189 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
33190 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
33191 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
33192 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
33193 .code
33194 verp_dnslookup:
33195 driver = dnslookup
33196 domains = ! +local_domains
33197 transport = remote_smtp
33198 errors_to = \
33199 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
33200 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33201 no_more
33202 .endd
33203 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
33204 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
33205 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
33206 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
33207 them.
33208
33209 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
33210 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
33211 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
33212 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
33213 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
33214 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
33215 used).
33216
33217
33218
33219
33220
33221
33222 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
33223 .cindex "virtual domains"
33224 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
33225 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
33226 meanings:
33227
33228 .ilist
33229 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
33230 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
33231 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
33232 .next
33233 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
33234 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
33235 have login accounts on that host.
33236 .endlist
33237
33238 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
33239 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
33240 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
33241 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
33242 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
33243 to a router of this form:
33244 .code
33245 virtual:
33246 driver = redirect
33247 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
33248 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
33249 no_more
33250 .endd
33251 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
33252 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
33253 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
33254 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
33255 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
33256 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
33257
33258 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
33259 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
33260 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
33261 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
33262
33263 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
33264 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
33265 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
33266 .code
33267 my_domains:
33268 driver = accept
33269 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
33270 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
33271 transport = my_mailboxes
33272 .endd
33273 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
33274 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
33275 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
33276 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
33277 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
33278 follows:
33279 .code
33280 my_mailboxes:
33281 driver = appendfile
33282 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
33283 user = mail
33284 .endd
33285 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
33286 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
33287
33288 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
33289 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
33290 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
33291 information about the domains.
33292
33293
33294
33295 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
33296 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
33297 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
33298 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
33299 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
33300 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
33301 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
33302 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
33303 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
33304 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
33305 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
33306 example, consider this router:
33307 .code
33308 userforward:
33309 driver = redirect
33310 check_local_user
33311 file = $home/.forward
33312 local_part_suffix = -*
33313 local_part_suffix_optional
33314 allow_filter
33315 .endd
33316 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
33317 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
33318 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
33319 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
33320 .code
33321 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
33322 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
33323 endif
33324 .endd
33325 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
33326 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
33327 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
33328 control over which suffixes are valid.
33329
33330 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
33331 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
33332 another MTA:
33333 .code
33334 userforward:
33335 driver = redirect
33336 check_local_user
33337 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
33338 local_part_suffix = -*
33339 local_part_suffix_optional
33340 allow_filter
33341 .endd
33342 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
33343 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
33344 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
33345 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
33346 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
33347
33348
33349
33350 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
33351 .cindex "vacation processing"
33352 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
33353 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
33354 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
33355 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
33356 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
33357
33358 .ilist
33359 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
33360 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
33361 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
33362 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
33363 .code
33364 spqr, vacation-spqr
33365 .endd
33366 .next
33367 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
33368 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
33369 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
33370 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
33371 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
33372 message.
33373 .endlist
33374
33375 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
33376 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
33377
33378
33379
33380 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
33381 .cindex "message" "copying every"
33382 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
33383 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
33384 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
33385 each day's messages.
33386
33387 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
33388 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
33389 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
33390 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
33391
33392
33393
33394 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
33395 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
33396 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
33397 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
33398 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
33399 permanently connected.
33400
33401 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
33402 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
33403 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
33404
33405
33406 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
33407 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
33408 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
33409 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
33410 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
33411 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
33412 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
33413 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
33414
33415 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
33416 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
33417 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
33418 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
33419 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
33420 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
33421 if required.
33422
33423 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
33424 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
33425 intermittent host. For example:
33426 .code
33427 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
33428 .endd
33429 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
33430 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
33431 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
33432 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
33433 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
33434 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
33435 immediately.
33436
33437 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
33438 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
33439 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
33440 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
33441 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
33442 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
33443 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
33444
33445
33446
33447 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
33448 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
33449 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
33450 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
33451 delivered immediately.
33452
33453 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33454 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
33455 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
33456 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
33457 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
33458 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
33459 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
33460 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
33461 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
33462 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
33463 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
33464 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
33465 single SMTP connection.
33466
33467
33468
33469 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33470 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33471
33472 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
33473 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
33474 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
33475 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
33476 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
33477 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
33478 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
33479 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
33480 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
33481 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
33482 messages this way.
33483
33484 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
33485 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
33486 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
33487 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
33488 email is not desirable.
33489
33490 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
33491 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
33492 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
33493 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
33494 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
33495 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
33496 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
33497
33498 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
33499 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
33500 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
33501 before sending a message to the smart host.
33502
33503 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
33504 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
33505 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
33506
33507 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
33508 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
33509 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
33510 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
33511 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
33512 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
33513 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
33514
33515 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
33516 following ways:
33517
33518 .ilist
33519 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
33520 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
33521 .next
33522 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
33523 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
33524 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
33525 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
33526 successful, a zero return code is given.
33527 .next
33528 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
33529 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
33530 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
33531 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
33532 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
33533 are.
33534 .next
33535 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
33536 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
33537 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
33538 .next
33539 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
33540 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
33541 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
33542 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
33543 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
33544 .next
33545 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
33546 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
33547 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
33548 .next
33549 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
33550 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
33551 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
33552 are ever generated.
33553 .next
33554 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
33555 .next
33556 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
33557 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
33558 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
33559 .endlist
33560
33561 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
33562 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
33563 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
33564 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
33565 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
33566 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
33567
33568
33569
33570
33571 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33572 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33573
33574 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
33575 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
33576 .cindex "log" "types of"
33577 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
33578 and the panic log:
33579
33580 .ilist
33581 .cindex "main log"
33582 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
33583 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
33584 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
33585 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
33586 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
33587 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
33588 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
33589 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
33590 .next
33591 .cindex "reject log"
33592 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
33593 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
33594 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
33595 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
33596 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
33597 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
33598 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
33599 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
33600 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
33601 false.
33602 .next
33603 .cindex "panic log"
33604 .cindex "system log"
33605 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
33606 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
33607 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
33608 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
33609 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
33610 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
33611 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
33612 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
33613 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
33614 .endlist
33615
33616 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
33617 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
33618 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
33619 .code
33620 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
33621 by QUIT
33622 .endd
33623 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
33624 ways of changing this:
33625
33626 .ilist
33627 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
33628 you set
33629 .code
33630 timezone = UTC
33631 .endd
33632 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
33633 .next
33634 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
33635 example:
33636 .code
33637 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
33638 .endd
33639 .endlist
33640
33641 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33642 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33643 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
33644 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
33645 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
33646 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
33647
33648
33649
33650
33651 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
33652 .cindex "log" "destination"
33653 .cindex "log" "to file"
33654 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
33655 .cindex "syslog"
33656 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
33657 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
33658 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
33659 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
33660 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
33661 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
33662 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
33663
33664 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
33665 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
33666 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
33667 references to the host name:
33668 .code
33669 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
33670 .endd
33671 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
33672 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
33673 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
33674 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
33675 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
33676 log at all.
33677
33678 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
33679 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
33680 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
33681 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
33682 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
33683 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
33684 implying the use of a default path.
33685
33686 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
33687 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
33688 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
33689 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
33690 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
33691 equivalent to the setting:
33692 .code
33693 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
33694 .endd
33695 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
33696 logs are written.
33697
33698 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
33699 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
33700
33701 Here are some examples of possible settings:
33702 .display
33703 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
33704 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
33705 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
33706 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
33707 .endd
33708 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
33709 error is logged.
33710
33711
33712
33713 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
33714 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33715 .cindex "cycling logs"
33716 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33717 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
33718 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
33719 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
33720 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
33721 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
33722 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
33723
33724 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
33725 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
33726 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
33727 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
33728 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
33729 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
33730 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
33731 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
33732 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
33733 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
33734 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
33735 renamed.
33736
33737
33738
33739 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
33740 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
33741 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
33742 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
33743 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
33744 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
33745 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
33746 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
33747 .code
33748 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
33749 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
33750 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
33751 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
33752 .endd
33753 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
33754 examples of names generated by the above examples:
33755 .code
33756 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
33757 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
33758 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
33759 /var/log/exim/main.200212
33760 .endd
33761 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
33762 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
33763 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
33764 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
33765
33766 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
33767 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
33768 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
33769 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
33770 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
33771 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
33772 log names:
33773 .code
33774 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33775 /var/log/exim-panic.log
33776 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33777 /var/log/exim/panic
33778 .endd
33779
33780
33781 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
33782 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
33783 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
33784 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
33785 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
33786 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
33787 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
33788 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
33789 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
33790 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
33791 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
33792 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
33793 the time and host name to each line.
33794 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
33795
33796 .ilist
33797 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
33798 .next
33799 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
33800 .next
33801 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
33802 .endlist
33803
33804 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
33805 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
33806 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
33807 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
33808
33809 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
33810 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
33811 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
33812 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
33813 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
33814 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
33815 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
33816 RFC 3164, you should set
33817 .code
33818 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
33819 .endd
33820 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
33821 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
33822
33823 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
33824 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
33825 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
33826 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
33827 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
33828 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
33829 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
33830 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
33831 name, and pid as added by syslog:
33832 .code
33833 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
33834 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
33835 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
33836 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
33837 [5/5] mple>)
33838 .endd
33839 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
33840 (LOG_NOTICE):
33841 .code
33842 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
33843 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
33844 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
33845 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
33846 [5\18] .example>)
33847 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
33848 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
33849 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
33850 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
33851 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
33852 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
33853 [12\18] F From: <>
33854 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
33855 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
33856 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
33857 [16\18] le>
33858 [17\18] B Bcc:
33859 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
33860 .endd
33861 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
33862 without modification.
33863
33864 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
33865 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
33866 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
33867 where it is.
33868
33869
33870
33871 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
33872 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
33873 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
33874 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
33875 timestamp. The flags are:
33876 .display
33877 &`<=`& message arrival
33878 &`=>`& normal message delivery
33879 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
33880 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
33881 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
33882 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
33883 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
33884 .endd
33885
33886
33887 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
33888 .cindex "log" "reception line"
33889 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33890 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
33891 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
33892 .code
33893 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
33894 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
33895 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
33896 .endd
33897 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
33898 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
33899 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
33900 .code
33901 R=<message id>
33902 .endd
33903 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
33904
33905 .cindex "HELO"
33906 .cindex "EHLO"
33907 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
33908 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
33909 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
33910 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
33911 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
33912 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
33913 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
33914 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
33915 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
33916 name in parentheses.
33917
33918 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
33919 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
33920 the log containing text like these examples:
33921 .code
33922 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
33923 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
33924 .endd
33925 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
33926 on.
33927
33928 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
33929 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
33930 of Exim.
33931
33932 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
33933 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
33934 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
33935 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
33936 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
33937 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
33938 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
33939 suite that was used.
33940
33941 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
33942 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
33943 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
33944 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
33945 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
33946 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
33947 authenticator name.
33948
33949 .cindex "size" "of message"
33950 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
33951 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
33952 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
33953 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
33954 other).
33955
33956 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33957 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33958
33959
33960
33961 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
33962 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
33963 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33964 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33965 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33966 to fit it on the page:
33967 .code
33968 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33969 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
33970 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33971 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33972 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33973 .endd
33974 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33975 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33976 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33977 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33978 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33979
33980 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
33981 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
33982 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
33983 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
33984
33985 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33986 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33987 .display
33988 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33989 .endd
33990 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33991 parentheses afterwards.
33992
33993 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33994 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33995 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33996 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
33997 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
33998 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
33999
34000 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
34001 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
34002 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
34003 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
34004 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
34005
34006 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
34007 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
34008
34009 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
34010 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
34011
34012
34013 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
34014 .cindex "discarded messages"
34015 .cindex "message" "discarded"
34016 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
34017 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
34018 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
34019 .code
34020 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
34021 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
34022 .endd
34023 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
34024 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
34025 .code
34026 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
34027 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
34028 .endd
34029
34030
34031 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
34032 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
34033 .code
34034 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
34035 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
34036 .endd
34037 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
34038 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
34039 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
34040 .code
34041 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
34042 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
34043 .endd
34044 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
34045 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
34046 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
34047
34048
34049
34050 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
34051 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
34052 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
34053 following form is logged:
34054 .code
34055 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
34056 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
34057 .endd
34058 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
34059 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
34060 .code
34061 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
34062 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
34063 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
34064 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
34065 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
34066 .endd
34067 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
34068 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
34069 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
34070 flagged with &`**`&.
34071
34072
34073
34074 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
34075 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
34076 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
34077 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
34078 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
34079
34080
34081
34082 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
34083 A line of the form
34084 .code
34085 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
34086 .endd
34087 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
34088 at the end of its processing.
34089
34090
34091
34092
34093 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
34094 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
34095 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
34096 the following table:
34097 .display
34098 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
34099 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
34100 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34101 &`CV `& certificate verification status
34102 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34103 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
34104 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
34105 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
34106 &`H `& host name and IP address
34107 &`I `& local interface used
34108 &`id `& message id for incoming message
34109 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
34110 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
34111 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
34112 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
34113 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
34114 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
34115 &`S `& size of message
34116 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
34117 &`ST `& shadow transport name
34118 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
34119 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
34120 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
34121 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
34122 .endd
34123
34124
34125 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
34126 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
34127 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
34128
34129 .ilist
34130 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
34131 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
34132 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
34133 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
34134 during the first delivery attempt.
34135 .next
34136 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
34137 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
34138 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
34139 .next
34140 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
34141 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
34142 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
34143 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
34144 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
34145 doing.
34146 .next
34147 .cindex "error" "ignored"
34148 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
34149 message:
34150 .olist
34151 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
34152 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
34153 .next
34154 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
34155 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34156 .next
34157 A delivery set up by a router configured with
34158 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
34159 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
34160 .code
34161 errors_to = <>
34162 .endd
34163 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34164 .endlist olist
34165 .endlist ilist
34166
34167
34168
34169
34170
34171 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
34172 .cindex "log" "selectors"
34173 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
34174 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
34175 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
34176 example:
34177 .code
34178 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
34179 .endd
34180 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
34181 selection marked by asterisks:
34182 .display
34183 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
34184 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
34185 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
34186 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
34187 &` arguments `& command line arguments
34188 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
34189 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
34190 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
34191 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
34192 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
34193 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
34194 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
34195 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
34196 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
34197 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
34198 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
34199 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
34200 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
34201 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
34202 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
34203 &` pid `& Exim process id
34204 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
34205 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
34206 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
34207 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
34208 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
34209 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
34210 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
34211 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
34212 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
34213 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
34214 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
34215 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
34216 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
34217 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
34218 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
34219 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
34220 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
34221 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
34222 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
34223 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
34224 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
34225 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
34226
34227 &` all `& all of the above
34228 .endd
34229 More details on each of these items follows:
34230
34231 .ilist
34232 .cindex "8BITMIME"
34233 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
34234 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
34235 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
34236 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
34237 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
34238 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
34239 .next
34240 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
34241 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
34242 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
34243 this log selector is set.
34244 .next
34245 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
34246 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
34247 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
34248 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
34249 such users cannot access the log).
34250 .next
34251 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
34252 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
34253 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
34254 parentheses between them.
34255 .next
34256 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
34257 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
34258 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
34259 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
34260 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
34261 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
34262 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
34263 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
34264 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
34265 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
34266 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
34267 between the caller and Exim.
34268 .next
34269 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
34270 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
34271 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
34272 .next
34273 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
34274 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
34275 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
34276 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
34277 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
34278 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
34279 .next
34280 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
34281 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
34282 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
34283 .next
34284 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
34285 .cindex "size" "of message"
34286 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
34287 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
34288 .next
34289 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
34290 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
34291 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
34292 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
34293 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
34294 .next
34295 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
34296 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
34297 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
34298 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
34299 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
34300 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
34301 .next
34302 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
34303 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
34304 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
34305 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
34306 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
34307 .next
34308 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
34309 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
34310 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
34311 client's ident port times out.
34312 .next
34313 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
34314 .cindex "interface" "logging"
34315 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
34316 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
34317 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
34318 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
34319 rejection lines.
34320 .next
34321 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
34322 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
34323 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
34324 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
34325 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
34326 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
34327 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
34328 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
34329 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
34330 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
34331 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
34332 .next
34333 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
34334 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
34335 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
34336 .next
34337 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
34338 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
34339 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
34340 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
34341 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
34342 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
34343 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
34344 .next
34345 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34346 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34347 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
34348 immediately after the time and date.
34349 .next
34350 .cindex "log" "queue run"
34351 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
34352 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
34353 .next
34354 .cindex "log" "queue time"
34355 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
34356 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
34357 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
34358 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
34359 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
34360 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
34361 message has been successfully received.
34362 .next
34363 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
34364 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
34365 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
34366 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
34367 .next
34368 .cindex "log" "recipients"
34369 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
34370 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
34371 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
34372 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
34373 has taken place.
34374 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
34375 in the list.
34376 .next
34377 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
34378 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
34379 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
34380 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
34381 .next
34382 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
34383 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
34384 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
34385 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
34386 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
34387 .next
34388 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
34389 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
34390 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
34391 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
34392 attempt.
34393 .next
34394 .cindex "log" "return path"
34395 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
34396 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
34397 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
34398 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
34399 .next
34400 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
34401 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
34402 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
34403 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
34404 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
34405 .next
34406 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
34407 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
34408 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
34409 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
34410 detail is lost.
34411 .next
34412 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
34413 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
34414 it is too big.
34415 .next
34416 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
34417 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
34418 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
34419 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
34420 it.
34421 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
34422 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
34423 .next
34424 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
34425 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
34426 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
34427 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
34428 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
34429 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
34430 response.
34431 .next
34432 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
34433 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
34434 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
34435 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
34436 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
34437 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
34438 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
34439 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
34440 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
34441 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
34442
34443 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
34444 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
34445 reset if the daemon is restarted.
34446 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
34447 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
34448 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
34449 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
34450 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
34451 .next
34452 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
34453 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
34454 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
34455 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
34456 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
34457 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
34458 .next
34459 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
34460 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
34461 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
34462 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
34463 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
34464 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
34465 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
34466 already have their own log lines.
34467
34468 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
34469 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
34470 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
34471 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
34472 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
34473 the same logging options.
34474
34475 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
34476 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
34477 .code
34478 C=EHLO,QUIT
34479 .endd
34480 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
34481 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
34482 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
34483 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
34484 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
34485 .next
34486 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
34487 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
34488 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
34489 was accepted or used.
34490 .next
34491 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
34492 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
34493 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
34494 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
34495 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
34496 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
34497 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
34498 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
34499 .next
34500 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
34501 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
34502 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
34503 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
34504 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
34505 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
34506 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
34507 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
34508 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
34509 .next
34510 .cindex "log" "subject"
34511 .cindex "subject, logging"
34512 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
34513 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
34514 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
34515 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
34516 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
34517 .next
34518 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
34519 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
34520 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
34521 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
34522 .next
34523 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
34524 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
34525 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34526 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
34527 .next
34528 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
34529 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
34530 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34531 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
34532 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
34533 .next
34534 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
34535 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
34536 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
34537 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
34538 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
34539 .next
34540 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
34541 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
34542 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
34543 .endlist
34544
34545
34546 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
34547 .cindex "message" "log file for"
34548 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
34549 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
34550 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
34551 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
34552 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
34553 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
34554 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
34555 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
34556 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
34557 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
34558 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
34559
34560 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
34561 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
34562 &%message_logs%& option false.
34563 .ecindex IIDloggen
34564
34565
34566
34567
34568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34570
34571 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
34572 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
34573 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
34574 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
34575 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
34576
34577 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
34578 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
34579 "list what Exim processes are doing"
34580 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
34581 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
34582 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
34583 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
34584 various criteria"
34585 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
34586 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
34587 "extract statistics from the log"
34588 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
34589 "check address acceptance from given IP"
34590 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
34591 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
34592 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
34593 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
34594 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
34595 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
34596 .endtable
34597
34598 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
34599 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
34600 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
34601
34602
34603
34604
34605 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
34606 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
34607 .cindex "process, querying"
34608 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
34609 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
34610 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
34611 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
34612 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
34613 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
34614 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
34615 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
34616 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
34617
34618 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
34619 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
34620 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
34621
34622
34623 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
34624 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
34625 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
34626 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
34627 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
34628 options:
34629 .display
34630 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
34631 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
34632 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
34633 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
34634 .endd
34635 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
34636 .code
34637 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
34638 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
34639 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
34640 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
34641 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
34642 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
34643 .endd
34644 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
34645 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
34646
34647
34648
34649 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
34650 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
34651 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
34652 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
34653 .code
34654 exim -bpu
34655 .endd
34656 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
34657 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
34658 options are available:
34659
34660 .vlist
34661 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
34662 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
34663 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
34664 .code
34665 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
34666 .endd
34667 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
34668 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
34669 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
34670
34671 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
34672 Match against the size field.
34673
34674 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34675 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
34676
34677 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34678 Match messages that are older than the given time.
34679
34680 .vitem &*-z*&
34681 Match only frozen messages.
34682
34683 .vitem &*-x*&
34684 Match only non-frozen messages.
34685 .endlist
34686
34687 The following options control the format of the output:
34688
34689 .vlist
34690 .vitem &*-c*&
34691 Display only the count of matching messages.
34692
34693 .vitem &*-l*&
34694 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
34695 the default.
34696
34697 .vitem &*-i*&
34698 Display message ids only.
34699
34700 .vitem &*-b*&
34701 Brief format &-- one line per message.
34702
34703 .vitem &*-R*&
34704 Display messages in reverse order.
34705 .endlist
34706
34707 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
34708
34709
34710
34711 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
34712 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
34713 .cindex "queue" "summary"
34714 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
34715 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
34716 running a command such as
34717 .code
34718 exim -bp | exiqsumm
34719 .endd
34720 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
34721 it, as in the following example:
34722 .code
34723 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
34724 .endd
34725 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
34726 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
34727 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
34728 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
34729
34730 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
34731 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
34732 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
34733 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
34734 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
34735 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
34736 sender.
34737
34738 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
34739 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
34740 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
34741 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
34742 level"& addresses).
34743
34744
34745
34746
34747 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
34748 "SECTextspeinf"
34749 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
34750 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
34751 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
34752 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
34753 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
34754 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
34755 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
34756 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
34757 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
34758 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
34759 .display
34760 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
34761 .endd
34762 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
34763
34764 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
34765 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
34766 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
34767
34768 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
34769 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
34770 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
34771 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
34772 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
34773
34774 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
34775 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
34776 regular expression.
34777
34778 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
34779 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
34780
34781 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
34782 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
34783 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
34784
34785
34786 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
34787 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
34788 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
34789 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
34790 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
34791 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
34792 the &%--help%& option.
34793
34794
34795 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
34796 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34797 .cindex "cycling logs"
34798 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34799 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
34800 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
34801 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
34802 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
34803 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
34804 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
34805 .ilist
34806 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
34807 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
34808 .next
34809 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
34810 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
34811 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
34812 configuration.
34813 .endlist
34814
34815 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
34816 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
34817 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
34818 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
34819 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
34820 logs are handled similarly.
34821
34822 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
34823 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
34824 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
34825 any existing log files.
34826
34827 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
34828 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
34829 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
34830 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
34831 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
34832 .code
34833 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
34834 .endd
34835 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
34836 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
34837
34838
34839
34840 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
34841 .cindex "statistics"
34842 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
34843 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
34844 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
34845 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
34846 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
34847
34848 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
34849 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
34850 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
34851 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
34852 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
34853 .code
34854 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
34855 .endd
34856 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
34857 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
34858 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
34859 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
34860 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
34861 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
34862 also produced per user.
34863
34864 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
34865 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
34866 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
34867 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
34868 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
34869
34870 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
34871 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
34872 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
34873 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
34874 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
34875 an entirely separate message.
34876
34877 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
34878 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
34879 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
34880 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
34881 least one address that failed.
34882
34883 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
34884 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
34885 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
34886 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
34887 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
34888 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
34889 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
34890
34891 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
34892 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
34893 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
34894
34895 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
34896 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
34897 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
34898 .code
34899 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
34900 .endd
34901
34902 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
34903 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
34904 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
34905 .cindex "checking access"
34906 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
34907 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
34908 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
34909 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
34910 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
34911 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
34912
34913 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
34914 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
34915 .code
34916 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
34917 .endd
34918 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
34919 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
34920 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
34921 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
34922 .code
34923 Rejected:
34924 550 Relay not permitted
34925 .endd
34926 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
34927 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
34928 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
34929 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
34930 you can use:
34931 .code
34932 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
34933 -f himself@there.example
34934 .endd
34935 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
34936 mandatory arguments.
34937
34938 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
34939 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
34940 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
34941
34942
34943
34944 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
34945 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
34946 .cindex "building DBM files"
34947 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
34948 .cindex "lower casing"
34949 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
34950 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
34951 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
34952 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
34953 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
34954 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
34955
34956 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
34957 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
34958 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
34959 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
34960 files.
34961
34962 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
34963 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
34964 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
34965 well.
34966
34967 .cindex "USE_DB"
34968 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
34969 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
34970 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
34971 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
34972 .code
34973 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
34974 .endd
34975 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
34976 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
34977
34978 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
34979 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
34980 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
34981 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
34982 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
34983 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
34984
34985 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
34986 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
34987 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
34988 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
34989 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
34990 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
34991 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
34992 return code is 2.
34993
34994
34995
34996
34997 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
34998 .cindex "retry" "times"
34999 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
35000 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
35001 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
35002 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
35003 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
35004 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
35005 output. For example:
35006 .code
35007 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
35008 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
35009 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35010 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35011 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
35012 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
35013 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
35014 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
35015 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
35016 past final cutoff time
35017 .endd
35018 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
35019 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
35020 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
35021 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
35022 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
35023 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
35024 run very often.
35025
35026 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
35027 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
35028 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
35029 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
35030 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
35031 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
35032
35033
35034
35035 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
35036 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
35037 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
35038 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
35039 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
35040 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
35041 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
35042
35043 .ilist
35044 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
35045 .next
35046 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
35047 for remote hosts
35048 .next
35049 &'callout'&: the callout cache
35050 .next
35051 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
35052 .next
35053 &'misc'&: other hints data
35054 .endlist
35055
35056 The &'misc'& database is used for
35057
35058 .ilist
35059 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
35060 .next
35061 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
35062 &(smtp)& transport)
35063 .endlist
35064
35065
35066
35067 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
35068 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
35069 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
35070 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
35071 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
35072 .code
35073 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
35074 .endd
35075 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
35076 .code
35077 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
35078 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
35079 .endd
35080 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
35081 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
35082 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
35083 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
35084 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
35085 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
35086 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
35087 and a textual description of the error.
35088
35089 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
35090 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
35091 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
35092 exceeded.
35093
35094 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
35095 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
35096 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
35097 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
35098 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
35099 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
35100 cross-references.
35101
35102
35103
35104 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
35105 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
35106 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
35107 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
35108 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
35109 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
35110 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
35111 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
35112 updated sufficiently often.
35113
35114 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
35115 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
35116 the retry database:
35117 .code
35118 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
35119 .endd
35120 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
35121 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
35122 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
35123 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
35124 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
35125 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
35126 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
35127 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
35128 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
35129 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
35130 whenever it removes information from the database.
35131
35132 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
35133 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
35134 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
35135 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
35136 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
35137
35138 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
35139 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
35140 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
35141 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
35142 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
35143 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
35144 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
35145 tidied.
35146
35147 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
35148 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
35149
35150
35151
35152
35153 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
35154 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
35155 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
35156 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
35157 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
35158 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
35159 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
35160 displayed.
35161
35162 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
35163 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
35164 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
35165 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
35166 by new data, for example:
35167 .code
35168 > 4 951102:1000
35169 .endd
35170 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
35171 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
35172 used as optional separators.
35173
35174
35175
35176
35177 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
35178 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
35179 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
35180 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
35181 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
35182 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
35183 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
35184 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
35185 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
35186 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
35187 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
35188 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
35189 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
35190
35191 .vlist
35192 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
35193 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
35194
35195 .vitem &%-flock%&
35196 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
35197 supports it.
35198
35199 .vitem &%-interval%&
35200 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
35201 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
35202
35203 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
35204 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
35205
35206 .vitem &%-mbx%&
35207 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
35208
35209 .vitem &%-q%&
35210 Suppress verification output.
35211
35212 .vitem &%-retries%&
35213 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
35214 the lock (default 10).
35215
35216 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
35217 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
35218 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
35219 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
35220 subsequently sees.
35221
35222 .vitem &%-timeout%&
35223 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
35224 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
35225 default), a non-blocking call is used.
35226
35227 .vitem &%-v%&
35228 Generate verbose output.
35229 .endlist
35230
35231 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
35232 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
35233 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
35234 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
35235 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
35236 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
35237 more than 30 minutes old.
35238
35239 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
35240 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
35241 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
35242 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
35243 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
35244 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
35245
35246 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
35247 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
35248 suppresses all output except error messages.
35249
35250 A command such as
35251 .code
35252 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
35253 .endd
35254 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
35255 .display
35256 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
35257 <&'some commands'&>
35258 &`End`&
35259 .endd
35260 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
35261 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
35262 such as
35263 .code
35264 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
35265 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
35266 .endd
35267 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
35268 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
35269 .ecindex IIDutils
35270
35271
35272 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35273 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35274
35275 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
35276 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
35277 .cindex "X-windows"
35278 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
35279 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
35280 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
35281 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
35282 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
35283 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
35284 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
35285 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
35286
35287
35288
35289 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
35290 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
35291 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
35292 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
35293 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
35294 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
35295 parameters are for.
35296
35297 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
35298 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
35299 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
35300 .code
35301 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
35302 .endd
35303 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
35304 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
35305 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
35306 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
35307 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
35308
35309 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
35310 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
35311 .code
35312 Eximon*background: gray94
35313 .endd
35314 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
35315 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
35316 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
35317 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
35318 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
35319 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
35320 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
35321 .code
35322 xrdb -merge <<End
35323 Eximon*highlight: gray
35324 End
35325 .endd
35326 .cindex "admin user"
35327 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
35328 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
35329
35330 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
35331 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
35332 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
35333 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
35334 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
35335
35336 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
35337 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
35338 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
35339 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
35340 different parts of the display.
35341
35342
35343
35344
35345 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
35346 .cindex "stripchart"
35347 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
35348 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35349 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
35350 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
35351 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
35352 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
35353 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
35354 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
35355 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35356
35357 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
35358 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
35359 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
35360 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
35361
35362 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
35363 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
35364 to a single partition.
35365
35366 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
35367 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
35368 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
35369 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
35370 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
35371 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35372 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35373
35374
35375
35376
35377 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
35378 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
35379 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
35380 .cindex "window size"
35381 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
35382 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
35383 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
35384 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
35385 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
35386 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
35387
35388 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
35389 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
35390 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
35391 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
35392
35393 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
35394 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
35395 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
35396 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
35397 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
35398 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35399
35400 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
35401 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
35402 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35403
35404
35405
35406 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
35407 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
35408 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
35409 the main log is maintained.
35410 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
35411 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
35412 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
35413 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
35414 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
35415
35416 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
35417 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
35418 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
35419 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
35420 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
35421 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
35422 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
35423 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
35424 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
35425 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
35426 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35427
35428 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
35429 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
35430 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
35431 It cannot go further back up the log.
35432
35433 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
35434 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
35435 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
35436 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
35437 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
35438 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
35439
35440 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
35441 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
35442 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
35443 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
35444 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
35445 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
35446
35447 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
35448 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
35449 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
35450 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
35451 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
35452 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
35453 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
35454 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
35455 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
35456 window.
35457
35458
35459
35460 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
35461 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
35462 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
35463 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
35464 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
35465 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
35466 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
35467 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
35468 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
35469 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
35470
35471 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
35472 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
35473 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
35474 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
35475 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
35476 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
35477 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
35478
35479 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
35480 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
35481 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
35482 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
35483 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
35484 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
35485 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
35486
35487 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
35488 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
35489 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
35490 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
35491
35492 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
35493 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
35494 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
35495 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
35496 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
35497 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
35498 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
35499 not shown.
35500
35501 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
35502 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
35503
35504 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
35505 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
35506 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
35507 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
35508 display is updated.
35509
35510
35511
35512 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
35513 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
35514 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
35515 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
35516 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
35517 any selected text.
35518
35519 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
35520 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
35521 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
35522 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
35523 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
35524 .code
35525 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
35526 .endd
35527 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
35528 follows:
35529
35530 .ilist
35531 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
35532 in a new text window.
35533 .next
35534 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
35535 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
35536 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
35537 .next
35538 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
35539 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
35540 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
35541 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
35542 .next
35543 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
35544 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
35545 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
35546 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
35547 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
35548 .next
35549 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
35550 that the message be frozen.
35551 .next
35552 .cindex "thawing messages"
35553 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
35554 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
35555 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
35556 that the message be thawed.
35557 .next
35558 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
35559 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
35560 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
35561 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
35562 .next
35563 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
35564 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
35565 message.
35566 .next
35567 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
35568 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35569 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35570 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35571 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
35572 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
35573 which case no action is taken.
35574 .next
35575 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
35576 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35577 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35578 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35579 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
35580 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
35581 case no action is taken.
35582 .next
35583 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
35584 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
35585 .next
35586 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
35587 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
35588 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
35589 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
35590 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
35591 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
35592 the address is qualified with that domain.
35593 .endlist
35594
35595 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
35596 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
35597 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
35598 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
35599 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
35600 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
35601 if no output is generated.
35602
35603 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
35604 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
35605 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
35606 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
35607
35608 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
35609 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
35610 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
35611 .ecindex IIDeximon
35612
35613
35614
35615
35616
35617 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35619
35620 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
35621 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
35622 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
35623 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
35624
35625 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
35626 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
35627 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
35628 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
35629 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
35630 its security as compared with other MTAs.
35631
35632 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
35633 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
35634 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
35635 as soon as possible.
35636
35637
35638 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
35639 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
35640 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
35641 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
35642 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
35643 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
35644
35645 .ilist
35646 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
35647 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
35648 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
35649 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
35650 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
35651 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
35652
35653 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
35654 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
35655 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
35656 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
35657 .next
35658
35659 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
35660 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
35661 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
35662 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
35663 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
35664 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
35665 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
35666 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
35667 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
35668 separate commands.
35669
35670 .next
35671 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
35672 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
35673 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
35674 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
35675 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
35676 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
35677 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
35678 .next
35679 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
35680 is disabled.
35681 .next
35682 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
35683 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
35684 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
35685 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
35686 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
35687 .endlist
35688
35689
35690
35691 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
35692 .cindex "setuid"
35693 .cindex "root privilege"
35694 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
35695 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
35696 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
35697 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
35698 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
35699 is required for two things:
35700
35701 .ilist
35702 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
35703 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
35704 not required.
35705 .next
35706 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
35707 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
35708 configuration.
35709 .endlist
35710
35711 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
35712 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
35713 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
35714 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
35715 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
35716 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
35717 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
35718 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
35719
35720 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
35721 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
35722 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
35723
35724 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
35725 uid and gid in the following cases:
35726
35727 .ilist
35728 .oindex "&%-C%&"
35729 .oindex "&%-D%&"
35730 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
35731 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
35732 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
35733 the calling process.
35734 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
35735 option may not be used at all.
35736 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
35737 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
35738 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
35739 .next
35740 .oindex "&%-be%&"
35741 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
35742 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
35743 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
35744 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
35745 calling process.
35746 .next
35747 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
35748 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
35749 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
35750 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
35751 testing address verification
35752 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
35753 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
35754 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
35755 option).
35756 .next
35757 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
35758 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
35759 .endlist
35760
35761 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
35762
35763 .ilist
35764 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
35765 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
35766 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
35767 will be used during message reception.
35768 .next
35769 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
35770 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
35771 .next
35772 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
35773 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
35774 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
35775 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
35776 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
35777 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
35778 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
35779 generating bounce and warning messages.
35780
35781 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
35782 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
35783 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
35784 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
35785 .next
35786 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
35787 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
35788 .endlist
35789
35790
35791
35792
35793 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
35794 .cindex "privilege, running without"
35795 .cindex "unprivileged running"
35796 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
35797 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
35798 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
35799 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
35800 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
35801 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
35802 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
35803 to any other uid.
35804
35805 .cindex SIGHUP
35806 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
35807 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
35808 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
35809 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
35810
35811 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
35812 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
35813 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
35814 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
35815 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
35816
35817 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
35818 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
35819 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
35820 effect.
35821
35822 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
35823 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
35824 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
35825
35826 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
35827 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
35828 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
35829 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
35830 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
35831 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
35832 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
35833 address this problem at this time.
35834
35835 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
35836 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
35837 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
35838 be used in the most straightforward way.
35839
35840 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
35841 number of restrictions on what you can do:
35842
35843 .ilist
35844 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
35845 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
35846 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
35847 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
35848 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
35849 .next
35850 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
35851 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
35852 .next
35853 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
35854 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
35855 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
35856 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
35857 .next
35858 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
35859 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
35860
35861 .olist
35862 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
35863 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
35864 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
35865 .next
35866 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
35867 owned by the Exim user.
35868 .next
35869 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
35870 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
35871 mailboxes need to be created manually.
35872 .endlist olist
35873 .endlist ilist
35874
35875
35876 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
35877 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
35878 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
35879 gives more security at essentially no cost.
35880
35881 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
35882 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
35883
35884
35885
35886
35887 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
35888 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
35889 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
35890
35891
35892
35893 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
35894 .cindex "security" "local commands"
35895 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
35896 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
35897 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
35898 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
35899 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
35900
35901 .ilist
35902 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
35903 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
35904 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
35905 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
35906 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
35907 .next
35908 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
35909 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
35910 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
35911 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
35912 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
35913 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
35914 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
35915 .next
35916 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
35917 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
35918 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
35919 .next
35920 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
35921 taint checking might apply to their usage.
35922 .next
35923 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
35924 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
35925 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
35926 .next
35927 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
35928 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
35929 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
35930 of opaque strings.
35931 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
35932 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
35933 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
35934 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
35935 .endlist
35936
35937
35938
35939
35940 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
35941 .cindex "security" "data sources"
35942 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
35943 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
35944 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
35945 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
35946 are some issues to be aware of:
35947
35948 .ilist
35949 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
35950 .next
35951 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
35952 .next
35953 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
35954 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
35955 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
35956 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
35957 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
35958 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
35959 data.
35960 .next
35961 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
35962 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
35963 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
35964 .next
35965 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
35966 expected to yield one result.
35967 .endlist
35968
35969
35970
35971
35972 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
35973 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
35974 .cindex "IP source routing"
35975 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
35976 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
35977 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
35978 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
35979
35980
35981
35982 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
35983 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
35984 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
35985
35986
35987
35988
35989 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
35990 .cindex "trusted users"
35991 .cindex "admin user"
35992 .cindex "privileged user"
35993 .cindex "user" "trusted"
35994 .cindex "user" "admin"
35995 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
35996 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
35997 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
35998 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
35999 permit a remote host to be specified.
36000
36001 .oindex "&%-f%&"
36002 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
36003 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
36004 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
36005 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
36006 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
36007 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
36008
36009 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
36010 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
36011 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
36012 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
36013 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
36014
36015 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
36016 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
36017 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
36018 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
36019 includes the contents of files on the spool.
36020
36021 .oindex "&%-M%&"
36022 .oindex "&%-q%&"
36023 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
36024 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
36025 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
36026 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
36027 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
36028 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
36029
36030 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
36031 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
36032 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
36033 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
36034 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
36035 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
36036 files.
36037
36038
36039
36040 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
36041 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
36042 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
36043 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
36044 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
36045 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
36046
36047
36048
36049 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
36050 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
36051 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
36052 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
36053 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
36054 this.
36055
36056
36057
36058 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
36059 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
36060 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
36061 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
36062 converted output.
36063
36064
36065
36066 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
36067 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
36068 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
36069 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
36070 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
36071
36072
36073
36074 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
36075 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
36076 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
36077 loading it.
36078
36079
36080 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
36081 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
36082 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
36083 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
36084 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
36085 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
36086 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
36087
36088 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
36089 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
36090 string.
36091
36092
36093
36094 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
36095 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
36096 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
36097 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
36098
36099
36100
36101 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
36102 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
36103 enough to hold the result.
36104 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
36105
36106
36107
36108
36109 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36111
36112 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
36113 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
36114 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
36115 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
36116 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
36117 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
36118 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
36119 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
36120 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
36121 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
36122 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
36123 themselves are recoverable.
36124
36125 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
36126 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
36127 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
36128
36129 .ilist
36130 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
36131 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
36132 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
36133 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
36134 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
36135 .next
36136 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
36137 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
36138 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
36139 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
36140 will always be the case.
36141 .next
36142 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
36143 .next
36144 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
36145 signature.
36146 .endlist
36147 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
36148
36149 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
36150 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
36151 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
36152 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
36153 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
36154 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
36155 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
36156 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
36157 attempt.
36158
36159 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
36160 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
36161 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
36162 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
36163 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
36164 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
36165 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
36166 normally the Exim user.
36167
36168 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
36169 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
36170 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
36171 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
36172 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
36173 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
36174 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
36175 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
36176
36177 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
36178 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
36179 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
36180 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
36181
36182 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
36183 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
36184
36185 .vlist
36186 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36187 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
36188 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
36189 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
36190 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
36191 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
36192 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
36193 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
36194 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
36195 newlines.
36196
36197 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36198 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
36199 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
36200 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36201 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36202 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36203
36204 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36205 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
36206 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
36207 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36208 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36209 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36210
36211 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
36212 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
36213 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
36214
36215 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
36216 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
36217 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
36218 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
36219 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36220
36221 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
36222 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
36223 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
36224 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
36225 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36226
36227 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
36228 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
36229 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
36230
36231 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
36232 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
36233 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
36234
36235 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36236 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
36237 present.
36238
36239 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36240 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
36241 present if the number is greater than zero.
36242
36243 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
36244 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
36245 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
36246
36247 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
36248 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
36249 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
36250
36251 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36252 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
36253 command.
36254
36255 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36256 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
36257 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
36258 messages.
36259
36260 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
36261 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
36262 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
36263 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
36264
36265 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
36266 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
36267 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
36268
36269 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36270 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
36271 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
36272 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
36273 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
36274 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
36275
36276 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
36277 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
36278 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
36279 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
36280 supplied by the remote host, if any.
36281
36282 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36283 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
36284 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
36285 generated messages.
36286
36287 .vitem &%-local%&
36288 The message is from a local sender.
36289
36290 .vitem &%-localerror%&
36291 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
36292
36293 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
36294 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
36295 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
36296 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
36297
36298 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
36299 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
36300 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
36301
36302 .vitem &%-N%&
36303 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
36304 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
36305 &%-N%& is assumed.
36306
36307 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
36308 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
36309 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
36310
36311 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
36312 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
36313 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
36314
36315 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
36316 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
36317 of &$spam_score_int$&.
36318
36319 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
36320 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
36321 certificate was verified by the server.
36322
36323 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
36324 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
36325 name of the cipher suite that was used.
36326
36327 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
36328 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
36329 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
36330 certificate.
36331 .endlist
36332
36333 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
36334 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
36335 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
36336 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
36337 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
36338 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
36339 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
36340 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
36341 addresses are complete.
36342
36343 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
36344 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
36345 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
36346 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
36347 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
36348 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
36349 .code
36350 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
36351 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
36352 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36353 .endd
36354 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
36355 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
36356 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
36357 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
36358 example:
36359 .code
36360 4
36361 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36362 darcy@austen.fict.example
36363 rdo@foundation
36364 alice@wonderland.fict.example
36365 .endd
36366 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
36367 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
36368 line is of the following form:
36369 .display
36370 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
36371 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
36372 .endd
36373 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
36374 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
36375 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
36376 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
36377 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
36378 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
36379 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
36380 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
36381
36382
36383 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
36384 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
36385 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
36386 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
36387 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
36388 following:
36389
36390 .table2 50pt
36391 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
36392 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
36393 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
36394 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
36395 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
36396 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
36397 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
36398 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
36399 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
36400 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
36401 .endtable
36402
36403 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
36404 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
36405 typical set of headers:
36406 .code
36407 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
36408 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36409 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
36410 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
36411 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
36412 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
36413 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
36414 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36415 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
36416 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36417 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36418 .endd
36419 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
36420 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
36421 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
36422 .ecindex IIDforspo1
36423 .ecindex IIDforspo2
36424 .ecindex IIDforspo3
36425
36426 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36427 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36428
36429 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
36430 "DKIM Support"
36431 .cindex "DKIM"
36432
36433 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
36434 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
36435 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
36436 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
36437
36438 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
36439 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
36440
36441 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
36442 .olist
36443 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
36444 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
36445 (including transport filters)
36446 except cutthrough delivery.
36447 .next
36448 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
36449 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
36450 different signature contexts.
36451 .endlist
36452
36453 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
36454 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
36455 Exim's standard controls.
36456
36457 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
36458 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
36459 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
36460 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
36461 .code
36462 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
36463 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
36464 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
36465 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
36466 .endd
36467 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
36468 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
36469 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
36470 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
36471 senders).
36472
36473
36474 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
36475 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
36476
36477 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
36478 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
36479
36480 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
36481 MANDATORY:
36482 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
36483 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
36484
36485 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
36486 MANDATORY:
36487 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
36488 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
36489 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
36490 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
36491
36492 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
36493 MANDATORY:
36494 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
36495 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
36496 The result can either
36497 .ilist
36498 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
36499 .next
36500 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
36501 the private key.
36502 .next
36503 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
36504 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
36505 is set.
36506 .endlist
36507
36508 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
36509 OPTIONAL:
36510 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
36511 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
36512 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
36513 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
36514
36515 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
36516 OPTIONAL:
36517 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
36518 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
36519 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
36520 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
36521 variables here.
36522
36523 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
36524 OPTIONAL:
36525 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
36526 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
36527 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
36528 used.
36529
36530
36531 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
36532 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
36533
36534 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
36535 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
36536 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
36537 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
36538 If any ACL call does not acccept, the message is not accepted.
36539 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
36540 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
36541
36542 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
36543 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
36544 runtime of the ACL.
36545
36546 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
36547 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
36548 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
36549 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
36550
36551 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
36552 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
36553 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
36554 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
36555 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
36556 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
36557 it defaults as:
36558 .code
36559 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
36560 .endd
36561 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
36562 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
36563 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
36564 .code
36565 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
36566 .endd
36567 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
36568 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
36569 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
36570 .code
36571 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
36572 .endd
36573
36574 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
36575 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
36576
36577
36578 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
36579 available (from most to least important):
36580
36581
36582 .vlist
36583 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
36584 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
36585 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
36586 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
36587 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
36588 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
36589 .ilist
36590 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
36591 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36592 .next
36593 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
36594 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36595 .next
36596 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
36597 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36598 .next
36599 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
36600 .endlist
36601 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
36602 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
36603 "fail" or "invalid". One of
36604 .ilist
36605 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
36606 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
36607 .next
36608 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
36609 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
36610 .next
36611 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
36612 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
36613 means that the message body was modified in transit.
36614 .next
36615 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
36616 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
36617 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
36618 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
36619 .endlist
36620 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
36621 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
36622 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
36623 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36624 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
36625 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
36626 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
36627 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36628 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
36629 The key record selector string.
36630 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
36631 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
36632 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
36633 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36634 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
36635 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36636 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
36637 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
36638 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
36639 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
36640 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
36641 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
36642 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
36643 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
36644 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
36645 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
36646 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
36647 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
36648 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
36649 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
36650 integer size comparisons against this value.
36651 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
36652 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
36653 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
36654 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
36655 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
36656 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
36657 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
36658 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36659 in the key record.
36660 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
36661 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36662 in the key record.
36663 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
36664 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
36665 .endlist
36666
36667 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
36668
36669 .vlist
36670 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
36671 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
36672 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
36673 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
36674 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
36675
36676 .code
36677 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
36678 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
36679 sender_domains = gmail.com
36680 dkim_signers = gmail.com
36681 dkim_status = none
36682 .endd
36683
36684 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
36685 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
36686 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
36687 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
36688
36689 .code
36690 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
36691 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
36692 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
36693 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
36694 .endd
36695
36696 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
36697 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
36698 for more information of what they mean.
36699 .endlist
36700
36701 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36702 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36703
36704 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
36705 "Adding drivers or lookups"
36706 .cindex "adding drivers"
36707 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
36708 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
36709 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
36710 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
36711
36712 .olist
36713 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
36714 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
36715 .next
36716 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
36717 .display
36718 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
36719 .endd
36720 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
36721 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
36722 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
36723 .next
36724 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
36725 .code
36726 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
36727 .endd
36728 .next
36729 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
36730 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
36731 .next
36732 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
36733 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
36734 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
36735 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
36736 simple form that most lookups have.
36737 .next
36738 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
36739 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
36740 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
36741 .next
36742 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
36743 &_src_&.
36744 .next
36745 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
36746 as for other drivers and lookups.
36747 .endlist
36748
36749 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
36750 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
36751 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
36752 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
36753 searched using a binary chop procedure.
36754
36755 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
36756 the interface that is expected.
36757
36758
36759
36760
36761 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36762 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36763
36764 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36765 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
36766 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
36767 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
36768 . processors.
36769 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36770
36771 .literal xml
36772 <?sdop
36773 format="newpage"
36774 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
36775 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
36776 ?>
36777 .literal off
36778
36779 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
36780 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
36781 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
36782
36783
36784 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36785 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////